Quotations.ch
  Directory : The Secret Garden
GUIDE SUPPORT US BLOG
  • The Project Gutenberg EBook of The Secret Garden, Frances Hodgson Burnett
  • This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
  • almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
  • re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
  • with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
  • Title: The Secret Garden
  • Author: Frances Hodgson Burnett
  • Release Date: May 15, 2008 [EBook #113]
  • Last Updated: July 16, 2018
  • Language: English
  • Character set encoding: UTF-8
  • *** START OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK THE SECRET GARDEN ***
  • THE SECRET GARDEN
  • by Frances Hodgson Burnett
  • _Author of
  • “The Shuttle,” “The Making of a Marchioness,” “The Methods of Lady
  • Walderhurst,” “The Lass o’ Lowries,” “Through One Administration,”
  • “Little Lord Fauntleroy,” “A Lady of Quality,” etc._
  • Contents
  • I. THERE IS NO ONE LEFT
  • II. MISTRESS MARY QUITE CONTRARY
  • III. ACROSS THE MOOR
  • IV. MARTHA
  • V. THE CRY IN THE CORRIDOR
  • VI. “THERE WAS SOMEONE CRYING—THERE WAS!”
  • VII. THE KEY TO THE GARDEN
  • VIII. THE ROBIN WHO SHOWED THE WAY
  • IX. THE STRANGEST HOUSE ANYONE EVER LIVED IN
  • X. DICKON
  • XI. THE NEST OF THE MISSEL THRUSH
  • XII. “MIGHT I HAVE A BIT OF EARTH?”
  • XIII. “I AM COLIN”
  • XIV. A YOUNG RAJAH
  • XV. NEST BUILDING
  • XVI. “I WON’T!” SAID MARY
  • XVII. A TANTRUM
  • XVIII. “THA’ MUNNOT WASTE NO TIME”
  • XIX. “IT HAS COME!”
  • XX. “I SHALL LIVE FOREVER—AND EVER—AND EVER!”
  • XXI. BEN WEATHERSTAFF
  • XXII. WHEN THE SUN WENT DOWN
  • XXIII. MAGIC
  • XXIV. “LET THEM LAUGH”
  • XXV. THE CURTAIN
  • XXVI. “IT’S MOTHER!”
  • XXVII. IN THE GARDEN
  • CHAPTER I
  • THERE IS NO ONE LEFT
  • When Mary Lennox was sent to Misselthwaite Manor to live with her uncle
  • everybody said she was the most disagreeable-looking child ever seen.
  • It was true, too. She had a little thin face and a little thin body,
  • thin light hair and a sour expression. Her hair was yellow, and her
  • face was yellow because she had been born in India and had always been
  • ill in one way or another. Her father had held a position under the
  • English Government and had always been busy and ill himself, and her
  • mother had been a great beauty who cared only to go to parties and
  • amuse herself with gay people. She had not wanted a little girl at all,
  • and when Mary was born she handed her over to the care of an Ayah, who
  • was made to understand that if she wished to please the Mem Sahib she
  • must keep the child out of sight as much as possible. So when she was a
  • sickly, fretful, ugly little baby she was kept out of the way, and when
  • she became a sickly, fretful, toddling thing she was kept out of the
  • way also. She never remembered seeing familiarly anything but the dark
  • faces of her Ayah and the other native servants, and as they always
  • obeyed her and gave her her own way in everything, because the Mem
  • Sahib would be angry if she was disturbed by her crying, by the time
  • she was six years old she was as tyrannical and selfish a little pig as
  • ever lived. The young English governess who came to teach her to read
  • and write disliked her so much that she gave up her place in three
  • months, and when other governesses came to try to fill it they always
  • went away in a shorter time than the first one. So if Mary had not
  • chosen to really want to know how to read books she would never have
  • learned her letters at all.
  • One frightfully hot morning, when she was about nine years old, she
  • awakened feeling very cross, and she became crosser still when she saw
  • that the servant who stood by her bedside was not her Ayah.
  • “Why did you come?” she said to the strange woman. “I will not let you
  • stay. Send my Ayah to me.”
  • The woman looked frightened, but she only stammered that the Ayah could
  • not come and when Mary threw herself into a passion and beat and kicked
  • her, she looked only more frightened and repeated that it was not
  • possible for the Ayah to come to Missie Sahib.
  • There was something mysterious in the air that morning. Nothing was
  • done in its regular order and several of the native servants seemed
  • missing, while those whom Mary saw slunk or hurried about with ashy and
  • scared faces. But no one would tell her anything and her Ayah did not
  • come. She was actually left alone as the morning went on, and at last
  • she wandered out into the garden and began to play by herself under a
  • tree near the veranda. She pretended that she was making a flower-bed,
  • and she stuck big scarlet hibiscus blossoms into little heaps of earth,
  • all the time growing more and more angry and muttering to herself the
  • things she would say and the names she would call Saidie when she
  • returned.
  • “Pig! Pig! Daughter of Pigs!” she said, because to call a native a pig
  • is the worst insult of all.
  • She was grinding her teeth and saying this over and over again when she
  • heard her mother come out on the veranda with someone. She was with a
  • fair young man and they stood talking together in low strange voices.
  • Mary knew the fair young man who looked like a boy. She had heard that
  • he was a very young officer who had just come from England. The child
  • stared at him, but she stared most at her mother. She always did this
  • when she had a chance to see her, because the Mem Sahib—Mary used to
  • call her that oftener than anything else—was such a tall, slim, pretty
  • person and wore such lovely clothes. Her hair was like curly silk and
  • she had a delicate little nose which seemed to be disdaining things,
  • and she had large laughing eyes. All her clothes were thin and
  • floating, and Mary said they were “full of lace.” They looked fuller of
  • lace than ever this morning, but her eyes were not laughing at all.
  • They were large and scared and lifted imploringly to the fair boy
  • officer’s face.
  • “Is it so very bad? Oh, is it?” Mary heard her say.
  • “Awfully,” the young man answered in a trembling voice. “Awfully, Mrs.
  • Lennox. You ought to have gone to the hills two weeks ago.”
  • The Mem Sahib wrung her hands.
  • “Oh, I know I ought!” she cried. “I only stayed to go to that silly
  • dinner party. What a fool I was!”
  • At that very moment such a loud sound of wailing broke out from the
  • servants’ quarters that she clutched the young man’s arm, and Mary
  • stood shivering from head to foot. The wailing grew wilder and wilder.
  • “What is it? What is it?” Mrs. Lennox gasped.
  • “Someone has died,” answered the boy officer. “You did not say it had
  • broken out among your servants.”
  • “I did not know!” the Mem Sahib cried. “Come with me! Come with me!”
  • and she turned and ran into the house.
  • After that appalling things happened, and the mysteriousness of the
  • morning was explained to Mary. The cholera had broken out in its most
  • fatal form and people were dying like flies. The Ayah had been taken
  • ill in the night, and it was because she had just died that the
  • servants had wailed in the huts. Before the next day three other
  • servants were dead and others had run away in terror. There was panic
  • on every side, and dying people in all the bungalows.
  • During the confusion and bewilderment of the second day Mary hid
  • herself in the nursery and was forgotten by everyone. Nobody thought of
  • her, nobody wanted her, and strange things happened of which she knew
  • nothing. Mary alternately cried and slept through the hours. She only
  • knew that people were ill and that she heard mysterious and frightening
  • sounds. Once she crept into the dining-room and found it empty, though
  • a partly finished meal was on the table and chairs and plates looked as
  • if they had been hastily pushed back when the diners rose suddenly for
  • some reason. The child ate some fruit and biscuits, and being thirsty
  • she drank a glass of wine which stood nearly filled. It was sweet, and
  • she did not know how strong it was. Very soon it made her intensely
  • drowsy, and she went back to her nursery and shut herself in again,
  • frightened by cries she heard in the huts and by the hurrying sound of
  • feet. The wine made her so sleepy that she could scarcely keep her eyes
  • open and she lay down on her bed and knew nothing more for a long time.
  • Many things happened during the hours in which she slept so heavily,
  • but she was not disturbed by the wails and the sound of things being
  • carried in and out of the bungalow.
  • When she awakened she lay and stared at the wall. The house was
  • perfectly still. She had never known it to be so silent before. She
  • heard neither voices nor footsteps, and wondered if everybody had got
  • well of the cholera and all the trouble was over. She wondered also who
  • would take care of her now her Ayah was dead. There would be a new
  • Ayah, and perhaps she would know some new stories. Mary had been rather
  • tired of the old ones. She did not cry because her nurse had died. She
  • was not an affectionate child and had never cared much for anyone. The
  • noise and hurrying about and wailing over the cholera had frightened
  • her, and she had been angry because no one seemed to remember that she
  • was alive. Everyone was too panic-stricken to think of a little girl no
  • one was fond of. When people had the cholera it seemed that they
  • remembered nothing but themselves. But if everyone had got well again,
  • surely someone would remember and come to look for her.
  • But no one came, and as she lay waiting the house seemed to grow more
  • and more silent. She heard something rustling on the matting and when
  • she looked down she saw a little snake gliding along and watching her
  • with eyes like jewels. She was not frightened, because he was a
  • harmless little thing who would not hurt her and he seemed in a hurry
  • to get out of the room. He slipped under the door as she watched him.
  • “How queer and quiet it is,” she said. “It sounds as if there were no
  • one in the bungalow but me and the snake.”
  • Almost the next minute she heard footsteps in the compound, and then on
  • the veranda. They were men’s footsteps, and the men entered the
  • bungalow and talked in low voices. No one went to meet or speak to them
  • and they seemed to open doors and look into rooms.
  • “What desolation!” she heard one voice say. “That pretty, pretty woman!
  • I suppose the child, too. I heard there was a child, though no one ever
  • saw her.”
  • Mary was standing in the middle of the nursery when they opened the
  • door a few minutes later. She looked an ugly, cross little thing and
  • was frowning because she was beginning to be hungry and feel
  • disgracefully neglected. The first man who came in was a large officer
  • she had once seen talking to her father. He looked tired and troubled,
  • but when he saw her he was so startled that he almost jumped back.
  • “Barney!” he cried out. “There is a child here! A child alone! In a
  • place like this! Mercy on us, who is she!”
  • “I am Mary Lennox,” the little girl said, drawing herself up stiffly.
  • She thought the man was very rude to call her father’s bungalow “A
  • place like this!” “I fell asleep when everyone had the cholera and I
  • have only just wakened up. Why does nobody come?”
  • “It is the child no one ever saw!” exclaimed the man, turning to his
  • companions. “She has actually been forgotten!”
  • “Why was I forgotten?” Mary said, stamping her foot. “Why does nobody
  • come?”
  • The young man whose name was Barney looked at her very sadly. Mary even
  • thought she saw him wink his eyes as if to wink tears away.
  • “Poor little kid!” he said. “There is nobody left to come.”
  • It was in that strange and sudden way that Mary found out that she had
  • neither father nor mother left; that they had died and been carried
  • away in the night, and that the few native servants who had not died
  • also had left the house as quickly as they could get out of it, none of
  • them even remembering that there was a Missie Sahib. That was why the
  • place was so quiet. It was true that there was no one in the bungalow
  • but herself and the little rustling snake.
  • CHAPTER II
  • MISTRESS MARY QUITE CONTRARY
  • Mary had liked to look at her mother from a distance and she had
  • thought her very pretty, but as she knew very little of her she could
  • scarcely have been expected to love her or to miss her very much when
  • she was gone. She did not miss her at all, in fact, and as she was a
  • self-absorbed child she gave her entire thought to herself, as she had
  • always done. If she had been older she would no doubt have been very
  • anxious at being left alone in the world, but she was very young, and
  • as she had always been taken care of, she supposed she always would be.
  • What she thought was that she would like to know if she was going to
  • nice people, who would be polite to her and give her her own way as her
  • Ayah and the other native servants had done.
  • She knew that she was not going to stay at the English clergyman’s
  • house where she was taken at first. She did not want to stay. The
  • English clergyman was poor and he had five children nearly all the same
  • age and they wore shabby clothes and were always quarreling and
  • snatching toys from each other. Mary hated their untidy bungalow and
  • was so disagreeable to them that after the first day or two nobody
  • would play with her. By the second day they had given her a nickname
  • which made her furious.
  • It was Basil who thought of it first. Basil was a little boy with
  • impudent blue eyes and a turned-up nose, and Mary hated him. She was
  • playing by herself under a tree, just as she had been playing the day
  • the cholera broke out. She was making heaps of earth and paths for a
  • garden and Basil came and stood near to watch her. Presently he got
  • rather interested and suddenly made a suggestion.
  • “Why don’t you put a heap of stones there and pretend it is a rockery?”
  • he said. “There in the middle,” and he leaned over her to point.
  • “Go away!” cried Mary. “I don’t want boys. Go away!”
  • For a moment Basil looked angry, and then he began to tease. He was
  • always teasing his sisters. He danced round and round her and made
  • faces and sang and laughed.
  • “Mistress Mary, quite contrary,
  • How does your garden grow?
  • With silver bells, and cockle shells,
  • And marigolds all in a row.”
  • He sang it until the other children heard and laughed, too; and the
  • crosser Mary got, the more they sang “Mistress Mary, quite contrary”;
  • and after that as long as she stayed with them they called her
  • “Mistress Mary Quite Contrary” when they spoke of her to each other,
  • and often when they spoke to her.
  • “You are going to be sent home,” Basil said to her, “at the end of the
  • week. And we’re glad of it.”
  • “I am glad of it, too,” answered Mary. “Where is home?”
  • “She doesn’t know where home is!” said Basil, with seven-year-old
  • scorn. “It’s England, of course. Our grandmama lives there and our
  • sister Mabel was sent to her last year. You are not going to your
  • grandmama. You have none. You are going to your uncle. His name is Mr.
  • Archibald Craven.”
  • “I don’t know anything about him,” snapped Mary.
  • “I know you don’t,” Basil answered. “You don’t know anything. Girls
  • never do. I heard father and mother talking about him. He lives in a
  • great, big, desolate old house in the country and no one goes near him.
  • He’s so cross he won’t let them, and they wouldn’t come if he would let
  • them. He’s a hunchback, and he’s horrid.”
  • “I don’t believe you,” said Mary; and she turned her back and stuck her
  • fingers in her ears, because she would not listen any more.
  • But she thought over it a great deal afterward; and when Mrs. Crawford
  • told her that night that she was going to sail away to England in a few
  • days and go to her uncle, Mr. Archibald Craven, who lived at
  • Misselthwaite Manor, she looked so stony and stubbornly uninterested
  • that they did not know what to think about her. They tried to be kind
  • to her, but she only turned her face away when Mrs. Crawford attempted
  • to kiss her, and held herself stiffly when Mr. Crawford patted her
  • shoulder.
  • “She is such a plain child,” Mrs. Crawford said pityingly, afterward.
  • “And her mother was such a pretty creature. She had a very pretty
  • manner, too, and Mary has the most unattractive ways I ever saw in a
  • child. The children call her ‘Mistress Mary Quite Contrary,’ and though
  • it’s naughty of them, one can’t help understanding it.”
  • “Perhaps if her mother had carried her pretty face and her pretty
  • manners oftener into the nursery Mary might have learned some pretty
  • ways too. It is very sad, now the poor beautiful thing is gone, to
  • remember that many people never even knew that she had a child at all.”
  • “I believe she scarcely ever looked at her,” sighed Mrs. Crawford.
  • “When her Ayah was dead there was no one to give a thought to the
  • little thing. Think of the servants running away and leaving her all
  • alone in that deserted bungalow. Colonel McGrew said he nearly jumped
  • out of his skin when he opened the door and found her standing by
  • herself in the middle of the room.”
  • Mary made the long voyage to England under the care of an officer’s
  • wife, who was taking her children to leave them in a boarding-school.
  • She was very much absorbed in her own little boy and girl, and was
  • rather glad to hand the child over to the woman Mr. Archibald Craven
  • sent to meet her, in London. The woman was his housekeeper at
  • Misselthwaite Manor, and her name was Mrs. Medlock. She was a stout
  • woman, with very red cheeks and sharp black eyes. She wore a very
  • purple dress, a black silk mantle with jet fringe on it and a black
  • bonnet with purple velvet flowers which stuck up and trembled when she
  • moved her head. Mary did not like her at all, but as she very seldom
  • liked people there was nothing remarkable in that; besides which it was
  • very evident Mrs. Medlock did not think much of her.
  • “My word! she’s a plain little piece of goods!” she said. “And we’d
  • heard that her mother was a beauty. She hasn’t handed much of it down,
  • has she, ma’am?”
  • “Perhaps she will improve as she grows older,” the officer’s wife said
  • good-naturedly. “If she were not so sallow and had a nicer expression,
  • her features are rather good. Children alter so much.”
  • “She’ll have to alter a good deal,” answered Mrs. Medlock. “And,
  • there’s nothing likely to improve children at Misselthwaite—if you ask
  • me!”
  • They thought Mary was not listening because she was standing a little
  • apart from them at the window of the private hotel they had gone to.
  • She was watching the passing buses and cabs and people, but she heard
  • quite well and was made very curious about her uncle and the place he
  • lived in. What sort of a place was it, and what would he be like? What
  • was a hunchback? She had never seen one. Perhaps there were none in
  • India.
  • Since she had been living in other people’s houses and had had no Ayah,
  • she had begun to feel lonely and to think queer thoughts which were new
  • to her. She had begun to wonder why she had never seemed to belong to
  • anyone even when her father and mother had been alive. Other children
  • seemed to belong to their fathers and mothers, but she had never seemed
  • to really be anyone’s little girl. She had had servants, and food and
  • clothes, but no one had taken any notice of her. She did not know that
  • this was because she was a disagreeable child; but then, of course, she
  • did not know she was disagreeable. She often thought that other people
  • were, but she did not know that she was so herself.
  • She thought Mrs. Medlock the most disagreeable person she had ever
  • seen, with her common, highly colored face and her common fine bonnet.
  • When the next day they set out on their journey to Yorkshire, she
  • walked through the station to the railway carriage with her head up and
  • trying to keep as far away from her as she could, because she did not
  • want to seem to belong to her. It would have made her angry to think
  • people imagined she was her little girl.
  • But Mrs. Medlock was not in the least disturbed by her and her
  • thoughts. She was the kind of woman who would “stand no nonsense from
  • young ones.” At least, that is what she would have said if she had been
  • asked. She had not wanted to go to London just when her sister Maria’s
  • daughter was going to be married, but she had a comfortable, well paid
  • place as housekeeper at Misselthwaite Manor and the only way in which
  • she could keep it was to do at once what Mr. Archibald Craven told her
  • to do. She never dared even to ask a question.
  • “Captain Lennox and his wife died of the cholera,” Mr. Craven had said
  • in his short, cold way. “Captain Lennox was my wife’s brother and I am
  • their daughter’s guardian. The child is to be brought here. You must go
  • to London and bring her yourself.”
  • So she packed her small trunk and made the journey.
  • Mary sat in her corner of the railway carriage and looked plain and
  • fretful. She had nothing to read or to look at, and she had folded her
  • thin little black-gloved hands in her lap. Her black dress made her
  • look yellower than ever, and her limp light hair straggled from under
  • her black crêpe hat.
  • “A more marred-looking young one I never saw in my life,” Mrs. Medlock
  • thought. (Marred is a Yorkshire word and means spoiled and pettish.)
  • She had never seen a child who sat so still without doing anything; and
  • at last she got tired of watching her and began to talk in a brisk,
  • hard voice.
  • “I suppose I may as well tell you something about where you are going
  • to,” she said. “Do you know anything about your uncle?”
  • “No,” said Mary.
  • “Never heard your father and mother talk about him?”
  • “No,” said Mary frowning. She frowned because she remembered that her
  • father and mother had never talked to her about anything in particular.
  • Certainly they had never told her things.
  • “Humph,” muttered Mrs. Medlock, staring at her queer, unresponsive
  • little face. She did not say any more for a few moments and then she
  • began again.
  • “I suppose you might as well be told something—to prepare you. You are
  • going to a queer place.”
  • Mary said nothing at all, and Mrs. Medlock looked rather discomfited by
  • her apparent indifference, but, after taking a breath, she went on.
  • “Not but that it’s a grand big place in a gloomy way, and Mr. Craven’s
  • proud of it in his way—and that’s gloomy enough, too. The house is six
  • hundred years old and it’s on the edge of the moor, and there’s near a
  • hundred rooms in it, though most of them’s shut up and locked. And
  • there’s pictures and fine old furniture and things that’s been there
  • for ages, and there’s a big park round it and gardens and trees with
  • branches trailing to the ground—some of them.” She paused and took
  • another breath. “But there’s nothing else,” she ended suddenly.
  • Mary had begun to listen in spite of herself. It all sounded so unlike
  • India, and anything new rather attracted her. But she did not intend to
  • look as if she were interested. That was one of her unhappy,
  • disagreeable ways. So she sat still.
  • “Well,” said Mrs. Medlock. “What do you think of it?”
  • “Nothing,” she answered. “I know nothing about such places.”
  • That made Mrs. Medlock laugh a short sort of laugh.
  • “Eh!” she said, “but you are like an old woman. Don’t you care?”
  • “It doesn’t matter” said Mary, “whether I care or not.”
  • “You are right enough there,” said Mrs. Medlock. “It doesn’t. What
  • you’re to be kept at Misselthwaite Manor for I don’t know, unless
  • because it’s the easiest way. _He’s_ not going to trouble himself about
  • you, that’s sure and certain. He never troubles himself about no one.”
  • She stopped herself as if she had just remembered something in time.
  • “He’s got a crooked back,” she said. “That set him wrong. He was a sour
  • young man and got no good of all his money and big place till he was
  • married.”
  • Mary’s eyes turned toward her in spite of her intention not to seem to
  • care. She had never thought of the hunchback’s being married and she
  • was a trifle surprised. Mrs. Medlock saw this, and as she was a
  • talkative woman she continued with more interest. This was one way of
  • passing some of the time, at any rate.
  • “She was a sweet, pretty thing and he’d have walked the world over to
  • get her a blade o’ grass she wanted. Nobody thought she’d marry him,
  • but she did, and people said she married him for his money. But she
  • didn’t—she didn’t,” positively. “When she died—”
  • Mary gave a little involuntary jump.
  • “Oh! did she die!” she exclaimed, quite without meaning to. She had
  • just remembered a French fairy story she had once read called “Riquet à
  • la Houppe.” It had been about a poor hunchback and a beautiful princess
  • and it had made her suddenly sorry for Mr. Archibald Craven.
  • “Yes, she died,” Mrs. Medlock answered. “And it made him queerer than
  • ever. He cares about nobody. He won’t see people. Most of the time he
  • goes away, and when he is at Misselthwaite he shuts himself up in the
  • West Wing and won’t let anyone but Pitcher see him. Pitcher’s an old
  • fellow, but he took care of him when he was a child and he knows his
  • ways.”
  • It sounded like something in a book and it did not make Mary feel
  • cheerful. A house with a hundred rooms, nearly all shut up and with
  • their doors locked—a house on the edge of a moor—whatsoever a moor
  • was—sounded dreary. A man with a crooked back who shut himself up also!
  • She stared out of the window with her lips pinched together, and it
  • seemed quite natural that the rain should have begun to pour down in
  • gray slanting lines and splash and stream down the window-panes. If the
  • pretty wife had been alive she might have made things cheerful by being
  • something like her own mother and by running in and out and going to
  • parties as she had done in frocks “full of lace.” But she was not there
  • any more.
  • “You needn’t expect to see him, because ten to one you won’t,” said
  • Mrs. Medlock. “And you mustn’t expect that there will be people to talk
  • to you. You’ll have to play about and look after yourself. You’ll be
  • told what rooms you can go into and what rooms you’re to keep out of.
  • There’s gardens enough. But when you’re in the house don’t go wandering
  • and poking about. Mr. Craven won’t have it.”
  • “I shall not want to go poking about,” said sour little Mary and just
  • as suddenly as she had begun to be rather sorry for Mr. Archibald
  • Craven she began to cease to be sorry and to think he was unpleasant
  • enough to deserve all that had happened to him.
  • And she turned her face toward the streaming panes of the window of the
  • railway carriage and gazed out at the gray rain-storm which looked as
  • if it would go on forever and ever. She watched it so long and steadily
  • that the grayness grew heavier and heavier before her eyes and she fell
  • asleep.
  • CHAPTER III
  • ACROSS THE MOOR
  • She slept a long time, and when she awakened Mrs. Medlock had bought a
  • lunchbasket at one of the stations and they had some chicken and cold
  • beef and bread and butter and some hot tea. The rain seemed to be
  • streaming down more heavily than ever and everybody in the station wore
  • wet and glistening waterproofs. The guard lighted the lamps in the
  • carriage, and Mrs. Medlock cheered up very much over her tea and
  • chicken and beef. She ate a great deal and afterward fell asleep
  • herself, and Mary sat and stared at her and watched her fine bonnet
  • slip on one side until she herself fell asleep once more in the corner
  • of the carriage, lulled by the splashing of the rain against the
  • windows. It was quite dark when she awakened again. The train had
  • stopped at a station and Mrs. Medlock was shaking her.
  • “You have had a sleep!” she said. “It’s time to open your eyes! We’re
  • at Thwaite Station and we’ve got a long drive before us.”
  • Mary stood up and tried to keep her eyes open while Mrs. Medlock
  • collected her parcels. The little girl did not offer to help her,
  • because in India native servants always picked up or carried things and
  • it seemed quite proper that other people should wait on one.
  • The station was a small one and nobody but themselves seemed to be
  • getting out of the train. The station-master spoke to Mrs. Medlock in a
  • rough, good-natured way, pronouncing his words in a queer broad fashion
  • which Mary found out afterward was Yorkshire.
  • “I see tha’s got back,” he said. “An’ tha’s browt th’ young ’un with
  • thee.”
  • “Aye, that’s her,” answered Mrs. Medlock, speaking with a Yorkshire
  • accent herself and jerking her head over her shoulder toward Mary.
  • “How’s thy Missus?”
  • “Well enow. Th’ carriage is waitin’ outside for thee.”
  • A brougham stood on the road before the little outside platform. Mary
  • saw that it was a smart carriage and that it was a smart footman who
  • helped her in. His long waterproof coat and the waterproof covering of
  • his hat were shining and dripping with rain as everything was, the
  • burly station-master included.
  • When he shut the door, mounted the box with the coachman, and they
  • drove off, the little girl found herself seated in a comfortably
  • cushioned corner, but she was not inclined to go to sleep again. She
  • sat and looked out of the window, curious to see something of the road
  • over which she was being driven to the queer place Mrs. Medlock had
  • spoken of. She was not at all a timid child and she was not exactly
  • frightened, but she felt that there was no knowing what might happen in
  • a house with a hundred rooms nearly all shut up—a house standing on the
  • edge of a moor.
  • “What is a moor?” she said suddenly to Mrs. Medlock.
  • “Look out of the window in about ten minutes and you’ll see,” the woman
  • answered. “We’ve got to drive five miles across Missel Moor before we
  • get to the Manor. You won’t see much because it’s a dark night, but you
  • can see something.”
  • Mary asked no more questions but waited in the darkness of her corner,
  • keeping her eyes on the window. The carriage lamps cast rays of light a
  • little distance ahead of them and she caught glimpses of the things
  • they passed. After they had left the station they had driven through a
  • tiny village and she had seen whitewashed cottages and the lights of a
  • public house. Then they had passed a church and a vicarage and a little
  • shop-window or so in a cottage with toys and sweets and odd things set
  • out for sale. Then they were on the highroad and she saw hedges and
  • trees. After that there seemed nothing different for a long time—or at
  • least it seemed a long time to her.
  • At last the horses began to go more slowly, as if they were climbing
  • up-hill, and presently there seemed to be no more hedges and no more
  • trees. She could see nothing, in fact, but a dense darkness on either
  • side. She leaned forward and pressed her face against the window just
  • as the carriage gave a big jolt.
  • “Eh! We’re on the moor now sure enough,” said Mrs. Medlock.
  • The carriage lamps shed a yellow light on a rough-looking road which
  • seemed to be cut through bushes and low-growing things which ended in
  • the great expanse of dark apparently spread out before and around them.
  • A wind was rising and making a singular, wild, low, rushing sound.
  • “It’s—it’s not the sea, is it?” said Mary, looking round at her
  • companion.
  • “No, not it,” answered Mrs. Medlock. “Nor it isn’t fields nor
  • mountains, it’s just miles and miles and miles of wild land that
  • nothing grows on but heather and gorse and broom, and nothing lives on
  • but wild ponies and sheep.”
  • “I feel as if it might be the sea, if there were water on it,” said
  • Mary. “It sounds like the sea just now.”
  • “That’s the wind blowing through the bushes,” Mrs. Medlock said. “It’s
  • a wild, dreary enough place to my mind, though there’s plenty that
  • likes it—particularly when the heather’s in bloom.”
  • On and on they drove through the darkness, and though the rain stopped,
  • the wind rushed by and whistled and made strange sounds. The road went
  • up and down, and several times the carriage passed over a little bridge
  • beneath which water rushed very fast with a great deal of noise. Mary
  • felt as if the drive would never come to an end and that the wide,
  • bleak moor was a wide expanse of black ocean through which she was
  • passing on a strip of dry land.
  • “I don’t like it,” she said to herself. “I don’t like it,” and she
  • pinched her thin lips more tightly together.
  • The horses were climbing up a hilly piece of road when she first caught
  • sight of a light. Mrs. Medlock saw it as soon as she did and drew a
  • long sigh of relief.
  • “Eh, I am glad to see that bit o’ light twinkling,” she exclaimed.
  • “It’s the light in the lodge window. We shall get a good cup of tea
  • after a bit, at all events.”
  • It was “after a bit,” as she said, for when the carriage passed through
  • the park gates there was still two miles of avenue to drive through and
  • the trees (which nearly met overhead) made it seem as if they were
  • driving through a long dark vault.
  • They drove out of the vault into a clear space and stopped before an
  • immensely long but low-built house which seemed to ramble round a stone
  • court. At first Mary thought that there were no lights at all in the
  • windows, but as she got out of the carriage she saw that one room in a
  • corner upstairs showed a dull glow.
  • The entrance door was a huge one made of massive, curiously shaped
  • panels of oak studded with big iron nails and bound with great iron
  • bars. It opened into an enormous hall, which was so dimly lighted that
  • the faces in the portraits on the walls and the figures in the suits of
  • armor made Mary feel that she did not want to look at them. As she
  • stood on the stone floor she looked a very small, odd little black
  • figure, and she felt as small and lost and odd as she looked.
  • A neat, thin old man stood near the manservant who opened the door for
  • them.
  • “You are to take her to her room,” he said in a husky voice. “He
  • doesn’t want to see her. He’s going to London in the morning.”
  • “Very well, Mr. Pitcher,” Mrs. Medlock answered. “So long as I know
  • what’s expected of me, I can manage.”
  • “What’s expected of you, Mrs. Medlock,” Mr. Pitcher said, “is that you
  • make sure that he’s not disturbed and that he doesn’t see what he
  • doesn’t want to see.”
  • And then Mary Lennox was led up a broad staircase and down a long
  • corridor and up a short flight of steps and through another corridor
  • and another, until a door opened in a wall and she found herself in a
  • room with a fire in it and a supper on a table.
  • Mrs. Medlock said unceremoniously:
  • “Well, here you are! This room and the next are where you’ll live—and
  • you must keep to them. Don’t you forget that!”
  • It was in this way Mistress Mary arrived at Misselthwaite Manor and she
  • had perhaps never felt quite so contrary in all her life.
  • CHAPTER IV
  • MARTHA
  • When she opened her eyes in the morning it was because a young
  • housemaid had come into her room to light the fire and was kneeling on
  • the hearth-rug raking out the cinders noisily. Mary lay and watched her
  • for a few moments and then began to look about the room. She had never
  • seen a room at all like it and thought it curious and gloomy. The walls
  • were covered with tapestry with a forest scene embroidered on it. There
  • were fantastically dressed people under the trees and in the distance
  • there was a glimpse of the turrets of a castle. There were hunters and
  • horses and dogs and ladies. Mary felt as if she were in the forest with
  • them. Out of a deep window she could see a great climbing stretch of
  • land which seemed to have no trees on it, and to look rather like an
  • endless, dull, purplish sea.
  • “What is that?” she said, pointing out of the window.
  • Martha, the young housemaid, who had just risen to her feet, looked and
  • pointed also.
  • “That there?” she said.
  • “Yes.”
  • “That’s th’ moor,” with a good-natured grin. “Does tha’ like it?”
  • “No,” answered Mary. “I hate it.”
  • “That’s because tha’rt not used to it,” Martha said, going back to her
  • hearth. “Tha’ thinks it’s too big an’ bare now. But tha’ will like it.”
  • “Do you?” inquired Mary.
  • “Aye, that I do,” answered Martha, cheerfully polishing away at the
  • grate. “I just love it. It’s none bare. It’s covered wi’ growin’ things
  • as smells sweet. It’s fair lovely in spring an’ summer when th’ gorse
  • an’ broom an’ heather’s in flower. It smells o’ honey an’ there’s such
  • a lot o’ fresh air—an’ th’ sky looks so high an’ th’ bees an’ skylarks
  • makes such a nice noise hummin’ an’ singin’. Eh! I wouldn’t live away
  • from th’ moor for anythin’.”
  • Mary listened to her with a grave, puzzled expression. The native
  • servants she had been used to in India were not in the least like this.
  • They were obsequious and servile and did not presume to talk to their
  • masters as if they were their equals. They made salaams and called them
  • “protector of the poor” and names of that sort. Indian servants were
  • commanded to do things, not asked. It was not the custom to say
  • “please” and “thank you” and Mary had always slapped her Ayah in the
  • face when she was angry. She wondered a little what this girl would do
  • if one slapped her in the face. She was a round, rosy, good-natured
  • looking creature, but she had a sturdy way which made Mistress Mary
  • wonder if she might not even slap back—if the person who slapped her
  • was only a little girl.
  • “You are a strange servant,” she said from her pillows, rather
  • haughtily.
  • Martha sat up on her heels, with her blacking-brush in her hand, and
  • laughed, without seeming the least out of temper.
  • “Eh! I know that,” she said. “If there was a grand Missus at
  • Misselthwaite I should never have been even one of th’ under
  • housemaids. I might have been let to be scullerymaid but I’d never have
  • been let upstairs. I’m too common an’ I talk too much Yorkshire. But
  • this is a funny house for all it’s so grand. Seems like there’s neither
  • Master nor Mistress except Mr. Pitcher an’ Mrs. Medlock. Mr. Craven, he
  • won’t be troubled about anythin’ when he’s here, an’ he’s nearly always
  • away. Mrs. Medlock gave me th’ place out o’ kindness. She told me she
  • could never have done it if Misselthwaite had been like other big
  • houses.”
  • “Are you going to be my servant?” Mary asked, still in her imperious
  • little Indian way.
  • Martha began to rub her grate again.
  • “I’m Mrs. Medlock’s servant,” she said stoutly. “An’ she’s Mr.
  • Craven’s—but I’m to do the housemaid’s work up here an’ wait on you a
  • bit. But you won’t need much waitin’ on.”
  • “Who is going to dress me?” demanded Mary.
  • Martha sat up on her heels again and stared. She spoke in broad
  • Yorkshire in her amazement.
  • “Canna’ tha’ dress thysen!” she said.
  • “What do you mean? I don’t understand your language,” said Mary.
  • “Eh! I forgot,” Martha said. “Mrs. Medlock told me I’d have to be
  • careful or you wouldn’t know what I was sayin’. I mean can’t you put on
  • your own clothes?”
  • “No,” answered Mary, quite indignantly. “I never did in my life. My
  • Ayah dressed me, of course.”
  • “Well,” said Martha, evidently not in the least aware that she was
  • impudent, “it’s time tha’ should learn. Tha’ cannot begin younger.
  • It’ll do thee good to wait on thysen a bit. My mother always said she
  • couldn’t see why grand people’s children didn’t turn out fair
  • fools—what with nurses an’ bein’ washed an’ dressed an’ took out to
  • walk as if they was puppies!”
  • “It is different in India,” said Mistress Mary disdainfully. She could
  • scarcely stand this.
  • But Martha was not at all crushed.
  • “Eh! I can see it’s different,” she answered almost sympathetically. “I
  • dare say it’s because there’s such a lot o’ blacks there instead o’
  • respectable white people. When I heard you was comin’ from India I
  • thought you was a black too.”
  • Mary sat up in bed furious.
  • “What!” she said. “What! You thought I was a native. You—you daughter
  • of a pig!”
  • Martha stared and looked hot.
  • “Who are you callin’ names?” she said. “You needn’t be so vexed. That’s
  • not th’ way for a young lady to talk. I’ve nothin’ against th’ blacks.
  • When you read about ’em in tracts they’re always very religious. You
  • always read as a black’s a man an’ a brother. I’ve never seen a black
  • an’ I was fair pleased to think I was goin’ to see one close. When I
  • come in to light your fire this mornin’ I crep’ up to your bed an’
  • pulled th’ cover back careful to look at you. An’ there you was,”
  • disappointedly, “no more black than me—for all you’re so yeller.”
  • Mary did not even try to control her rage and humiliation.
  • “You thought I was a native! You dared! You don’t know anything about
  • natives! They are not people—they’re servants who must salaam to you.
  • You know nothing about India. You know nothing about anything!”
  • She was in such a rage and felt so helpless before the girl’s simple
  • stare, and somehow she suddenly felt so horribly lonely and far away
  • from everything she understood and which understood her, that she threw
  • herself face downward on the pillows and burst into passionate sobbing.
  • She sobbed so unrestrainedly that good-natured Yorkshire Martha was a
  • little frightened and quite sorry for her. She went to the bed and bent
  • over her.
  • “Eh! you mustn’t cry like that there!” she begged. “You mustn’t for
  • sure. I didn’t know you’d be vexed. I don’t know anythin’ about
  • anythin’—just like you said. I beg your pardon, Miss. Do stop cryin’.”
  • There was something comforting and really friendly in her queer
  • Yorkshire speech and sturdy way which had a good effect on Mary. She
  • gradually ceased crying and became quiet. Martha looked relieved.
  • “It’s time for thee to get up now,” she said. “Mrs. Medlock said I was
  • to carry tha’ breakfast an’ tea an’ dinner into th’ room next to this.
  • It’s been made into a nursery for thee. I’ll help thee on with thy
  • clothes if tha’ll get out o’ bed. If th’ buttons are at th’ back tha’
  • cannot button them up tha’self.”
  • When Mary at last decided to get up, the clothes Martha took from the
  • wardrobe were not the ones she had worn when she arrived the night
  • before with Mrs. Medlock.
  • “Those are not mine,” she said. “Mine are black.”
  • She looked the thick white wool coat and dress over, and added with
  • cool approval:
  • “Those are nicer than mine.”
  • “These are th’ ones tha’ must put on,” Martha answered. “Mr. Craven
  • ordered Mrs. Medlock to get ’em in London. He said ‘I won’t have a
  • child dressed in black wanderin’ about like a lost soul,’ he said.
  • ‘It’d make the place sadder than it is. Put color on her.’ Mother she
  • said she knew what he meant. Mother always knows what a body means. She
  • doesn’t hold with black hersel’.”
  • “I hate black things,” said Mary.
  • The dressing process was one which taught them both something. Martha
  • had “buttoned up” her little sisters and brothers but she had never
  • seen a child who stood still and waited for another person to do things
  • for her as if she had neither hands nor feet of her own.
  • “Why doesn’t tha’ put on tha’ own shoes?” she said when Mary quietly
  • held out her foot.
  • “My Ayah did it,” answered Mary, staring. “It was the custom.”
  • She said that very often—“It was the custom.” The native servants were
  • always saying it. If one told them to do a thing their ancestors had
  • not done for a thousand years they gazed at one mildly and said, “It is
  • not the custom” and one knew that was the end of the matter.
  • It had not been the custom that Mistress Mary should do anything but
  • stand and allow herself to be dressed like a doll, but before she was
  • ready for breakfast she began to suspect that her life at Misselthwaite
  • Manor would end by teaching her a number of things quite new to
  • her—things such as putting on her own shoes and stockings, and picking
  • up things she let fall. If Martha had been a well-trained fine young
  • lady’s maid she would have been more subservient and respectful and
  • would have known that it was her business to brush hair, and button
  • boots, and pick things up and lay them away. She was, however, only an
  • untrained Yorkshire rustic who had been brought up in a moorland
  • cottage with a swarm of little brothers and sisters who had never
  • dreamed of doing anything but waiting on themselves and on the younger
  • ones who were either babies in arms or just learning to totter about
  • and tumble over things.
  • If Mary Lennox had been a child who was ready to be amused she would
  • perhaps have laughed at Martha’s readiness to talk, but Mary only
  • listened to her coldly and wondered at her freedom of manner. At first
  • she was not at all interested, but gradually, as the girl rattled on in
  • her good-tempered, homely way, Mary began to notice what she was
  • saying.
  • “Eh! you should see ’em all,” she said. “There’s twelve of us an’ my
  • father only gets sixteen shilling a week. I can tell you my mother’s
  • put to it to get porridge for ’em all. They tumble about on th’ moor
  • an’ play there all day an’ mother says th’ air of th’ moor fattens ’em.
  • She says she believes they eat th’ grass same as th’ wild ponies do.
  • Our Dickon, he’s twelve years old and he’s got a young pony he calls
  • his own.”
  • “Where did he get it?” asked Mary.
  • “He found it on th’ moor with its mother when it was a little one an’
  • he began to make friends with it an’ give it bits o’ bread an’ pluck
  • young grass for it. And it got to like him so it follows him about an’
  • it lets him get on its back. Dickon’s a kind lad an’ animals likes
  • him.”
  • Mary had never possessed an animal pet of her own and had always
  • thought she should like one. So she began to feel a slight interest in
  • Dickon, and as she had never before been interested in anyone but
  • herself, it was the dawning of a healthy sentiment. When she went into
  • the room which had been made into a nursery for her, she found that it
  • was rather like the one she had slept in. It was not a child’s room,
  • but a grown-up person’s room, with gloomy old pictures on the walls and
  • heavy old oak chairs. A table in the center was set with a good
  • substantial breakfast. But she had always had a very small appetite,
  • and she looked with something more than indifference at the first plate
  • Martha set before her.
  • “I don’t want it,” she said.
  • “Tha’ doesn’t want thy porridge!” Martha exclaimed incredulously.
  • “No.”
  • “Tha’ doesn’t know how good it is. Put a bit o’ treacle on it or a bit
  • o’ sugar.”
  • “I don’t want it,” repeated Mary.
  • “Eh!” said Martha. “I can’t abide to see good victuals go to waste. If
  • our children was at this table they’d clean it bare in five minutes.”
  • “Why?” said Mary coldly.
  • “Why!” echoed Martha. “Because they scarce ever had their stomachs full
  • in their lives. They’re as hungry as young hawks an’ foxes.”
  • “I don’t know what it is to be hungry,” said Mary, with the
  • indifference of ignorance.
  • Martha looked indignant.
  • “Well, it would do thee good to try it. I can see that plain enough,”
  • she said outspokenly. “I’ve no patience with folk as sits an’ just
  • stares at good bread an’ meat. My word! don’t I wish Dickon and Phil
  • an’ Jane an’ th’ rest of ’em had what’s here under their pinafores.”
  • “Why don’t you take it to them?” suggested Mary.
  • “It’s not mine,” answered Martha stoutly. “An’ this isn’t my day out. I
  • get my day out once a month same as th’ rest. Then I go home an’ clean
  • up for mother an’ give her a day’s rest.”
  • Mary drank some tea and ate a little toast and some marmalade.
  • “You wrap up warm an’ run out an’ play you,” said Martha. “It’ll do you
  • good and give you some stomach for your meat.”
  • Mary went to the window. There were gardens and paths and big trees,
  • but everything looked dull and wintry.
  • “Out? Why should I go out on a day like this?”
  • “Well, if tha’ doesn’t go out tha’lt have to stay in, an’ what has tha’
  • got to do?”
  • Mary glanced about her. There was nothing to do. When Mrs. Medlock had
  • prepared the nursery she had not thought of amusement. Perhaps it would
  • be better to go and see what the gardens were like.
  • “Who will go with me?” she inquired.
  • Martha stared.
  • “You’ll go by yourself,” she answered. “You’ll have to learn to play
  • like other children does when they haven’t got sisters and brothers.
  • Our Dickon goes off on th’ moor by himself an’ plays for hours. That’s
  • how he made friends with th’ pony. He’s got sheep on th’ moor that
  • knows him, an’ birds as comes an’ eats out of his hand. However little
  • there is to eat, he always saves a bit o’ his bread to coax his pets.”
  • It was really this mention of Dickon which made Mary decide to go out,
  • though she was not aware of it. There would be, birds outside though
  • there would not be ponies or sheep. They would be different from the
  • birds in India and it might amuse her to look at them.
  • Martha found her coat and hat for her and a pair of stout little boots
  • and she showed her her way downstairs.
  • “If tha’ goes round that way tha’ll come to th’ gardens,” she said,
  • pointing to a gate in a wall of shrubbery. “There’s lots o’ flowers in
  • summer-time, but there’s nothin’ bloomin’ now.” She seemed to hesitate
  • a second before she added, “One of th’ gardens is locked up. No one has
  • been in it for ten years.”
  • “Why?” asked Mary in spite of herself. Here was another locked door
  • added to the hundred in the strange house.
  • “Mr. Craven had it shut when his wife died so sudden. He won’t let no
  • one go inside. It was her garden. He locked th’ door an’ dug a hole and
  • buried th’ key. There’s Mrs. Medlock’s bell ringing—I must run.”
  • After she was gone Mary turned down the walk which led to the door in
  • the shrubbery. She could not help thinking about the garden which no
  • one had been into for ten years. She wondered what it would look like
  • and whether there were any flowers still alive in it. When she had
  • passed through the shrubbery gate she found herself in great gardens,
  • with wide lawns and winding walks with clipped borders. There were
  • trees, and flower-beds, and evergreens clipped into strange shapes, and
  • a large pool with an old gray fountain in its midst. But the
  • flower-beds were bare and wintry and the fountain was not playing. This
  • was not the garden which was shut up. How could a garden be shut up?
  • You could always walk into a garden.
  • She was just thinking this when she saw that, at the end of the path
  • she was following, there seemed to be a long wall, with ivy growing
  • over it. She was not familiar enough with England to know that she was
  • coming upon the kitchen-gardens where the vegetables and fruit were
  • growing. She went toward the wall and found that there was a green door
  • in the ivy, and that it stood open. This was not the closed garden,
  • evidently, and she could go into it.
  • She went through the door and found that it was a garden with walls all
  • round it and that it was only one of several walled gardens which
  • seemed to open into one another. She saw another open green door,
  • revealing bushes and pathways between beds containing winter
  • vegetables. Fruit-trees were trained flat against the wall, and over
  • some of the beds there were glass frames. The place was bare and ugly
  • enough, Mary thought, as she stood and stared about her. It might be
  • nicer in summer when things were green, but there was nothing pretty
  • about it now.
  • Presently an old man with a spade over his shoulder walked through the
  • door leading from the second garden. He looked startled when he saw
  • Mary, and then touched his cap. He had a surly old face, and did not
  • seem at all pleased to see her—but then she was displeased with his
  • garden and wore her “quite contrary” expression, and certainly did not
  • seem at all pleased to see him.
  • “What is this place?” she asked.
  • “One o’ th’ kitchen-gardens,” he answered.
  • “What is that?” said Mary, pointing through the other green door.
  • “Another of ’em,” shortly. “There’s another on t’other side o’ th’ wall
  • an’ there’s th’ orchard t’other side o’ that.”
  • “Can I go in them?” asked Mary.
  • “If tha’ likes. But there’s nowt to see.”
  • Mary made no response. She went down the path and through the second
  • green door. There, she found more walls and winter vegetables and glass
  • frames, but in the second wall there was another green door and it was
  • not open. Perhaps it led into the garden which no one had seen for ten
  • years. As she was not at all a timid child and always did what she
  • wanted to do, Mary went to the green door and turned the handle. She
  • hoped the door would not open because she wanted to be sure she had
  • found the mysterious garden—but it did open quite easily and she walked
  • through it and found herself in an orchard. There were walls all round
  • it also and trees trained against them, and there were bare fruit-trees
  • growing in the winter-browned grass—but there was no green door to be
  • seen anywhere. Mary looked for it, and yet when she had entered the
  • upper end of the garden she had noticed that the wall did not seem to
  • end with the orchard but to extend beyond it as if it enclosed a place
  • at the other side. She could see the tops of trees above the wall, and
  • when she stood still she saw a bird with a bright red breast sitting on
  • the topmost branch of one of them, and suddenly he burst into his
  • winter song—almost as if he had caught sight of her and was calling to
  • her.
  • She stopped and listened to him and somehow his cheerful, friendly
  • little whistle gave her a pleased feeling—even a disagreeable little
  • girl may be lonely, and the big closed house and big bare moor and big
  • bare gardens had made this one feel as if there was no one left in the
  • world but herself. If she had been an affectionate child, who had been
  • used to being loved, she would have broken her heart, but even though
  • she was “Mistress Mary Quite Contrary” she was desolate, and the
  • bright-breasted little bird brought a look into her sour little face
  • which was almost a smile. She listened to him until he flew away. He
  • was not like an Indian bird and she liked him and wondered if she
  • should ever see him again. Perhaps he lived in the mysterious garden
  • and knew all about it.
  • Perhaps it was because she had nothing whatever to do that she thought
  • so much of the deserted garden. She was curious about it and wanted to
  • see what it was like. Why had Mr. Archibald Craven buried the key? If
  • he had liked his wife so much why did he hate her garden? She wondered
  • if she should ever see him, but she knew that if she did she should not
  • like him, and he would not like her, and that she should only stand and
  • stare at him and say nothing, though she should be wanting dreadfully
  • to ask him why he had done such a queer thing.
  • “People never like me and I never like people,” she thought. “And I
  • never can talk as the Crawford children could. They were always talking
  • and laughing and making noises.”
  • She thought of the robin and of the way he seemed to sing his song at
  • her, and as she remembered the tree-top he perched on she stopped
  • rather suddenly on the path.
  • “I believe that tree was in the secret garden—I feel sure it was,” she
  • said. “There was a wall round the place and there was no door.”
  • She walked back into the first kitchen-garden she had entered and found
  • the old man digging there. She went and stood beside him and watched
  • him a few moments in her cold little way. He took no notice of her and
  • so at last she spoke to him.
  • “I have been into the other gardens,” she said.
  • “There was nothin’ to prevent thee,” he answered crustily.
  • “I went into the orchard.”
  • “There was no dog at th’ door to bite thee,” he answered.
  • “There was no door there into the other garden,” said Mary.
  • “What garden?” he said in a rough voice, stopping his digging for a
  • moment.
  • “The one on the other side of the wall,” answered Mistress Mary. “There
  • are trees there—I saw the tops of them. A bird with a red breast was
  • sitting on one of them and he sang.”
  • To her surprise the surly old weather-beaten face actually changed its
  • expression. A slow smile spread over it and the gardener looked quite
  • different. It made her think that it was curious how much nicer a
  • person looked when he smiled. She had not thought of it before.
  • He turned about to the orchard side of his garden and began to
  • whistle—a low soft whistle. She could not understand how such a surly
  • man could make such a coaxing sound.
  • Almost the next moment a wonderful thing happened. She heard a soft
  • little rushing flight through the air—and it was the bird with the red
  • breast flying to them, and he actually alighted on the big clod of
  • earth quite near to the gardener’s foot.
  • “Here he is,” chuckled the old man, and then he spoke to the bird as if
  • he were speaking to a child.
  • “Where has tha’ been, tha’ cheeky little beggar?” he said. “I’ve not
  • seen thee before today. Has tha begun tha’ courtin’ this early in th’
  • season? Tha’rt too forrad.”
  • The bird put his tiny head on one side and looked up at him with his
  • soft bright eye which was like a black dewdrop. He seemed quite
  • familiar and not the least afraid. He hopped about and pecked the earth
  • briskly, looking for seeds and insects. It actually gave Mary a queer
  • feeling in her heart, because he was so pretty and cheerful and seemed
  • so like a person. He had a tiny plump body and a delicate beak, and
  • slender delicate legs.
  • “Will he always come when you call him?” she asked almost in a whisper.
  • “Aye, that he will. I’ve knowed him ever since he was a fledgling. He
  • come out of th’ nest in th’ other garden an’ when first he flew over
  • th’ wall he was too weak to fly back for a few days an’ we got
  • friendly. When he went over th’ wall again th’ rest of th’ brood was
  • gone an’ he was lonely an’ he come back to me.”
  • “What kind of a bird is he?” Mary asked.
  • “Doesn’t tha’ know? He’s a robin redbreast an’ they’re th’ friendliest,
  • curiousest birds alive. They’re almost as friendly as dogs—if you know
  • how to get on with ’em. Watch him peckin’ about there an’ lookin’ round
  • at us now an’ again. He knows we’re talkin’ about him.”
  • It was the queerest thing in the world to see the old fellow. He looked
  • at the plump little scarlet-waistcoated bird as if he were both proud
  • and fond of him.
  • “He’s a conceited one,” he chuckled. “He likes to hear folk talk about
  • him. An’ curious—bless me, there never was his like for curiosity an’
  • meddlin’. He’s always comin’ to see what I’m plantin’. He knows all th’
  • things Mester Craven never troubles hissel’ to find out. He’s th’ head
  • gardener, he is.”
  • The robin hopped about busily pecking the soil and now and then stopped
  • and looked at them a little. Mary thought his black dewdrop eyes gazed
  • at her with great curiosity. It really seemed as if he were finding out
  • all about her. The queer feeling in her heart increased.
  • “Where did the rest of the brood fly to?” she asked.
  • “There’s no knowin’. The old ones turn ’em out o’ their nest an’ make
  • ’em fly an’ they’re scattered before you know it. This one was a
  • knowin’ one an’ he knew he was lonely.”
  • Mistress Mary went a step nearer to the robin and looked at him very
  • hard.
  • “I’m lonely,” she said.
  • She had not known before that this was one of the things which made her
  • feel sour and cross. She seemed to find it out when the robin looked at
  • her and she looked at the robin.
  • The old gardener pushed his cap back on his bald head and stared at her
  • a minute.
  • “Art tha’ th’ little wench from India?” he asked.
  • Mary nodded.
  • “Then no wonder tha’rt lonely. Tha’lt be lonlier before tha’s done,” he
  • said.
  • He began to dig again, driving his spade deep into the rich black
  • garden soil while the robin hopped about very busily employed.
  • “What is your name?” Mary inquired.
  • He stood up to answer her.
  • “Ben Weatherstaff,” he answered, and then he added with a surly
  • chuckle, “I’m lonely mysel’ except when he’s with me,” and he jerked
  • his thumb toward the robin. “He’s th’ only friend I’ve got.”
  • “I have no friends at all,” said Mary. “I never had. My Ayah didn’t
  • like me and I never played with anyone.”
  • It is a Yorkshire habit to say what you think with blunt frankness, and
  • old Ben Weatherstaff was a Yorkshire moor man.
  • “Tha’ an’ me are a good bit alike,” he said. “We was wove out of th’
  • same cloth. We’re neither of us good lookin’ an’ we’re both of us as
  • sour as we look. We’ve got the same nasty tempers, both of us, I’ll
  • warrant.”
  • This was plain speaking, and Mary Lennox had never heard the truth
  • about herself in her life. Native servants always salaamed and
  • submitted to you, whatever you did. She had never thought much about
  • her looks, but she wondered if she was as unattractive as Ben
  • Weatherstaff and she also wondered if she looked as sour as he had
  • looked before the robin came. She actually began to wonder also if she
  • was “nasty tempered.” She felt uncomfortable.
  • Suddenly a clear rippling little sound broke out near her and she
  • turned round. She was standing a few feet from a young apple-tree and
  • the robin had flown on to one of its branches and had burst out into a
  • scrap of a song. Ben Weatherstaff laughed outright.
  • “What did he do that for?” asked Mary.
  • “He’s made up his mind to make friends with thee,” replied Ben. “Dang
  • me if he hasn’t took a fancy to thee.”
  • “To me?” said Mary, and she moved toward the little tree softly and
  • looked up.
  • “Would you make friends with me?” she said to the robin just as if she
  • was speaking to a person. “Would you?” And she did not say it either in
  • her hard little voice or in her imperious Indian voice, but in a tone
  • so soft and eager and coaxing that Ben Weatherstaff was as surprised as
  • she had been when she heard him whistle.
  • “Why,” he cried out, “tha’ said that as nice an’ human as if tha’ was a
  • real child instead of a sharp old woman. Tha’ said it almost like
  • Dickon talks to his wild things on th’ moor.”
  • “Do you know Dickon?” Mary asked, turning round rather in a hurry.
  • “Everybody knows him. Dickon’s wanderin’ about everywhere. Th’ very
  • blackberries an’ heather-bells knows him. I warrant th’ foxes shows him
  • where their cubs lies an’ th’ skylarks doesn’t hide their nests from
  • him.”
  • Mary would have liked to ask some more questions. She was almost as
  • curious about Dickon as she was about the deserted garden. But just
  • that moment the robin, who had ended his song, gave a little shake of
  • his wings, spread them and flew away. He had made his visit and had
  • other things to do.
  • “He has flown over the wall!” Mary cried out, watching him. “He has
  • flown into the orchard—he has flown across the other wall—into the
  • garden where there is no door!”
  • “He lives there,” said old Ben. “He came out o’ th’ egg there. If he’s
  • courtin’, he’s makin’ up to some young madam of a robin that lives
  • among th’ old rose-trees there.”
  • “Rose-trees,” said Mary. “Are there rose-trees?”
  • Ben Weatherstaff took up his spade again and began to dig.
  • “There was ten year’ ago,” he mumbled.
  • “I should like to see them,” said Mary. “Where is the green door? There
  • must be a door somewhere.”
  • Ben drove his spade deep and looked as uncompanionable as he had looked
  • when she first saw him.
  • “There was ten year’ ago, but there isn’t now,” he said.
  • “No door!” cried Mary. “There must be.”
  • “None as anyone can find, an’ none as is anyone’s business. Don’t you
  • be a meddlesome wench an’ poke your nose where it’s no cause to go.
  • Here, I must go on with my work. Get you gone an’ play you. I’ve no
  • more time.”
  • And he actually stopped digging, threw his spade over his shoulder and
  • walked off, without even glancing at her or saying good-by.
  • CHAPTER V
  • THE CRY IN THE CORRIDOR
  • At first each day which passed by for Mary Lennox was exactly like the
  • others. Every morning she awoke in her tapestried room and found Martha
  • kneeling upon the hearth building her fire; every morning she ate her
  • breakfast in the nursery which had nothing amusing in it; and after
  • each breakfast she gazed out of the window across to the huge moor
  • which seemed to spread out on all sides and climb up to the sky, and
  • after she had stared for a while she realized that if she did not go
  • out she would have to stay in and do nothing—and so she went out. She
  • did not know that this was the best thing she could have done, and she
  • did not know that, when she began to walk quickly or even run along the
  • paths and down the avenue, she was stirring her slow blood and making
  • herself stronger by fighting with the wind which swept down from the
  • moor. She ran only to make herself warm, and she hated the wind which
  • rushed at her face and roared and held her back as if it were some
  • giant she could not see. But the big breaths of rough fresh air blown
  • over the heather filled her lungs with something which was good for her
  • whole thin body and whipped some red color into her cheeks and
  • brightened her dull eyes when she did not know anything about it.
  • But after a few days spent almost entirely out of doors she wakened one
  • morning knowing what it was to be hungry, and when she sat down to her
  • breakfast she did not glance disdainfully at her porridge and push it
  • away, but took up her spoon and began to eat it and went on eating it
  • until her bowl was empty.
  • “Tha’ got on well enough with that this mornin’, didn’t tha’?” said
  • Martha.
  • “It tastes nice today,” said Mary, feeling a little surprised herself.
  • “It’s th’ air of th’ moor that’s givin’ thee stomach for tha’
  • victuals,” answered Martha. “It’s lucky for thee that tha’s got
  • victuals as well as appetite. There’s been twelve in our cottage as had
  • th’ stomach an’ nothin’ to put in it. You go on playin’ you out o’
  • doors every day an’ you’ll get some flesh on your bones an’ you won’t
  • be so yeller.”
  • “I don’t play,” said Mary. “I have nothing to play with.”
  • “Nothin’ to play with!” exclaimed Martha. “Our children plays with
  • sticks and stones. They just runs about an’ shouts an’ looks at
  • things.” Mary did not shout, but she looked at things. There was
  • nothing else to do. She walked round and round the gardens and wandered
  • about the paths in the park. Sometimes she looked for Ben Weatherstaff,
  • but though several times she saw him at work he was too busy to look at
  • her or was too surly. Once when she was walking toward him he picked up
  • his spade and turned away as if he did it on purpose.
  • One place she went to oftener than to any other. It was the long walk
  • outside the gardens with the walls round them. There were bare
  • flower-beds on either side of it and against the walls ivy grew
  • thickly. There was one part of the wall where the creeping dark green
  • leaves were more bushy than elsewhere. It seemed as if for a long time
  • that part had been neglected. The rest of it had been clipped and made
  • to look neat, but at this lower end of the walk it had not been trimmed
  • at all.
  • A few days after she had talked to Ben Weatherstaff, Mary stopped to
  • notice this and wondered why it was so. She had just paused and was
  • looking up at a long spray of ivy swinging in the wind when she saw a
  • gleam of scarlet and heard a brilliant chirp, and there, on the top of
  • the wall, perched Ben Weatherstaff’s robin redbreast, tilting forward
  • to look at her with his small head on one side.
  • “Oh!” she cried out, “is it you—is it you?” And it did not seem at all
  • queer to her that she spoke to him as if she were sure that he would
  • understand and answer her.
  • He did answer. He twittered and chirped and hopped along the wall as if
  • he were telling her all sorts of things. It seemed to Mistress Mary as
  • if she understood him, too, though he was not speaking in words. It was
  • as if he said:
  • “Good morning! Isn’t the wind nice? Isn’t the sun nice? Isn’t
  • everything nice? Let us both chirp and hop and twitter. Come on! Come
  • on!”
  • Mary began to laugh, and as he hopped and took little flights along the
  • wall she ran after him. Poor little thin, sallow, ugly Mary—she
  • actually looked almost pretty for a moment.
  • “I like you! I like you!” she cried out, pattering down the walk; and
  • she chirped and tried to whistle, which last she did not know how to do
  • in the least. But the robin seemed to be quite satisfied and chirped
  • and whistled back at her. At last he spread his wings and made a
  • darting flight to the top of a tree, where he perched and sang loudly.
  • That reminded Mary of the first time she had seen him. He had been
  • swinging on a tree-top then and she had been standing in the orchard.
  • Now she was on the other side of the orchard and standing in the path
  • outside a wall—much lower down—and there was the same tree inside.
  • “It’s in the garden no one can go into,” she said to herself. “It’s the
  • garden without a door. He lives in there. How I wish I could see what
  • it is like!”
  • She ran up the walk to the green door she had entered the first
  • morning. Then she ran down the path through the other door and then
  • into the orchard, and when she stood and looked up there was the tree
  • on the other side of the wall, and there was the robin just finishing
  • his song and beginning to preen his feathers with his beak.
  • “It is the garden,” she said. “I am sure it is.”
  • She walked round and looked closely at that side of the orchard wall,
  • but she only found what she had found before—that there was no door in
  • it. Then she ran through the kitchen-gardens again and out into the
  • walk outside the long ivy-covered wall, and she walked to the end of it
  • and looked at it, but there was no door; and then she walked to the
  • other end, looking again, but there was no door.
  • “It’s very queer,” she said. “Ben Weatherstaff said there was no door
  • and there is no door. But there must have been one ten years ago,
  • because Mr. Craven buried the key.”
  • This gave her so much to think of that she began to be quite interested
  • and feel that she was not sorry that she had come to Misselthwaite
  • Manor. In India she had always felt hot and too languid to care much
  • about anything. The fact was that the fresh wind from the moor had
  • begun to blow the cobwebs out of her young brain and to waken her up a
  • little.
  • She stayed out of doors nearly all day, and when she sat down to her
  • supper at night she felt hungry and drowsy and comfortable. She did not
  • feel cross when Martha chattered away. She felt as if she rather liked
  • to hear her, and at last she thought she would ask her a question. She
  • asked it after she had finished her supper and had sat down on the
  • hearth-rug before the fire.
  • “Why did Mr. Craven hate the garden?” she said.
  • She had made Martha stay with her and Martha had not objected at all.
  • She was very young, and used to a crowded cottage full of brothers and
  • sisters, and she found it dull in the great servants’ hall downstairs
  • where the footman and upper-housemaids made fun of her Yorkshire speech
  • and looked upon her as a common little thing, and sat and whispered
  • among themselves. Martha liked to talk, and the strange child who had
  • lived in India, and been waited upon by “blacks,” was novelty enough to
  • attract her.
  • She sat down on the hearth herself without waiting to be asked.
  • “Art tha’ thinkin’ about that garden yet?” she said. “I knew tha’
  • would. That was just the way with me when I first heard about it.”
  • “Why did he hate it?” Mary persisted.
  • Martha tucked her feet under her and made herself quite comfortable.
  • “Listen to th’ wind wutherin’ round the house,” she said. “You could
  • bare stand up on the moor if you was out on it tonight.”
  • Mary did not know what “wutherin’” meant until she listened, and then
  • she understood. It must mean that hollow shuddering sort of roar which
  • rushed round and round the house as if the giant no one could see were
  • buffeting it and beating at the walls and windows to try to break in.
  • But one knew he could not get in, and somehow it made one feel very
  • safe and warm inside a room with a red coal fire.
  • “But why did he hate it so?” she asked, after she had listened. She
  • intended to know if Martha did.
  • Then Martha gave up her store of knowledge.
  • “Mind,” she said, “Mrs. Medlock said it’s not to be talked about.
  • There’s lots o’ things in this place that’s not to be talked over.
  • That’s Mr. Craven’s orders. His troubles are none servants’ business,
  • he says. But for th’ garden he wouldn’t be like he is. It was Mrs.
  • Craven’s garden that she had made when first they were married an’ she
  • just loved it, an’ they used to ’tend the flowers themselves. An’ none
  • o’ th’ gardeners was ever let to go in. Him an’ her used to go in an’
  • shut th’ door an’ stay there hours an’ hours, readin’ and talkin’. An’
  • she was just a bit of a girl an’ there was an old tree with a branch
  • bent like a seat on it. An’ she made roses grow over it an’ she used to
  • sit there. But one day when she was sittin’ there th’ branch broke an’
  • she fell on th’ ground an’ was hurt so bad that next day she died. Th’
  • doctors thought he’d go out o’ his mind an’ die, too. That’s why he
  • hates it. No one’s never gone in since, an’ he won’t let anyone talk
  • about it.”
  • Mary did not ask any more questions. She looked at the red fire and
  • listened to the wind “wutherin’.” It seemed to be “wutherin’” louder
  • than ever.
  • At that moment a very good thing was happening to her. Four good things
  • had happened to her, in fact, since she came to Misselthwaite Manor.
  • She had felt as if she had understood a robin and that he had
  • understood her; she had run in the wind until her blood had grown warm;
  • she had been healthily hungry for the first time in her life; and she
  • had found out what it was to be sorry for someone.
  • But as she was listening to the wind she began to listen to something
  • else. She did not know what it was, because at first she could scarcely
  • distinguish it from the wind itself. It was a curious sound—it seemed
  • almost as if a child were crying somewhere. Sometimes the wind sounded
  • rather like a child crying, but presently Mistress Mary felt quite sure
  • this sound was inside the house, not outside it. It was far away, but
  • it was inside. She turned round and looked at Martha.
  • “Do you hear anyone crying?” she said.
  • Martha suddenly looked confused.
  • “No,” she answered. “It’s th’ wind. Sometimes it sounds like as if
  • someone was lost on th’ moor an’ wailin’. It’s got all sorts o’
  • sounds.”
  • “But listen,” said Mary. “It’s in the house—down one of those long
  • corridors.”
  • And at that very moment a door must have been opened somewhere
  • downstairs; for a great rushing draft blew along the passage and the
  • door of the room they sat in was blown open with a crash, and as they
  • both jumped to their feet the light was blown out and the crying sound
  • was swept down the far corridor so that it was to be heard more plainly
  • than ever.
  • “There!” said Mary. “I told you so! It is someone crying—and it isn’t a
  • grown-up person.”
  • Martha ran and shut the door and turned the key, but before she did it
  • they both heard the sound of a door in some far passage shutting with a
  • bang, and then everything was quiet, for even the wind ceased
  • “wutherin’” for a few moments.
  • “It was th’ wind,” said Martha stubbornly. “An’ if it wasn’t, it was
  • little Betty Butterworth, th’ scullery-maid. She’s had th’ toothache
  • all day.”
  • But something troubled and awkward in her manner made Mistress Mary
  • stare very hard at her. She did not believe she was speaking the truth.
  • CHAPTER VI
  • “THERE WAS SOMEONE CRYING—THERE WAS!”
  • The next day the rain poured down in torrents again, and when Mary
  • looked out of her window the moor was almost hidden by gray mist and
  • cloud. There could be no going out today.
  • “What do you do in your cottage when it rains like this?” she asked
  • Martha.
  • “Try to keep from under each other’s feet mostly,” Martha answered.
  • “Eh! there does seem a lot of us then. Mother’s a good-tempered woman
  • but she gets fair moithered. The biggest ones goes out in th’ cow-shed
  • and plays there. Dickon he doesn’t mind th’ wet. He goes out just th’
  • same as if th’ sun was shinin’. He says he sees things on rainy days as
  • doesn’t show when it’s fair weather. He once found a little fox cub
  • half drowned in its hole and he brought it home in th’ bosom of his
  • shirt to keep it warm. Its mother had been killed nearby an’ th’ hole
  • was swum out an’ th’ rest o’ th’ litter was dead. He’s got it at home
  • now. He found a half-drowned young crow another time an’ he brought it
  • home, too, an’ tamed it. It’s named Soot because it’s so black, an’ it
  • hops an’ flies about with him everywhere.”
  • The time had come when Mary had forgotten to resent Martha’s familiar
  • talk. She had even begun to find it interesting and to be sorry when
  • she stopped or went away. The stories she had been told by her Ayah
  • when she lived in India had been quite unlike those Martha had to tell
  • about the moorland cottage which held fourteen people who lived in four
  • little rooms and never had quite enough to eat. The children seemed to
  • tumble about and amuse themselves like a litter of rough, good-natured
  • collie puppies. Mary was most attracted by the mother and Dickon. When
  • Martha told stories of what “mother” said or did they always sounded
  • comfortable.
  • “If I had a raven or a fox cub I could play with it,” said Mary. “But I
  • have nothing.”
  • Martha looked perplexed.
  • “Can tha’ knit?” she asked.
  • “No,” answered Mary.
  • “Can tha’ sew?”
  • “No.”
  • “Can tha’ read?”
  • “Yes.”
  • “Then why doesn’t tha read somethin’, or learn a bit o’ spellin’?
  • Tha’st old enough to be learnin’ thy book a good bit now.”
  • “I haven’t any books,” said Mary. “Those I had were left in India.”
  • “That’s a pity,” said Martha. “If Mrs. Medlock’d let thee go into th’
  • library, there’s thousands o’ books there.”
  • Mary did not ask where the library was, because she was suddenly
  • inspired by a new idea. She made up her mind to go and find it herself.
  • She was not troubled about Mrs. Medlock. Mrs. Medlock seemed always to
  • be in her comfortable housekeeper’s sitting-room downstairs. In this
  • queer place one scarcely ever saw anyone at all. In fact, there was no
  • one to see but the servants, and when their master was away they lived
  • a luxurious life below stairs, where there was a huge kitchen hung
  • about with shining brass and pewter, and a large servants’ hall where
  • there were four or five abundant meals eaten every day, and where a
  • great deal of lively romping went on when Mrs. Medlock was out of the
  • way.
  • Mary’s meals were served regularly, and Martha waited on her, but no
  • one troubled themselves about her in the least. Mrs. Medlock came and
  • looked at her every day or two, but no one inquired what she did or
  • told her what to do. She supposed that perhaps this was the English way
  • of treating children. In India she had always been attended by her
  • Ayah, who had followed her about and waited on her, hand and foot. She
  • had often been tired of her company. Now she was followed by nobody and
  • was learning to dress herself because Martha looked as though she
  • thought she was silly and stupid when she wanted to have things handed
  • to her and put on.
  • “Hasn’t tha’ got good sense?” she said once, when Mary had stood
  • waiting for her to put on her gloves for her. “Our Susan Ann is twice
  • as sharp as thee an’ she’s only four year’ old. Sometimes tha’ looks
  • fair soft in th’ head.”
  • Mary had worn her contrary scowl for an hour after that, but it made
  • her think several entirely new things.
  • She stood at the window for about ten minutes this morning after Martha
  • had swept up the hearth for the last time and gone downstairs. She was
  • thinking over the new idea which had come to her when she heard of the
  • library. She did not care very much about the library itself, because
  • she had read very few books; but to hear of it brought back to her mind
  • the hundred rooms with closed doors. She wondered if they were all
  • really locked and what she would find if she could get into any of
  • them. Were there a hundred really? Why shouldn’t she go and see how
  • many doors she could count? It would be something to do on this morning
  • when she could not go out. She had never been taught to ask permission
  • to do things, and she knew nothing at all about authority, so she would
  • not have thought it necessary to ask Mrs. Medlock if she might walk
  • about the house, even if she had seen her.
  • She opened the door of the room and went into the corridor, and then
  • she began her wanderings. It was a long corridor and it branched into
  • other corridors and it led her up short flights of steps which mounted
  • to others again. There were doors and doors, and there were pictures on
  • the walls. Sometimes they were pictures of dark, curious landscapes,
  • but oftenest they were portraits of men and women in queer, grand
  • costumes made of satin and velvet. She found herself in one long
  • gallery whose walls were covered with these portraits. She had never
  • thought there could be so many in any house. She walked slowly down
  • this place and stared at the faces which also seemed to stare at her.
  • She felt as if they were wondering what a little girl from India was
  • doing in their house. Some were pictures of children—little girls in
  • thick satin frocks which reached to their feet and stood out about
  • them, and boys with puffed sleeves and lace collars and long hair, or
  • with big ruffs around their necks. She always stopped to look at the
  • children, and wonder what their names were, and where they had gone,
  • and why they wore such odd clothes. There was a stiff, plain little
  • girl rather like herself. She wore a green brocade dress and held a
  • green parrot on her finger. Her eyes had a sharp, curious look.
  • “Where do you live now?” said Mary aloud to her. “I wish you were
  • here.”
  • Surely no other little girl ever spent such a queer morning. It seemed
  • as if there was no one in all the huge rambling house but her own small
  • self, wandering about upstairs and down, through narrow passages and
  • wide ones, where it seemed to her that no one but herself had ever
  • walked. Since so many rooms had been built, people must have lived in
  • them, but it all seemed so empty that she could not quite believe it
  • true.
  • It was not until she climbed to the second floor that she thought of
  • turning the handle of a door. All the doors were shut, as Mrs. Medlock
  • had said they were, but at last she put her hand on the handle of one
  • of them and turned it. She was almost frightened for a moment when she
  • felt that it turned without difficulty and that when she pushed upon
  • the door itself it slowly and heavily opened. It was a massive door and
  • opened into a big bedroom. There were embroidered hangings on the wall,
  • and inlaid furniture such as she had seen in India stood about the
  • room. A broad window with leaded panes looked out upon the moor; and
  • over the mantel was another portrait of the stiff, plain little girl
  • who seemed to stare at her more curiously than ever.
  • “Perhaps she slept here once,” said Mary. “She stares at me so that she
  • makes me feel queer.”
  • After that she opened more doors and more. She saw so many rooms that
  • she became quite tired and began to think that there must be a hundred,
  • though she had not counted them. In all of them there were old pictures
  • or old tapestries with strange scenes worked on them. There were
  • curious pieces of furniture and curious ornaments in nearly all of
  • them.
  • In one room, which looked like a lady’s sitting-room, the hangings were
  • all embroidered velvet, and in a cabinet were about a hundred little
  • elephants made of ivory. They were of different sizes, and some had
  • their mahouts or palanquins on their backs. Some were much bigger than
  • the others and some were so tiny that they seemed only babies. Mary had
  • seen carved ivory in India and she knew all about elephants. She opened
  • the door of the cabinet and stood on a footstool and played with these
  • for quite a long time. When she got tired she set the elephants in
  • order and shut the door of the cabinet.
  • In all her wanderings through the long corridors and the empty rooms,
  • she had seen nothing alive; but in this room she saw something. Just
  • after she had closed the cabinet door she heard a tiny rustling sound.
  • It made her jump and look around at the sofa by the fireplace, from
  • which it seemed to come. In the corner of the sofa there was a cushion,
  • and in the velvet which covered it there was a hole, and out of the
  • hole peeped a tiny head with a pair of frightened eyes in it.
  • Mary crept softly across the room to look. The bright eyes belonged to
  • a little gray mouse, and the mouse had eaten a hole into the cushion
  • and made a comfortable nest there. Six baby mice were cuddled up asleep
  • near her. If there was no one else alive in the hundred rooms there
  • were seven mice who did not look lonely at all.
  • “If they wouldn’t be so frightened I would take them back with me,”
  • said Mary.
  • She had wandered about long enough to feel too tired to wander any
  • farther, and she turned back. Two or three times she lost her way by
  • turning down the wrong corridor and was obliged to ramble up and down
  • until she found the right one; but at last she reached her own floor
  • again, though she was some distance from her own room and did not know
  • exactly where she was.
  • “I believe I have taken a wrong turning again,” she said, standing
  • still at what seemed the end of a short passage with tapestry on the
  • wall. “I don’t know which way to go. How still everything is!”
  • It was while she was standing here and just after she had said this
  • that the stillness was broken by a sound. It was another cry, but not
  • quite like the one she had heard last night; it was only a short one, a
  • fretful childish whine muffled by passing through walls.
  • “It’s nearer than it was,” said Mary, her heart beating rather faster.
  • “And it _is_ crying.”
  • She put her hand accidentally upon the tapestry near her, and then
  • sprang back, feeling quite startled. The tapestry was the covering of a
  • door which fell open and showed her that there was another part of the
  • corridor behind it, and Mrs. Medlock was coming up it with her bunch of
  • keys in her hand and a very cross look on her face.
  • “What are you doing here?” she said, and she took Mary by the arm and
  • pulled her away. “What did I tell you?”
  • “I turned round the wrong corner,” explained Mary. “I didn’t know which
  • way to go and I heard someone crying.” She quite hated Mrs. Medlock at
  • the moment, but she hated her more the next.
  • “You didn’t hear anything of the sort,” said the housekeeper. “You come
  • along back to your own nursery or I’ll box your ears.”
  • And she took her by the arm and half pushed, half pulled her up one
  • passage and down another until she pushed her in at the door of her own
  • room.
  • “Now,” she said, “you stay where you’re told to stay or you’ll find
  • yourself locked up. The master had better get you a governess, same as
  • he said he would. You’re one that needs someone to look sharp after
  • you. I’ve got enough to do.”
  • She went out of the room and slammed the door after her, and Mary went
  • and sat on the hearth-rug, pale with rage. She did not cry, but ground
  • her teeth.
  • “There _was_ someone crying—there _was_—there _was!_” she said to
  • herself.
  • She had heard it twice now, and sometime she would find out. She had
  • found out a great deal this morning. She felt as if she had been on a
  • long journey, and at any rate she had had something to amuse her all
  • the time, and she had played with the ivory elephants and had seen the
  • gray mouse and its babies in their nest in the velvet cushion.
  • CHAPTER VII
  • THE KEY TO THE GARDEN
  • Two days after this, when Mary opened her eyes she sat upright in bed
  • immediately, and called to Martha.
  • “Look at the moor! Look at the moor!”
  • The rainstorm had ended and the gray mist and clouds had been swept
  • away in the night by the wind. The wind itself had ceased and a
  • brilliant, deep blue sky arched high over the moorland. Never, never
  • had Mary dreamed of a sky so blue. In India skies were hot and blazing;
  • this was of a deep cool blue which almost seemed to sparkle like the
  • waters of some lovely bottomless lake, and here and there, high, high
  • in the arched blueness floated small clouds of snow-white fleece. The
  • far-reaching world of the moor itself looked softly blue instead of
  • gloomy purple-black or awful dreary gray.
  • “Aye,” said Martha with a cheerful grin. “Th’ storm’s over for a bit.
  • It does like this at this time o’ th’ year. It goes off in a night like
  • it was pretendin’ it had never been here an’ never meant to come again.
  • That’s because th’ springtime’s on its way. It’s a long way off yet,
  • but it’s comin’.”
  • “I thought perhaps it always rained or looked dark in England,” Mary
  • said.
  • “Eh! no!” said Martha, sitting up on her heels among her black lead
  • brushes. “Nowt o’ th’ soart!”
  • “What does that mean?” asked Mary seriously. In India the natives spoke
  • different dialects which only a few people understood, so she was not
  • surprised when Martha used words she did not know.
  • Martha laughed as she had done the first morning.
  • “There now,” she said. “I’ve talked broad Yorkshire again like Mrs.
  • Medlock said I mustn’t. ‘Nowt o’ th’ soart’ means
  • ‘nothin’-of-the-sort,’” slowly and carefully, “but it takes so long to
  • say it. Yorkshire’s th’ sunniest place on earth when it is sunny. I
  • told thee tha’d like th’ moor after a bit. Just you wait till you see
  • th’ gold-colored gorse blossoms an’ th’ blossoms o’ th’ broom, an’ th’
  • heather flowerin’, all purple bells, an’ hundreds o’ butterflies
  • flutterin’ an’ bees hummin’ an’ skylarks soarin’ up an’ singin’. You’ll
  • want to get out on it at sunrise an’ live out on it all day like Dickon
  • does.”
  • “Could I ever get there?” asked Mary wistfully, looking through her
  • window at the far-off blue. It was so new and big and wonderful and
  • such a heavenly color.
  • “I don’t know,” answered Martha. “Tha’s never used tha’ legs since tha’
  • was born, it seems to me. Tha’ couldn’t walk five mile. It’s five mile
  • to our cottage.”
  • “I should like to see your cottage.”
  • Martha stared at her a moment curiously before she took up her
  • polishing brush and began to rub the grate again. She was thinking that
  • the small plain face did not look quite as sour at this moment as it
  • had done the first morning she saw it. It looked just a trifle like
  • little Susan Ann’s when she wanted something very much.
  • “I’ll ask my mother about it,” she said. “She’s one o’ them that nearly
  • always sees a way to do things. It’s my day out today an’ I’m goin’
  • home. Eh! I am glad. Mrs. Medlock thinks a lot o’ mother. Perhaps she
  • could talk to her.”
  • “I like your mother,” said Mary.
  • “I should think tha’ did,” agreed Martha, polishing away.
  • “I’ve never seen her,” said Mary.
  • “No, tha’ hasn’t,” replied Martha.
  • She sat up on her heels again and rubbed the end of her nose with the
  • back of her hand as if puzzled for a moment, but she ended quite
  • positively.
  • “Well, she’s that sensible an’ hard workin’ an’ good-natured an’ clean
  • that no one could help likin’ her whether they’d seen her or not. When
  • I’m goin’ home to her on my day out I just jump for joy when I’m
  • crossin’ the moor.”
  • “I like Dickon,” added Mary. “And I’ve never seen him.”
  • “Well,” said Martha stoutly, “I’ve told thee that th’ very birds likes
  • him an’ th’ rabbits an’ wild sheep an’ ponies, an’ th’ foxes
  • themselves. I wonder,” staring at her reflectively, “what Dickon would
  • think of thee?”
  • “He wouldn’t like me,” said Mary in her stiff, cold little way. “No one
  • does.”
  • Martha looked reflective again.
  • “How does tha’ like thysel’?” she inquired, really quite as if she were
  • curious to know.
  • Mary hesitated a moment and thought it over.
  • “Not at all—really,” she answered. “But I never thought of that
  • before.”
  • Martha grinned a little as if at some homely recollection.
  • “Mother said that to me once,” she said. “She was at her wash-tub an’ I
  • was in a bad temper an’ talkin’ ill of folk, an’ she turns round on me
  • an’ says: ‘Tha’ young vixen, tha’! There tha’ stands sayin’ tha’
  • doesn’t like this one an’ tha’ doesn’t like that one. How does tha’
  • like thysel’?’ It made me laugh an’ it brought me to my senses in a
  • minute.”
  • She went away in high spirits as soon as she had given Mary her
  • breakfast. She was going to walk five miles across the moor to the
  • cottage, and she was going to help her mother with the washing and do
  • the week’s baking and enjoy herself thoroughly.
  • Mary felt lonelier than ever when she knew she was no longer in the
  • house. She went out into the garden as quickly as possible, and the
  • first thing she did was to run round and round the fountain flower
  • garden ten times. She counted the times carefully and when she had
  • finished she felt in better spirits. The sunshine made the whole place
  • look different. The high, deep, blue sky arched over Misselthwaite as
  • well as over the moor, and she kept lifting her face and looking up
  • into it, trying to imagine what it would be like to lie down on one of
  • the little snow-white clouds and float about. She went into the first
  • kitchen-garden and found Ben Weatherstaff working there with two other
  • gardeners. The change in the weather seemed to have done him good. He
  • spoke to her of his own accord.
  • “Springtime’s comin,’” he said. “Cannot tha’ smell it?”
  • Mary sniffed and thought she could.
  • “I smell something nice and fresh and damp,” she said.
  • “That’s th’ good rich earth,” he answered, digging away. “It’s in a
  • good humor makin’ ready to grow things. It’s glad when plantin’ time
  • comes. It’s dull in th’ winter when it’s got nowt to do. In th’ flower
  • gardens out there things will be stirrin’ down below in th’ dark. Th’
  • sun’s warmin’ ’em. You’ll see bits o’ green spikes stickin’ out o’ th’
  • black earth after a bit.”
  • “What will they be?” asked Mary.
  • “Crocuses an’ snowdrops an’ daffydowndillys. Has tha’ never seen them?”
  • “No. Everything is hot, and wet, and green after the rains in India,”
  • said Mary. “And I think things grow up in a night.”
  • “These won’t grow up in a night,” said Weatherstaff. “Tha’ll have to
  • wait for ’em. They’ll poke up a bit higher here, an’ push out a spike
  • more there, an’ uncurl a leaf this day an’ another that. You watch
  • ’em.”
  • “I am going to,” answered Mary.
  • Very soon she heard the soft rustling flight of wings again and she
  • knew at once that the robin had come again. He was very pert and
  • lively, and hopped about so close to her feet, and put his head on one
  • side and looked at her so slyly that she asked Ben Weatherstaff a
  • question.
  • “Do you think he remembers me?” she said.
  • “Remembers thee!” said Weatherstaff indignantly. “He knows every
  • cabbage stump in th’ gardens, let alone th’ people. He’s never seen a
  • little wench here before, an’ he’s bent on findin’ out all about thee.
  • Tha’s no need to try to hide anything from _him_.”
  • “Are things stirring down below in the dark in that garden where he
  • lives?” Mary inquired.
  • “What garden?” grunted Weatherstaff, becoming surly again.
  • “The one where the old rose-trees are.” She could not help asking,
  • because she wanted so much to know. “Are all the flowers dead, or do
  • some of them come again in the summer? Are there ever any roses?”
  • “Ask him,” said Ben Weatherstaff, hunching his shoulders toward the
  • robin. “He’s the only one as knows. No one else has seen inside it for
  • ten year’.”
  • Ten years was a long time, Mary thought. She had been born ten years
  • ago.
  • She walked away, slowly thinking. She had begun to like the garden just
  • as she had begun to like the robin and Dickon and Martha’s mother. She
  • was beginning to like Martha, too. That seemed a good many people to
  • like—when you were not used to liking. She thought of the robin as one
  • of the people. She went to her walk outside the long, ivy-covered wall
  • over which she could see the tree-tops; and the second time she walked
  • up and down the most interesting and exciting thing happened to her,
  • and it was all through Ben Weatherstaff’s robin.
  • She heard a chirp and a twitter, and when she looked at the bare
  • flower-bed at her left side there he was hopping about and pretending
  • to peck things out of the earth to persuade her that he had not
  • followed her. But she knew he had followed her and the surprise so
  • filled her with delight that she almost trembled a little.
  • “You do remember me!” she cried out. “You do! You are prettier than
  • anything else in the world!”
  • She chirped, and talked, and coaxed and he hopped, and flirted his tail
  • and twittered. It was as if he were talking. His red waistcoat was like
  • satin and he puffed his tiny breast out and was so fine and so grand
  • and so pretty that it was really as if he were showing her how
  • important and like a human person a robin could be. Mistress Mary
  • forgot that she had ever been contrary in her life when he allowed her
  • to draw closer and closer to him, and bend down and talk and try to
  • make something like robin sounds.
  • Oh! to think that he should actually let her come as near to him as
  • that! He knew nothing in the world would make her put out her hand
  • toward him or startle him in the least tiniest way. He knew it because
  • he was a real person—only nicer than any other person in the world. She
  • was so happy that she scarcely dared to breathe.
  • The flower-bed was not quite bare. It was bare of flowers because the
  • perennial plants had been cut down for their winter rest, but there
  • were tall shrubs and low ones which grew together at the back of the
  • bed, and as the robin hopped about under them she saw him hop over a
  • small pile of freshly turned up earth. He stopped on it to look for a
  • worm. The earth had been turned up because a dog had been trying to dig
  • up a mole and he had scratched quite a deep hole.
  • Mary looked at it, not really knowing why the hole was there, and as
  • she looked she saw something almost buried in the newly-turned soil. It
  • was something like a ring of rusty iron or brass and when the robin
  • flew up into a tree nearby she put out her hand and picked the ring up.
  • It was more than a ring, however; it was an old key which looked as if
  • it had been buried a long time.
  • Mistress Mary stood up and looked at it with an almost frightened face
  • as it hung from her finger.
  • “Perhaps it has been buried for ten years,” she said in a whisper.
  • “Perhaps it is the key to the garden!”
  • CHAPTER VIII
  • THE ROBIN WHO SHOWED THE WAY
  • She looked at the key quite a long time. She turned it over and over,
  • and thought about it. As I have said before, she was not a child who
  • had been trained to ask permission or consult her elders about things.
  • All she thought about the key was that if it was the key to the closed
  • garden, and she could find out where the door was, she could perhaps
  • open it and see what was inside the walls, and what had happened to the
  • old rose-trees. It was because it had been shut up so long that she
  • wanted to see it. It seemed as if it must be different from other
  • places and that something strange must have happened to it during ten
  • years. Besides that, if she liked it she could go into it every day and
  • shut the door behind her, and she could make up some play of her own
  • and play it quite alone, because nobody would ever know where she was,
  • but would think the door was still locked and the key buried in the
  • earth. The thought of that pleased her very much.
  • Living as it were, all by herself in a house with a hundred
  • mysteriously closed rooms and having nothing whatever to do to amuse
  • herself, had set her inactive brain to working and was actually
  • awakening her imagination. There is no doubt that the fresh, strong,
  • pure air from the moor had a great deal to do with it. Just as it had
  • given her an appetite, and fighting with the wind had stirred her
  • blood, so the same things had stirred her mind. In India she had always
  • been too hot and languid and weak to care much about anything, but in
  • this place she was beginning to care and to want to do new things.
  • Already she felt less “contrary,” though she did not know why.
  • She put the key in her pocket and walked up and down her walk. No one
  • but herself ever seemed to come there, so she could walk slowly and
  • look at the wall, or, rather, at the ivy growing on it. The ivy was the
  • baffling thing. Howsoever carefully she looked she could see nothing
  • but thickly growing, glossy, dark green leaves. She was very much
  • disappointed. Something of her contrariness came back to her as she
  • paced the walk and looked over it at the tree-tops inside. It seemed so
  • silly, she said to herself, to be near it and not be able to get in.
  • She took the key in her pocket when she went back to the house, and she
  • made up her mind that she would always carry it with her when she went
  • out, so that if she ever should find the hidden door she would be
  • ready.
  • Mrs. Medlock had allowed Martha to sleep all night at the cottage, but
  • she was back at her work in the morning with cheeks redder than ever
  • and in the best of spirits.
  • “I got up at four o’clock,” she said. “Eh! it was pretty on th’ moor
  • with th’ birds gettin’ up an’ th’ rabbits scamperin’ about an’ th’ sun
  • risin’. I didn’t walk all th’ way. A man gave me a ride in his cart an’
  • I did enjoy myself.”
  • She was full of stories of the delights of her day out. Her mother had
  • been glad to see her and they had got the baking and washing all out of
  • the way. She had even made each of the children a doughcake with a bit
  • of brown sugar in it.
  • “I had ’em all pipin’ hot when they came in from playin’ on th’ moor.
  • An’ th’ cottage all smelt o’ nice, clean hot bakin’ an’ there was a
  • good fire, an’ they just shouted for joy. Our Dickon he said our
  • cottage was good enough for a king to live in.”
  • In the evening they had all sat round the fire, and Martha and her
  • mother had sewed patches on torn clothes and mended stockings and
  • Martha had told them about the little girl who had come from India and
  • who had been waited on all her life by what Martha called “blacks”
  • until she didn’t know how to put on her own stockings.
  • “Eh! they did like to hear about you,” said Martha. “They wanted to
  • know all about th’ blacks an’ about th’ ship you came in. I couldn’t
  • tell ’em enough.”
  • Mary reflected a little.
  • “I’ll tell you a great deal more before your next day out,” she said,
  • “so that you will have more to talk about. I dare say they would like
  • to hear about riding on elephants and camels, and about the officers
  • going to hunt tigers.”
  • “My word!” cried delighted Martha. “It would set ’em clean off their
  • heads. Would tha’ really do that, Miss? It would be same as a wild
  • beast show like we heard they had in York once.”
  • “India is quite different from Yorkshire,” Mary said slowly, as she
  • thought the matter over. “I never thought of that. Did Dickon and your
  • mother like to hear you talk about me?”
  • “Why, our Dickon’s eyes nearly started out o’ his head, they got that
  • round,” answered Martha. “But mother, she was put out about your
  • seemin’ to be all by yourself like. She said, ‘Hasn’t Mr. Craven got no
  • governess for her, nor no nurse?’ and I said, ‘No, he hasn’t, though
  • Mrs. Medlock says he will when he thinks of it, but she says he mayn’t
  • think of it for two or three years.’”
  • “I don’t want a governess,” said Mary sharply.
  • “But mother says you ought to be learnin’ your book by this time an’
  • you ought to have a woman to look after you, an’ she says: ‘Now,
  • Martha, you just think how you’d feel yourself, in a big place like
  • that, wanderin’ about all alone, an’ no mother. You do your best to
  • cheer her up,’ she says, an’ I said I would.”
  • Mary gave her a long, steady look.
  • “You do cheer me up,” she said. “I like to hear you talk.”
  • Presently Martha went out of the room and came back with something held
  • in her hands under her apron.
  • “What does tha’ think,” she said, with a cheerful grin. “I’ve brought
  • thee a present.”
  • “A present!” exclaimed Mistress Mary. How could a cottage full of
  • fourteen hungry people give anyone a present!
  • “A man was drivin’ across the moor peddlin’,” Martha explained. “An’ he
  • stopped his cart at our door. He had pots an’ pans an’ odds an’ ends,
  • but mother had no money to buy anythin’. Just as he was goin’ away our
  • ’Lizabeth Ellen called out, ‘Mother, he’s got skippin’-ropes with red
  • an’ blue handles.’ An’ mother she calls out quite sudden, ‘Here, stop,
  • mister! How much are they?’ An’ he says ‘Tuppence’, an’ mother she
  • began fumblin’ in her pocket an’ she says to me, ‘Martha, tha’s brought
  • me thy wages like a good lass, an’ I’ve got four places to put every
  • penny, but I’m just goin’ to take tuppence out of it to buy that child
  • a skippin’-rope,’ an’ she bought one an’ here it is.”
  • She brought it out from under her apron and exhibited it quite proudly.
  • It was a strong, slender rope with a striped red and blue handle at
  • each end, but Mary Lennox had never seen a skipping-rope before. She
  • gazed at it with a mystified expression.
  • “What is it for?” she asked curiously.
  • “For!” cried out Martha. “Does tha’ mean that they’ve not got
  • skippin’-ropes in India, for all they’ve got elephants and tigers and
  • camels! No wonder most of ’em’s black. This is what it’s for; just
  • watch me.”
  • And she ran into the middle of the room and, taking a handle in each
  • hand, began to skip, and skip, and skip, while Mary turned in her chair
  • to stare at her, and the queer faces in the old portraits seemed to
  • stare at her, too, and wonder what on earth this common little cottager
  • had the impudence to be doing under their very noses. But Martha did
  • not even see them. The interest and curiosity in Mistress Mary’s face
  • delighted her, and she went on skipping and counted as she skipped
  • until she had reached a hundred.
  • “I could skip longer than that,” she said when she stopped. “I’ve
  • skipped as much as five hundred when I was twelve, but I wasn’t as fat
  • then as I am now, an’ I was in practice.”
  • Mary got up from her chair beginning to feel excited herself.
  • “It looks nice,” she said. “Your mother is a kind woman. Do you think I
  • could ever skip like that?”
  • “You just try it,” urged Martha, handing her the skipping-rope. “You
  • can’t skip a hundred at first, but if you practice you’ll mount up.
  • That’s what mother said. She says, ‘Nothin’ will do her more good than
  • skippin’ rope. It’s th’ sensiblest toy a child can have. Let her play
  • out in th’ fresh air skippin’ an’ it’ll stretch her legs an’ arms an’
  • give her some strength in ’em.’”
  • It was plain that there was not a great deal of strength in Mistress
  • Mary’s arms and legs when she first began to skip. She was not very
  • clever at it, but she liked it so much that she did not want to stop.
  • “Put on tha’ things and run an’ skip out o’ doors,” said Martha.
  • “Mother said I must tell you to keep out o’ doors as much as you could,
  • even when it rains a bit, so as tha’ wrap up warm.”
  • Mary put on her coat and hat and took her skipping-rope over her arm.
  • She opened the door to go out, and then suddenly thought of something
  • and turned back rather slowly.
  • “Martha,” she said, “they were your wages. It was your two-pence
  • really. Thank you.” She said it stiffly because she was not used to
  • thanking people or noticing that they did things for her. “Thank you,”
  • she said, and held out her hand because she did not know what else to
  • do.
  • Martha gave her hand a clumsy little shake, as if she was not
  • accustomed to this sort of thing either. Then she laughed.
  • “Eh! th’ art a queer, old-womanish thing,” she said. “If tha’d been our
  • ’Lizabeth Ellen tha’d have given me a kiss.”
  • Mary looked stiffer than ever.
  • “Do you want me to kiss you?”
  • Martha laughed again.
  • “Nay, not me,” she answered. “If tha’ was different, p’raps tha’d want
  • to thysel’. But tha’ isn’t. Run off outside an’ play with thy rope.”
  • Mistress Mary felt a little awkward as she went out of the room.
  • Yorkshire people seemed strange, and Martha was always rather a puzzle
  • to her. At first she had disliked her very much, but now she did not.
  • The skipping-rope was a wonderful thing. She counted and skipped, and
  • skipped and counted, until her cheeks were quite red, and she was more
  • interested than she had ever been since she was born. The sun was
  • shining and a little wind was blowing—not a rough wind, but one which
  • came in delightful little gusts and brought a fresh scent of newly
  • turned earth with it. She skipped round the fountain garden, and up one
  • walk and down another. She skipped at last into the kitchen-garden and
  • saw Ben Weatherstaff digging and talking to his robin, which was
  • hopping about him. She skipped down the walk toward him and he lifted
  • his head and looked at her with a curious expression. She had wondered
  • if he would notice her. She wanted him to see her skip.
  • “Well!” he exclaimed. “Upon my word. P’raps tha’ art a young ’un, after
  • all, an’ p’raps tha’s got child’s blood in thy veins instead of sour
  • buttermilk. Tha’s skipped red into thy cheeks as sure as my name’s Ben
  • Weatherstaff. I wouldn’t have believed tha’ could do it.”
  • “I never skipped before,” Mary said. “I’m just beginning. I can only go
  • up to twenty.”
  • “Tha’ keep on,” said Ben. “Tha’ shapes well enough at it for a young
  • ’un that’s lived with heathen. Just see how he’s watchin’ thee,”
  • jerking his head toward the robin. “He followed after thee yesterday.
  • He’ll be at it again today. He’ll be bound to find out what th’
  • skippin’-rope is. He’s never seen one. Eh!” shaking his head at the
  • bird, “tha’ curiosity will be th’ death of thee sometime if tha’
  • doesn’t look sharp.”
  • Mary skipped round all the gardens and round the orchard, resting every
  • few minutes. At length she went to her own special walk and made up her
  • mind to try if she could skip the whole length of it. It was a good
  • long skip and she began slowly, but before she had gone half-way down
  • the path she was so hot and breathless that she was obliged to stop.
  • She did not mind much, because she had already counted up to thirty.
  • She stopped with a little laugh of pleasure, and there, lo and behold,
  • was the robin swaying on a long branch of ivy. He had followed her and
  • he greeted her with a chirp. As Mary had skipped toward him she felt
  • something heavy in her pocket strike against her at each jump, and when
  • she saw the robin she laughed again.
  • “You showed me where the key was yesterday,” she said. “You ought to
  • show me the door today; but I don’t believe you know!”
  • The robin flew from his swinging spray of ivy on to the top of the wall
  • and he opened his beak and sang a loud, lovely trill, merely to show
  • off. Nothing in the world is quite as adorably lovely as a robin when
  • he shows off—and they are nearly always doing it.
  • Mary Lennox had heard a great deal about Magic in her Ayah’s stories,
  • and she always said that what happened almost at that moment was Magic.
  • One of the nice little gusts of wind rushed down the walk, and it was a
  • stronger one than the rest. It was strong enough to wave the branches
  • of the trees, and it was more than strong enough to sway the trailing
  • sprays of untrimmed ivy hanging from the wall. Mary had stepped close
  • to the robin, and suddenly the gust of wind swung aside some loose ivy
  • trails, and more suddenly still she jumped toward it and caught it in
  • her hand. This she did because she had seen something under it—a round
  • knob which had been covered by the leaves hanging over it. It was the
  • knob of a door.
  • She put her hands under the leaves and began to pull and push them
  • aside. Thick as the ivy hung, it nearly all was a loose and swinging
  • curtain, though some had crept over wood and iron. Mary’s heart began
  • to thump and her hands to shake a little in her delight and excitement.
  • The robin kept singing and twittering away and tilting his head on one
  • side, as if he were as excited as she was. What was this under her
  • hands which was square and made of iron and which her fingers found a
  • hole in?
  • It was the lock of the door which had been closed ten years and she put
  • her hand in her pocket, drew out the key and found it fitted the
  • keyhole. She put the key in and turned it. It took two hands to do it,
  • but it did turn.
  • And then she took a long breath and looked behind her up the long walk
  • to see if anyone was coming. No one was coming. No one ever did come,
  • it seemed, and she took another long breath, because she could not help
  • it, and she held back the swinging curtain of ivy and pushed back the
  • door which opened slowly—slowly.
  • Then she slipped through it, and shut it behind her, and stood with her
  • back against it, looking about her and breathing quite fast with
  • excitement, and wonder, and delight.
  • She was standing _inside_ the secret garden.
  • CHAPTER IX
  • THE STRANGEST HOUSE ANYONE EVER LIVED IN
  • It was the sweetest, most mysterious-looking place anyone could
  • imagine. The high walls which shut it in were covered with the leafless
  • stems of climbing roses which were so thick that they were matted
  • together. Mary Lennox knew they were roses because she had seen a great
  • many roses in India. All the ground was covered with grass of a wintry
  • brown and out of it grew clumps of bushes which were surely rosebushes
  • if they were alive. There were numbers of standard roses which had so
  • spread their branches that they were like little trees. There were
  • other trees in the garden, and one of the things which made the place
  • look strangest and loveliest was that climbing roses had run all over
  • them and swung down long tendrils which made light swaying curtains,
  • and here and there they had caught at each other or at a far-reaching
  • branch and had crept from one tree to another and made lovely bridges
  • of themselves. There were neither leaves nor roses on them now and Mary
  • did not know whether they were dead or alive, but their thin gray or
  • brown branches and sprays looked like a sort of hazy mantle spreading
  • over everything, walls, and trees, and even brown grass, where they had
  • fallen from their fastenings and run along the ground. It was this hazy
  • tangle from tree to tree which made it all look so mysterious. Mary had
  • thought it must be different from other gardens which had not been left
  • all by themselves so long; and indeed it was different from any other
  • place she had ever seen in her life.
  • “How still it is!” she whispered. “How still!”
  • Then she waited a moment and listened at the stillness. The robin, who
  • had flown to his treetop, was still as all the rest. He did not even
  • flutter his wings; he sat without stirring, and looked at Mary.
  • “No wonder it is still,” she whispered again. “I am the first person
  • who has spoken in here for ten years.”
  • She moved away from the door, stepping as softly as if she were afraid
  • of awakening someone. She was glad that there was grass under her feet
  • and that her steps made no sounds. She walked under one of the
  • fairy-like gray arches between the trees and looked up at the sprays
  • and tendrils which formed them.
  • “I wonder if they are all quite dead,” she said. “Is it all a quite
  • dead garden? I wish it wasn’t.”
  • If she had been Ben Weatherstaff she could have told whether the wood
  • was alive by looking at it, but she could only see that there were only
  • gray or brown sprays and branches and none showed any signs of even a
  • tiny leaf-bud anywhere.
  • But she was _inside_ the wonderful garden and she could come through
  • the door under the ivy any time and she felt as if she had found a
  • world all her own.
  • The sun was shining inside the four walls and the high arch of blue sky
  • over this particular piece of Misselthwaite seemed even more brilliant
  • and soft than it was over the moor. The robin flew down from his
  • tree-top and hopped about or flew after her from one bush to another.
  • He chirped a good deal and had a very busy air, as if he were showing
  • her things. Everything was strange and silent and she seemed to be
  • hundreds of miles away from anyone, but somehow she did not feel lonely
  • at all. All that troubled her was her wish that she knew whether all
  • the roses were dead, or if perhaps some of them had lived and might put
  • out leaves and buds as the weather got warmer. She did not want it to
  • be a quite dead garden. If it were a quite alive garden, how wonderful
  • it would be, and what thousands of roses would grow on every side!
  • Her skipping-rope had hung over her arm when she came in and after she
  • had walked about for a while she thought she would skip round the whole
  • garden, stopping when she wanted to look at things. There seemed to
  • have been grass paths here and there, and in one or two corners there
  • were alcoves of evergreen with stone seats or tall moss-covered flower
  • urns in them.
  • As she came near the second of these alcoves she stopped skipping.
  • There had once been a flowerbed in it, and she thought she saw
  • something sticking out of the black earth—some sharp little pale green
  • points. She remembered what Ben Weatherstaff had said and she knelt
  • down to look at them.
  • “Yes, they are tiny growing things and they _might_ be crocuses or
  • snowdrops or daffodils,” she whispered.
  • She bent very close to them and sniffed the fresh scent of the damp
  • earth. She liked it very much.
  • “Perhaps there are some other ones coming up in other places,” she
  • said. “I will go all over the garden and look.”
  • She did not skip, but walked. She went slowly and kept her eyes on the
  • ground. She looked in the old border beds and among the grass, and
  • after she had gone round, trying to miss nothing, she had found ever so
  • many more sharp, pale green points, and she had become quite excited
  • again.
  • “It isn’t a quite dead garden,” she cried out softly to herself. “Even
  • if the roses are dead, there are other things alive.”
  • She did not know anything about gardening, but the grass seemed so
  • thick in some of the places where the green points were pushing their
  • way through that she thought they did not seem to have room enough to
  • grow. She searched about until she found a rather sharp piece of wood
  • and knelt down and dug and weeded out the weeds and grass until she
  • made nice little clear places around them.
  • “Now they look as if they could breathe,” she said, after she had
  • finished with the first ones. “I am going to do ever so many more. I’ll
  • do all I can see. If I haven’t time today I can come tomorrow.”
  • She went from place to place, and dug and weeded, and enjoyed herself
  • so immensely that she was led on from bed to bed and into the grass
  • under the trees. The exercise made her so warm that she first threw her
  • coat off, and then her hat, and without knowing it she was smiling down
  • on to the grass and the pale green points all the time.
  • The robin was tremendously busy. He was very much pleased to see
  • gardening begun on his own estate. He had often wondered at Ben
  • Weatherstaff. Where gardening is done all sorts of delightful things to
  • eat are turned up with the soil. Now here was this new kind of creature
  • who was not half Ben’s size and yet had had the sense to come into his
  • garden and begin at once.
  • Mistress Mary worked in her garden until it was time to go to her
  • midday dinner. In fact, she was rather late in remembering, and when
  • she put on her coat and hat, and picked up her skipping-rope, she could
  • not believe that she had been working two or three hours. She had been
  • actually happy all the time; and dozens and dozens of the tiny, pale
  • green points were to be seen in cleared places, looking twice as
  • cheerful as they had looked before when the grass and weeds had been
  • smothering them.
  • “I shall come back this afternoon,” she said, looking all round at her
  • new kingdom, and speaking to the trees and the rose-bushes as if they
  • heard her.
  • Then she ran lightly across the grass, pushed open the slow old door
  • and slipped through it under the ivy. She had such red cheeks and such
  • bright eyes and ate such a dinner that Martha was delighted.
  • “Two pieces o’ meat an’ two helps o’ rice puddin’!” she said. “Eh!
  • mother will be pleased when I tell her what th’ skippin’-rope’s done
  • for thee.”
  • In the course of her digging with her pointed stick Mistress Mary had
  • found herself digging up a sort of white root rather like an onion. She
  • had put it back in its place and patted the earth carefully down on it
  • and just now she wondered if Martha could tell her what it was.
  • “Martha,” she said, “what are those white roots that look like onions?”
  • “They’re bulbs,” answered Martha. “Lots o’ spring flowers grow from
  • ’em. Th’ very little ones are snowdrops an’ crocuses an’ th’ big ones
  • are narcissuses an’ jonquils and daffydowndillys. Th’ biggest of all is
  • lilies an’ purple flags. Eh! they are nice. Dickon’s got a whole lot of
  • ’em planted in our bit o’ garden.”
  • “Does Dickon know all about them?” asked Mary, a new idea taking
  • possession of her.
  • “Our Dickon can make a flower grow out of a brick walk. Mother says he
  • just whispers things out o’ th’ ground.”
  • “Do bulbs live a long time? Would they live years and years if no one
  • helped them?” inquired Mary anxiously.
  • “They’re things as helps themselves,” said Martha. “That’s why poor
  • folk can afford to have ’em. If you don’t trouble ’em, most of ’em’ll
  • work away underground for a lifetime an’ spread out an’ have little
  • ’uns. There’s a place in th’ park woods here where there’s snowdrops by
  • thousands. They’re the prettiest sight in Yorkshire when th’ spring
  • comes. No one knows when they was first planted.”
  • “I wish the spring was here now,” said Mary. “I want to see all the
  • things that grow in England.”
  • She had finished her dinner and gone to her favorite seat on the
  • hearth-rug.
  • “I wish—I wish I had a little spade,” she said.
  • “Whatever does tha’ want a spade for?” asked Martha, laughing. “Art
  • tha’ goin’ to take to diggin’? I must tell mother that, too.”
  • Mary looked at the fire and pondered a little. She must be careful if
  • she meant to keep her secret kingdom. She wasn’t doing any harm, but if
  • Mr. Craven found out about the open door he would be fearfully angry
  • and get a new key and lock it up forevermore. She really could not bear
  • that.
  • “This is such a big lonely place,” she said slowly, as if she were
  • turning matters over in her mind. “The house is lonely, and the park is
  • lonely, and the gardens are lonely. So many places seem shut up. I
  • never did many things in India, but there were more people to look
  • at—natives and soldiers marching by—and sometimes bands playing, and my
  • Ayah told me stories. There is no one to talk to here except you and
  • Ben Weatherstaff. And you have to do your work and Ben Weatherstaff
  • won’t speak to me often. I thought if I had a little spade I could dig
  • somewhere as he does, and I might make a little garden if he would give
  • me some seeds.”
  • Martha’s face quite lighted up.
  • “There now!” she exclaimed, “if that wasn’t one of th’ things mother
  • said. She says, ‘There’s such a lot o’ room in that big place, why
  • don’t they give her a bit for herself, even if she doesn’t plant
  • nothin’ but parsley an’ radishes? She’d dig an’ rake away an’ be right
  • down happy over it.’ Them was the very words she said.”
  • “Were they?” said Mary. “How many things she knows, doesn’t she?”
  • “Eh!” said Martha. “It’s like she says: ‘A woman as brings up twelve
  • children learns something besides her A B C. Children’s as good as
  • ’rithmetic to set you findin’ out things.’”
  • “How much would a spade cost—a little one?” Mary asked.
  • “Well,” was Martha’s reflective answer, “at Thwaite village there’s a
  • shop or so an’ I saw little garden sets with a spade an’ a rake an’ a
  • fork all tied together for two shillings. An’ they was stout enough to
  • work with, too.”
  • “I’ve got more than that in my purse,” said Mary. “Mrs. Morrison gave
  • me five shillings and Mrs. Medlock gave me some money from Mr. Craven.”
  • “Did he remember thee that much?” exclaimed Martha.
  • “Mrs. Medlock said I was to have a shilling a week to spend. She gives
  • me one every Saturday. I didn’t know what to spend it on.”
  • “My word! that’s riches,” said Martha. “Tha’ can buy anything in th’
  • world tha’ wants. Th’ rent of our cottage is only one an’ threepence
  • an’ it’s like pullin’ eye-teeth to get it. Now I’ve just thought of
  • somethin’,” putting her hands on her hips.
  • “What?” said Mary eagerly.
  • “In the shop at Thwaite they sell packages o’ flower-seeds for a penny
  • each, and our Dickon he knows which is th’ prettiest ones an’ how to
  • make ’em grow. He walks over to Thwaite many a day just for th’ fun of
  • it. Does tha’ know how to print letters?” suddenly.
  • “I know how to write,” Mary answered.
  • Martha shook her head.
  • “Our Dickon can only read printin’. If tha’ could print we could write
  • a letter to him an’ ask him to go an’ buy th’ garden tools an’ th’
  • seeds at th’ same time.”
  • “Oh! you’re a good girl!” Mary cried. “You are, really! I didn’t know
  • you were so nice. I know I can print letters if I try. Let’s ask Mrs.
  • Medlock for a pen and ink and some paper.”
  • “I’ve got some of my own,” said Martha. “I bought ’em so I could print
  • a bit of a letter to mother of a Sunday. I’ll go and get it.”
  • She ran out of the room, and Mary stood by the fire and twisted her
  • thin little hands together with sheer pleasure.
  • “If I have a spade,” she whispered, “I can make the earth nice and soft
  • and dig up weeds. If I have seeds and can make flowers grow the garden
  • won’t be dead at all—it will come alive.”
  • She did not go out again that afternoon because when Martha returned
  • with her pen and ink and paper she was obliged to clear the table and
  • carry the plates and dishes downstairs and when she got into the
  • kitchen Mrs. Medlock was there and told her to do something, so Mary
  • waited for what seemed to her a long time before she came back. Then it
  • was a serious piece of work to write to Dickon. Mary had been taught
  • very little because her governesses had disliked her too much to stay
  • with her. She could not spell particularly well but she found that she
  • could print letters when she tried. This was the letter Martha dictated
  • to her:
  • “_My Dear Dickon:_
  • This comes hoping to find you well as it leaves me at present. Miss
  • Mary has plenty of money and will you go to Thwaite and buy her some
  • flower seeds and a set of garden tools to make a flower-bed. Pick the
  • prettiest ones and easy to grow because she has never done it before
  • and lived in India which is different. Give my love to mother and
  • everyone of you. Miss Mary is going to tell me a lot more so that on my
  • next day out you can hear about elephants and camels and gentlemen
  • going hunting lions and tigers.
  • “Your loving sister,
  • “Martha Phœbe Sowerby.”
  • “We’ll put the money in th’ envelope an’ I’ll get th’ butcher boy to
  • take it in his cart. He’s a great friend o’ Dickon’s,” said Martha.
  • “How shall I get the things when Dickon buys them?”
  • “He’ll bring ’em to you himself. He’ll like to walk over this way.”
  • “Oh!” exclaimed Mary, “then I shall see him! I never thought I should
  • see Dickon.”
  • “Does tha’ want to see him?” asked Martha suddenly, for Mary had looked
  • so pleased.
  • “Yes, I do. I never saw a boy foxes and crows loved. I want to see him
  • very much.”
  • Martha gave a little start, as if she remembered something.
  • “Now to think,” she broke out, “to think o’ me forgettin’ that there;
  • an’ I thought I was goin’ to tell you first thing this mornin’. I asked
  • mother—and she said she’d ask Mrs. Medlock her own self.”
  • “Do you mean—” Mary began.
  • “What I said Tuesday. Ask her if you might be driven over to our
  • cottage some day and have a bit o’ mother’s hot oat cake, an’ butter,
  • an’ a glass o’ milk.”
  • It seemed as if all the interesting things were happening in one day.
  • To think of going over the moor in the daylight and when the sky was
  • blue! To think of going into the cottage which held twelve children!
  • “Does she think Mrs. Medlock would let me go?” she asked, quite
  • anxiously.
  • “Aye, she thinks she would. She knows what a tidy woman mother is and
  • how clean she keeps the cottage.”
  • “If I went I should see your mother as well as Dickon,” said Mary,
  • thinking it over and liking the idea very much. “She doesn’t seem to be
  • like the mothers in India.”
  • Her work in the garden and the excitement of the afternoon ended by
  • making her feel quiet and thoughtful. Martha stayed with her until
  • tea-time, but they sat in comfortable quiet and talked very little. But
  • just before Martha went downstairs for the tea-tray, Mary asked a
  • question.
  • “Martha,” she said, “has the scullery-maid had the toothache again
  • today?”
  • Martha certainly started slightly.
  • “What makes thee ask that?” she said.
  • “Because when I waited so long for you to come back I opened the door
  • and walked down the corridor to see if you were coming. And I heard
  • that far-off crying again, just as we heard it the other night. There
  • isn’t a wind today, so you see it couldn’t have been the wind.”
  • “Eh!” said Martha restlessly. “Tha’ mustn’t go walkin’ about in
  • corridors an’ listenin’. Mr. Craven would be that there angry there’s
  • no knowin’ what he’d do.”
  • “I wasn’t listening,” said Mary. “I was just waiting for you—and I
  • heard it. That’s three times.”
  • “My word! There’s Mrs. Medlock’s bell,” said Martha, and she almost ran
  • out of the room.
  • “It’s the strangest house anyone ever lived in,” said Mary drowsily, as
  • she dropped her head on the cushioned seat of the armchair near her.
  • Fresh air, and digging, and skipping-rope had made her feel so
  • comfortably tired that she fell asleep.
  • CHAPTER X
  • DICKON
  • The sun shone down for nearly a week on the secret garden. The Secret
  • Garden was what Mary called it when she was thinking of it. She liked
  • the name, and she liked still more the feeling that when its beautiful
  • old walls shut her in no one knew where she was. It seemed almost like
  • being shut out of the world in some fairy place. The few books she had
  • read and liked had been fairy-story books, and she had read of secret
  • gardens in some of the stories. Sometimes people went to sleep in them
  • for a hundred years, which she had thought must be rather stupid. She
  • had no intention of going to sleep, and, in fact, she was becoming
  • wider awake every day which passed at Misselthwaite. She was beginning
  • to like to be out of doors; she no longer hated the wind, but enjoyed
  • it. She could run faster, and longer, and she could skip up to a
  • hundred. The bulbs in the secret garden must have been much astonished.
  • Such nice clear places were made round them that they had all the
  • breathing space they wanted, and really, if Mistress Mary had known it,
  • they began to cheer up under the dark earth and work tremendously. The
  • sun could get at them and warm them, and when the rain came down it
  • could reach them at once, so they began to feel very much alive.
  • Mary was an odd, determined little person, and now she had something
  • interesting to be determined about, she was very much absorbed, indeed.
  • She worked and dug and pulled up weeds steadily, only becoming more
  • pleased with her work every hour instead of tiring of it. It seemed to
  • her like a fascinating sort of play. She found many more of the
  • sprouting pale green points than she had ever hoped to find. They
  • seemed to be starting up everywhere and each day she was sure she found
  • tiny new ones, some so tiny that they barely peeped above the earth.
  • There were so many that she remembered what Martha had said about the
  • “snowdrops by the thousands,” and about bulbs spreading and making new
  • ones. These had been left to themselves for ten years and perhaps they
  • had spread, like the snowdrops, into thousands. She wondered how long
  • it would be before they showed that they were flowers. Sometimes she
  • stopped digging to look at the garden and try to imagine what it would
  • be like when it was covered with thousands of lovely things in bloom.
  • During that week of sunshine, she became more intimate with Ben
  • Weatherstaff. She surprised him several times by seeming to start up
  • beside him as if she sprang out of the earth. The truth was that she
  • was afraid that he would pick up his tools and go away if he saw her
  • coming, so she always walked toward him as silently as possible. But,
  • in fact, he did not object to her as strongly as he had at first.
  • Perhaps he was secretly rather flattered by her evident desire for his
  • elderly company. Then, also, she was more civil than she had been. He
  • did not know that when she first saw him she spoke to him as she would
  • have spoken to a native, and had not known that a cross, sturdy old
  • Yorkshire man was not accustomed to salaam to his masters, and be
  • merely commanded by them to do things.
  • “Tha’rt like th’ robin,” he said to her one morning when he lifted his
  • head and saw her standing by him. “I never knows when I shall see thee
  • or which side tha’ll come from.”
  • “He’s friends with me now,” said Mary.
  • “That’s like him,” snapped Ben Weatherstaff. “Makin’ up to th’ women
  • folk just for vanity an’ flightiness. There’s nothin’ he wouldn’t do
  • for th’ sake o’ showin’ off an’ flirtin’ his tail-feathers. He’s as
  • full o’ pride as an egg’s full o’ meat.”
  • He very seldom talked much and sometimes did not even answer Mary’s
  • questions except by a grunt, but this morning he said more than usual.
  • He stood up and rested one hobnailed boot on the top of his spade while
  • he looked her over.
  • “How long has tha’ been here?” he jerked out.
  • “I think it’s about a month,” she answered.
  • “Tha’s beginnin’ to do Misselthwaite credit,” he said. “Tha’s a bit
  • fatter than tha’ was an’ tha’s not quite so yeller. Tha’ looked like a
  • young plucked crow when tha’ first came into this garden. Thinks I to
  • myself I never set eyes on an uglier, sourer faced young ’un.”
  • Mary was not vain and as she had never thought much of her looks she
  • was not greatly disturbed.
  • “I know I’m fatter,” she said. “My stockings are getting tighter. They
  • used to make wrinkles. There’s the robin, Ben Weatherstaff.”
  • There, indeed, was the robin, and she thought he looked nicer than
  • ever. His red waistcoat was as glossy as satin and he flirted his wings
  • and tail and tilted his head and hopped about with all sorts of lively
  • graces. He seemed determined to make Ben Weatherstaff admire him. But
  • Ben was sarcastic.
  • “Aye, there tha’ art!” he said. “Tha’ can put up with me for a bit
  • sometimes when tha’s got no one better. Tha’s been reddenin’ up thy
  • waistcoat an’ polishin’ thy feathers this two weeks. I know what tha’s
  • up to. Tha’s courtin’ some bold young madam somewhere tellin’ thy lies
  • to her about bein’ th’ finest cock robin on Missel Moor an’ ready to
  • fight all th’ rest of ’em.”
  • “Oh! look at him!” exclaimed Mary.
  • The robin was evidently in a fascinating, bold mood. He hopped closer
  • and closer and looked at Ben Weatherstaff more and more engagingly. He
  • flew on to the nearest currant bush and tilted his head and sang a
  • little song right at him.
  • “Tha’ thinks tha’ll get over me by doin’ that,” said Ben, wrinkling his
  • face up in such a way that Mary felt sure he was trying not to look
  • pleased. “Tha’ thinks no one can stand out against thee—that’s what
  • tha’ thinks.”
  • The robin spread his wings—Mary could scarcely believe her eyes. He
  • flew right up to the handle of Ben Weatherstaff’s spade and alighted on
  • the top of it. Then the old man’s face wrinkled itself slowly into a
  • new expression. He stood still as if he were afraid to breathe—as if he
  • would not have stirred for the world, lest his robin should start away.
  • He spoke quite in a whisper.
  • “Well, I’m danged!” he said as softly as if he were saying something
  • quite different. “Tha’ does know how to get at a chap—tha’ does! Tha’s
  • fair unearthly, tha’s so knowin’.”
  • And he stood without stirring—almost without drawing his breath—until
  • the robin gave another flirt to his wings and flew away. Then he stood
  • looking at the handle of the spade as if there might be Magic in it,
  • and then he began to dig again and said nothing for several minutes.
  • But because he kept breaking into a slow grin now and then, Mary was
  • not afraid to talk to him.
  • “Have you a garden of your own?” she asked.
  • “No. I’m bachelder an’ lodge with Martin at th’ gate.”
  • “If you had one,” said Mary, “what would you plant?”
  • “Cabbages an’ ’taters an’ onions.”
  • “But if you wanted to make a flower garden,” persisted Mary, “what
  • would you plant?”
  • “Bulbs an’ sweet-smellin’ things—but mostly roses.”
  • Mary’s face lighted up.
  • “Do you like roses?” she said.
  • Ben Weatherstaff rooted up a weed and threw it aside before he
  • answered.
  • “Well, yes, I do. I was learned that by a young lady I was gardener to.
  • She had a lot in a place she was fond of, an’ she loved ’em like they
  • was children—or robins. I’ve seen her bend over an’ kiss ’em.” He
  • dragged out another weed and scowled at it. “That were as much as ten
  • year’ ago.”
  • “Where is she now?” asked Mary, much interested.
  • “Heaven,” he answered, and drove his spade deep into the soil,
  • “’cording to what parson says.”
  • “What happened to the roses?” Mary asked again, more interested than
  • ever.
  • “They was left to themselves.”
  • Mary was becoming quite excited.
  • “Did they quite die? Do roses quite die when they are left to
  • themselves?” she ventured.
  • “Well, I’d got to like ’em—an’ I liked her—an’ she liked ’em,” Ben
  • Weatherstaff admitted reluctantly. “Once or twice a year I’d go an’
  • work at ’em a bit—prune ’em an’ dig about th’ roots. They run wild, but
  • they was in rich soil, so some of ’em lived.”
  • “When they have no leaves and look gray and brown and dry, how can you
  • tell whether they are dead or alive?” inquired Mary.
  • “Wait till th’ spring gets at ’em—wait till th’ sun shines on th’ rain
  • and th’ rain falls on th’ sunshine an’ then tha’ll find out.”
  • “How—how?” cried Mary, forgetting to be careful.
  • “Look along th’ twigs an’ branches an’ if tha’ see a bit of a brown
  • lump swelling here an’ there, watch it after th’ warm rain an’ see what
  • happens.” He stopped suddenly and looked curiously at her eager face.
  • “Why does tha’ care so much about roses an’ such, all of a sudden?” he
  • demanded.
  • Mistress Mary felt her face grow red. She was almost afraid to answer.
  • “I—I want to play that—that I have a garden of my own,” she stammered.
  • “I—there is nothing for me to do. I have nothing—and no one.”
  • “Well,” said Ben Weatherstaff slowly, as he watched her, “that’s true.
  • Tha’ hasn’t.”
  • He said it in such an odd way that Mary wondered if he was actually a
  • little sorry for her. She had never felt sorry for herself; she had
  • only felt tired and cross, because she disliked people and things so
  • much. But now the world seemed to be changing and getting nicer. If no
  • one found out about the secret garden, she should enjoy herself always.
  • She stayed with him for ten or fifteen minutes longer and asked him as
  • many questions as she dared. He answered everyone of them in his queer
  • grunting way and he did not seem really cross and did not pick up his
  • spade and leave her. He said something about roses just as she was
  • going away and it reminded her of the ones he had said he had been fond
  • of.
  • “Do you go and see those other roses now?” she asked.
  • “Not been this year. My rheumatics has made me too stiff in th’
  • joints.”
  • He said it in his grumbling voice, and then quite suddenly he seemed to
  • get angry with her, though she did not see why he should.
  • “Now look here!” he said sharply. “Don’t tha’ ask so many questions.
  • Tha’rt th’ worst wench for askin’ questions I’ve ever come across. Get
  • thee gone an’ play thee. I’ve done talkin’ for today.”
  • And he said it so crossly that she knew there was not the least use in
  • staying another minute. She went skipping slowly down the outside walk,
  • thinking him over and saying to herself that, queer as it was, here was
  • another person whom she liked in spite of his crossness. She liked old
  • Ben Weatherstaff. Yes, she did like him. She always wanted to try to
  • make him talk to her. Also she began to believe that he knew everything
  • in the world about flowers.
  • There was a laurel-hedged walk which curved round the secret garden and
  • ended at a gate which opened into a wood, in the park. She thought she
  • would slip round this walk and look into the wood and see if there were
  • any rabbits hopping about. She enjoyed the skipping very much and when
  • she reached the little gate she opened it and went through because she
  • heard a low, peculiar whistling sound and wanted to find out what it
  • was.
  • It was a very strange thing indeed. She quite caught her breath as she
  • stopped to look at it. A boy was sitting under a tree, with his back
  • against it, playing on a rough wooden pipe. He was a funny looking boy
  • about twelve. He looked very clean and his nose turned up and his
  • cheeks were as red as poppies and never had Mistress Mary seen such
  • round and such blue eyes in any boy’s face. And on the trunk of the
  • tree he leaned against, a brown squirrel was clinging and watching him,
  • and from behind a bush nearby a cock pheasant was delicately stretching
  • his neck to peep out, and quite near him were two rabbits sitting up
  • and sniffing with tremulous noses—and actually it appeared as if they
  • were all drawing near to watch him and listen to the strange low little
  • call his pipe seemed to make.
  • When he saw Mary he held up his hand and spoke to her in a voice almost
  • as low as and rather like his piping.
  • “Don’t tha’ move,” he said. “It’d flight ’em.”
  • Mary remained motionless. He stopped playing his pipe and began to rise
  • from the ground. He moved so slowly that it scarcely seemed as though
  • he were moving at all, but at last he stood on his feet and then the
  • squirrel scampered back up into the branches of his tree, the pheasant
  • withdrew his head and the rabbits dropped on all fours and began to hop
  • away, though not at all as if they were frightened.
  • “I’m Dickon,” the boy said. “I know tha’rt Miss Mary.”
  • Then Mary realized that somehow she had known at first that he was
  • Dickon. Who else could have been charming rabbits and pheasants as the
  • natives charm snakes in India? He had a wide, red, curving mouth and
  • his smile spread all over his face.
  • “I got up slow,” he explained, “because if tha’ makes a quick move it
  • startles ’em. A body ’as to move gentle an’ speak low when wild things
  • is about.”
  • He did not speak to her as if they had never seen each other before but
  • as if he knew her quite well. Mary knew nothing about boys and she
  • spoke to him a little stiffly because she felt rather shy.
  • “Did you get Martha’s letter?” she asked.
  • He nodded his curly, rust-colored head.
  • “That’s why I come.”
  • He stooped to pick up something which had been lying on the ground
  • beside him when he piped.
  • “I’ve got th’ garden tools. There’s a little spade an’ rake an’ a fork
  • an’ hoe. Eh! they are good ’uns. There’s a trowel, too. An’ th’ woman
  • in th’ shop threw in a packet o’ white poppy an’ one o’ blue larkspur
  • when I bought th’ other seeds.”
  • “Will you show the seeds to me?” Mary said.
  • She wished she could talk as he did. His speech was so quick and easy.
  • It sounded as if he liked her and was not the least afraid she would
  • not like him, though he was only a common moor boy, in patched clothes
  • and with a funny face and a rough, rusty-red head. As she came closer
  • to him she noticed that there was a clean fresh scent of heather and
  • grass and leaves about him, almost as if he were made of them. She
  • liked it very much and when she looked into his funny face with the red
  • cheeks and round blue eyes she forgot that she had felt shy.
  • “Let us sit down on this log and look at them,” she said.
  • They sat down and he took a clumsy little brown paper package out of
  • his coat pocket. He untied the string and inside there were ever so
  • many neater and smaller packages with a picture of a flower on each
  • one.
  • “There’s a lot o’ mignonette an’ poppies,” he said. “Mignonette’s th’
  • sweetest smellin’ thing as grows, an’ it’ll grow wherever you cast it,
  • same as poppies will. Them as’ll come up an’ bloom if you just whistle
  • to ’em, them’s th’ nicest of all.”
  • He stopped and turned his head quickly, his poppy-cheeked face lighting
  • up.
  • “Where’s that robin as is callin’ us?” he said.
  • The chirp came from a thick holly bush, bright with scarlet berries,
  • and Mary thought she knew whose it was.
  • “Is it really calling us?” she asked.
  • “Aye,” said Dickon, as if it was the most natural thing in the world,
  • “he’s callin’ someone he’s friends with. That’s same as sayin’ ‘Here I
  • am. Look at me. I wants a bit of a chat.’ There he is in the bush.
  • Whose is he?”
  • “He’s Ben Weatherstaff’s, but I think he knows me a little,” answered
  • Mary.
  • “Aye, he knows thee,” said Dickon in his low voice again. “An’ he likes
  • thee. He’s took thee on. He’ll tell me all about thee in a minute.”
  • He moved quite close to the bush with the slow movement Mary had
  • noticed before, and then he made a sound almost like the robin’s own
  • twitter. The robin listened a few seconds, intently, and then answered
  • quite as if he were replying to a question.
  • “Aye, he’s a friend o’ yours,” chuckled Dickon.
  • “Do you think he is?” cried Mary eagerly. She did so want to know. “Do
  • you think he really likes me?”
  • “He wouldn’t come near thee if he didn’t,” answered Dickon. “Birds is
  • rare choosers an’ a robin can flout a body worse than a man. See, he’s
  • making up to thee now. ‘Cannot tha’ see a chap?’ he’s sayin’.”
  • And it really seemed as if it must be true. He so sidled and twittered
  • and tilted as he hopped on his bush.
  • “Do you understand everything birds say?” said Mary.
  • Dickon’s grin spread until he seemed all wide, red, curving mouth, and
  • he rubbed his rough head.
  • “I think I do, and they think I do,” he said. “I’ve lived on th’ moor
  • with ’em so long. I’ve watched ’em break shell an’ come out an’ fledge
  • an’ learn to fly an’ begin to sing, till I think I’m one of ’em.
  • Sometimes I think p’raps I’m a bird, or a fox, or a rabbit, or a
  • squirrel, or even a beetle, an’ I don’t know it.”
  • He laughed and came back to the log and began to talk about the flower
  • seeds again. He told her what they looked like when they were flowers;
  • he told her how to plant them, and watch them, and feed and water them.
  • “See here,” he said suddenly, turning round to look at her. “I’ll plant
  • them for thee myself. Where is tha’ garden?”
  • Mary’s thin hands clutched each other as they lay on her lap. She did
  • not know what to say, so for a whole minute she said nothing. She had
  • never thought of this. She felt miserable. And she felt as if she went
  • red and then pale.
  • “Tha’s got a bit o’ garden, hasn’t tha’?” Dickon said.
  • It was true that she had turned red and then pale. Dickon saw her do
  • it, and as she still said nothing, he began to be puzzled.
  • “Wouldn’t they give thee a bit?” he asked. “Hasn’t tha’ got any yet?”
  • She held her hands tighter and turned her eyes toward him.
  • “I don’t know anything about boys,” she said slowly. “Could you keep a
  • secret, if I told you one? It’s a great secret. I don’t know what I
  • should do if anyone found it out. I believe I should die!” She said the
  • last sentence quite fiercely.
  • Dickon looked more puzzled than ever and even rubbed his hand over his
  • rough head again, but he answered quite good-humoredly.
  • “I’m keepin’ secrets all th’ time,” he said. “If I couldn’t keep
  • secrets from th’ other lads, secrets about foxes’ cubs, an’ birds’
  • nests, an’ wild things’ holes, there’d be naught safe on th’ moor. Aye,
  • I can keep secrets.”
  • Mistress Mary did not mean to put out her hand and clutch his sleeve
  • but she did it.
  • “I’ve stolen a garden,” she said very fast. “It isn’t mine. It isn’t
  • anybody’s. Nobody wants it, nobody cares for it, nobody ever goes into
  • it. Perhaps everything is dead in it already. I don’t know.”
  • She began to feel hot and as contrary as she had ever felt in her life.
  • “I don’t care, I don’t care! Nobody has any right to take it from me
  • when I care about it and they don’t. They’re letting it die, all shut
  • in by itself,” she ended passionately, and she threw her arms over her
  • face and burst out crying—poor little Mistress Mary.
  • Dickon’s curious blue eyes grew rounder and rounder.
  • “Eh-h-h!” he said, drawing his exclamation out slowly, and the way he
  • did it meant both wonder and sympathy.
  • “I’ve nothing to do,” said Mary. “Nothing belongs to me. I found it
  • myself and I got into it myself. I was only just like the robin, and
  • they wouldn’t take it from the robin.”
  • “Where is it?” asked Dickon in a dropped voice.
  • Mistress Mary got up from the log at once. She knew she felt contrary
  • again, and obstinate, and she did not care at all. She was imperious
  • and Indian, and at the same time hot and sorrowful.
  • “Come with me and I’ll show you,” she said.
  • She led him round the laurel path and to the walk where the ivy grew so
  • thickly. Dickon followed her with a queer, almost pitying, look on his
  • face. He felt as if he were being led to look at some strange bird’s
  • nest and must move softly. When she stepped to the wall and lifted the
  • hanging ivy he started. There was a door and Mary pushed it slowly open
  • and they passed in together, and then Mary stood and waved her hand
  • round defiantly.
  • “It’s this,” she said. “It’s a secret garden, and I’m the only one in
  • the world who wants it to be alive.”
  • Dickon looked round and round about it, and round and round again.
  • “Eh!” he almost whispered, “it is a queer, pretty place! It’s like as
  • if a body was in a dream.”
  • CHAPTER XI
  • THE NEST OF THE MISSEL THRUSH
  • For two or three minutes he stood looking round him, while Mary watched
  • him, and then he began to walk about softly, even more lightly than
  • Mary had walked the first time she had found herself inside the four
  • walls. His eyes seemed to be taking in everything—the gray trees with
  • the gray creepers climbing over them and hanging from their branches,
  • the tangle on the walls and among the grass, the evergreen alcoves with
  • the stone seats and tall flower urns standing in them.
  • “I never thought I’d see this place,” he said at last, in a whisper.
  • “Did you know about it?” asked Mary.
  • She had spoken aloud and he made a sign to her.
  • “We must talk low,” he said, “or someone’ll hear us an’ wonder what’s
  • to do in here.”
  • “Oh! I forgot!” said Mary, feeling frightened and putting her hand
  • quickly against her mouth. “Did you know about the garden?” she asked
  • again when she had recovered herself.
  • Dickon nodded.
  • “Martha told me there was one as no one ever went inside,” he answered.
  • “Us used to wonder what it was like.”
  • He stopped and looked round at the lovely gray tangle about him, and
  • his round eyes looked queerly happy.
  • “Eh! the nests as’ll be here come springtime,” he said. “It’d be th’
  • safest nestin’ place in England. No one never comin’ near an’ tangles
  • o’ trees an’ roses to build in. I wonder all th’ birds on th’ moor
  • don’t build here.”
  • Mistress Mary put her hand on his arm again without knowing it.
  • “Will there be roses?” she whispered. “Can you tell? I thought perhaps
  • they were all dead.”
  • “Eh! No! Not them—not all of ’em!” he answered. “Look here!”
  • He stepped over to the nearest tree—an old, old one with gray lichen
  • all over its bark, but upholding a curtain of tangled sprays and
  • branches. He took a thick knife out of his pocket and opened one of its
  • blades.
  • “There’s lots o’ dead wood as ought to be cut out,” he said. “An’
  • there’s a lot o’ old wood, but it made some new last year. This here’s
  • a new bit,” and he touched a shoot which looked brownish green instead
  • of hard, dry gray.
  • Mary touched it herself in an eager, reverent way.
  • “That one?” she said. “Is that one quite alive quite?”
  • Dickon curved his wide smiling mouth.
  • “It’s as wick as you or me,” he said; and Mary remembered that Martha
  • had told her that “wick” meant “alive” or “lively.”
  • “I’m glad it’s wick!” she cried out in her whisper. “I want them all to
  • be wick. Let us go round the garden and count how many wick ones there
  • are.”
  • She quite panted with eagerness, and Dickon was as eager as she was.
  • They went from tree to tree and from bush to bush. Dickon carried his
  • knife in his hand and showed her things which she thought wonderful.
  • “They’ve run wild,” he said, “but th’ strongest ones has fair thrived
  • on it. The delicatest ones has died out, but th’ others has growed an’
  • growed, an’ spread an’ spread, till they’s a wonder. See here!” and he
  • pulled down a thick gray, dry-looking branch. “A body might think this
  • was dead wood, but I don’t believe it is—down to th’ root. I’ll cut it
  • low down an’ see.”
  • He knelt and with his knife cut the lifeless-looking branch through,
  • not far above the earth.
  • “There!” he said exultantly. “I told thee so. There’s green in that
  • wood yet. Look at it.”
  • Mary was down on her knees before he spoke, gazing with all her might.
  • “When it looks a bit greenish an’ juicy like that, it’s wick,” he
  • explained. “When th’ inside is dry an’ breaks easy, like this here
  • piece I’ve cut off, it’s done for. There’s a big root here as all this
  • live wood sprung out of, an’ if th’ old wood’s cut off an’ it’s dug
  • round, and took care of there’ll be—” he stopped and lifted his face to
  • look up at the climbing and hanging sprays above him—“there’ll be a
  • fountain o’ roses here this summer.”
  • They went from bush to bush and from tree to tree. He was very strong
  • and clever with his knife and knew how to cut the dry and dead wood
  • away, and could tell when an unpromising bough or twig had still green
  • life in it. In the course of half an hour Mary thought she could tell
  • too, and when he cut through a lifeless-looking branch she would cry
  • out joyfully under her breath when she caught sight of the least shade
  • of moist green. The spade, and hoe, and fork were very useful. He
  • showed her how to use the fork while he dug about roots with the spade
  • and stirred the earth and let the air in.
  • They were working industriously round one of the biggest standard roses
  • when he caught sight of something which made him utter an exclamation
  • of surprise.
  • “Why!” he cried, pointing to the grass a few feet away. “Who did that
  • there?”
  • It was one of Mary’s own little clearings round the pale green points.
  • “I did it,” said Mary.
  • “Why, I thought tha’ didn’t know nothin’ about gardenin’,” he
  • exclaimed.
  • “I don’t,” she answered, “but they were so little, and the grass was so
  • thick and strong, and they looked as if they had no room to breathe. So
  • I made a place for them. I don’t even know what they are.”
  • Dickon went and knelt down by them, smiling his wide smile.
  • “Tha’ was right,” he said. “A gardener couldn’t have told thee better.
  • They’ll grow now like Jack’s bean-stalk. They’re crocuses an’
  • snowdrops, an’ these here is narcissuses,” turning to another patch,
  • “an here’s daffydowndillys. Eh! they will be a sight.”
  • He ran from one clearing to another.
  • “Tha’ has done a lot o’ work for such a little wench,” he said, looking
  • her over.
  • “I’m growing fatter,” said Mary, “and I’m growing stronger. I used
  • always to be tired. When I dig I’m not tired at all. I like to smell
  • the earth when it’s turned up.”
  • “It’s rare good for thee,” he said, nodding his head wisely. “There’s
  • naught as nice as th’ smell o’ good clean earth, except th’ smell o’
  • fresh growin’ things when th’ rain falls on ’em. I get out on th’ moor
  • many a day when it’s rainin’ an’ I lie under a bush an’ listen to th’
  • soft swish o’ drops on th’ heather an’ I just sniff an’ sniff. My nose
  • end fair quivers like a rabbit’s, mother says.”
  • “Do you never catch cold?” inquired Mary, gazing at him wonderingly.
  • She had never seen such a funny boy, or such a nice one.
  • “Not me,” he said, grinning. “I never ketched cold since I was born. I
  • wasn’t brought up nesh enough. I’ve chased about th’ moor in all
  • weathers same as th’ rabbits does. Mother says I’ve sniffed up too much
  • fresh air for twelve year’ to ever get to sniffin’ with cold. I’m as
  • tough as a white-thorn knobstick.”
  • He was working all the time he was talking and Mary was following him
  • and helping him with her fork or the trowel.
  • “There’s a lot of work to do here!” he said once, looking about quite
  • exultantly.
  • “Will you come again and help me to do it?” Mary begged. “I’m sure I
  • can help, too. I can dig and pull up weeds, and do whatever you tell
  • me. Oh! do come, Dickon!”
  • “I’ll come every day if tha’ wants me, rain or shine,” he answered
  • stoutly. “It’s the best fun I ever had in my life—shut in here an’
  • wakenin’ up a garden.”
  • “If you will come,” said Mary, “if you will help me to make it alive
  • I’ll—I don’t know what I’ll do,” she ended helplessly. What could you
  • do for a boy like that?
  • “I’ll tell thee what tha’ll do,” said Dickon, with his happy grin.
  • “Tha’ll get fat an’ tha’ll get as hungry as a young fox an’ tha’ll
  • learn how to talk to th’ robin same as I do. Eh! we’ll have a lot o’
  • fun.”
  • He began to walk about, looking up in the trees and at the walls and
  • bushes with a thoughtful expression.
  • “I wouldn’t want to make it look like a gardener’s garden, all clipped
  • an’ spick an’ span, would you?” he said. “It’s nicer like this with
  • things runnin’ wild, an’ swingin’ an’ catchin’ hold of each other.”
  • “Don’t let us make it tidy,” said Mary anxiously. “It wouldn’t seem
  • like a secret garden if it was tidy.”
  • Dickon stood rubbing his rusty-red head with a rather puzzled look.
  • “It’s a secret garden sure enough,” he said, “but seems like someone
  • besides th’ robin must have been in it since it was shut up ten year’
  • ago.”
  • “But the door was locked and the key was buried,” said Mary. “No one
  • could get in.”
  • “That’s true,” he answered. “It’s a queer place. Seems to me as if
  • there’d been a bit o’ prunin’ done here an’ there, later than ten year’
  • ago.”
  • “But how could it have been done?” said Mary.
  • He was examining a branch of a standard rose and he shook his head.
  • “Aye! how could it!” he murmured. “With th’ door locked an’ th’ key
  • buried.”
  • Mistress Mary always felt that however many years she lived she should
  • never forget that first morning when her garden began to grow. Of
  • course, it did seem to begin to grow for her that morning. When Dickon
  • began to clear places to plant seeds, she remembered what Basil had
  • sung at her when he wanted to tease her.
  • “Are there any flowers that look like bells?” she inquired.
  • “Lilies o’ th’ valley does,” he answered, digging away with the trowel,
  • “an’ there’s Canterbury bells, an’ campanulas.”
  • “Let’s plant some,” said Mary.
  • “There’s lilies o’ th, valley here already; I saw ’em. They’ll have
  • growed too close an’ we’ll have to separate ’em, but there’s plenty.
  • Th’ other ones takes two years to bloom from seed, but I can bring you
  • some bits o’ plants from our cottage garden. Why does tha’ want ’em?”
  • Then Mary told him about Basil and his brothers and sisters in India
  • and of how she had hated them and of their calling her “Mistress Mary
  • Quite Contrary.”
  • “They used to dance round and sing at me. They sang—
  • ‘Mistress Mary, quite contrary,
  • How does your garden grow?
  • With silver bells, and cockle shells,
  • And marigolds all in a row.’
  • I just remembered it and it made me wonder if there were really flowers
  • like silver bells.”
  • She frowned a little and gave her trowel a rather spiteful dig into the
  • earth.
  • “I wasn’t as contrary as they were.”
  • But Dickon laughed.
  • “Eh!” he said, and as he crumbled the rich black soil she saw he was
  • sniffing up the scent of it. “There doesn’t seem to be no need for no
  • one to be contrary when there’s flowers an’ such like, an’ such lots o’
  • friendly wild things runnin’ about makin’ homes for themselves, or
  • buildin’ nests an’ singin’ an’ whistlin’, does there?”
  • Mary, kneeling by him holding the seeds, looked at him and stopped
  • frowning.
  • “Dickon,” she said, “you are as nice as Martha said you were. I like
  • you, and you make the fifth person. I never thought I should like five
  • people.”
  • Dickon sat up on his heels as Martha did when she was polishing the
  • grate. He did look funny and delightful, Mary thought, with his round
  • blue eyes and red cheeks and happy looking turned-up nose.
  • “Only five folk as tha’ likes?” he said. “Who is th’ other four?”
  • “Your mother and Martha,” Mary checked them off on her fingers, “and
  • the robin and Ben Weatherstaff.”
  • Dickon laughed so that he was obliged to stifle the sound by putting
  • his arm over his mouth.
  • “I know tha’ thinks I’m a queer lad,” he said, “but I think tha’ art
  • th’ queerest little lass I ever saw.”
  • Then Mary did a strange thing. She leaned forward and asked him a
  • question she had never dreamed of asking anyone before. And she tried
  • to ask it in Yorkshire because that was his language, and in India a
  • native was always pleased if you knew his speech.
  • “Does tha’ like me?” she said.
  • “Eh!” he answered heartily, “that I does. I likes thee wonderful, an’
  • so does th’ robin, I do believe!”
  • “That’s two, then,” said Mary. “That’s two for me.”
  • And then they began to work harder than ever and more joyfully. Mary
  • was startled and sorry when she heard the big clock in the courtyard
  • strike the hour of her midday dinner.
  • “I shall have to go,” she said mournfully. “And you will have to go
  • too, won’t you?”
  • Dickon grinned.
  • “My dinner’s easy to carry about with me,” he said. “Mother always lets
  • me put a bit o’ somethin’ in my pocket.”
  • He picked up his coat from the grass and brought out of a pocket a
  • lumpy little bundle tied up in a quite clean, coarse, blue and white
  • handkerchief. It held two thick pieces of bread with a slice of
  • something laid between them.
  • “It’s oftenest naught but bread,” he said, “but I’ve got a fine slice
  • o’ fat bacon with it today.”
  • Mary thought it looked a queer dinner, but he seemed ready to enjoy it.
  • “Run on an’ get thy victuals,” he said. “I’ll be done with mine first.
  • I’ll get some more work done before I start back home.”
  • He sat down with his back against a tree.
  • “I’ll call th’ robin up,” he said, “and give him th’ rind o’ th’ bacon
  • to peck at. They likes a bit o’ fat wonderful.”
  • Mary could scarcely bear to leave him. Suddenly it seemed as if he
  • might be a sort of wood fairy who might be gone when she came into the
  • garden again. He seemed too good to be true. She went slowly half-way
  • to the door in the wall and then she stopped and went back.
  • “Whatever happens, you—you never would tell?” she said.
  • His poppy-colored cheeks were distended with his first big bite of
  • bread and bacon, but he managed to smile encouragingly.
  • “If tha’ was a missel thrush an’ showed me where thy nest was, does
  • tha’ think I’d tell anyone? Not me,” he said. “Tha’ art as safe as a
  • missel thrush.”
  • And she was quite sure she was.
  • CHAPTER XII
  • “MIGHT I HAVE A BIT OF EARTH?”
  • Mary ran so fast that she was rather out of breath when she reached her
  • room. Her hair was ruffled on her forehead and her cheeks were bright
  • pink. Her dinner was waiting on the table, and Martha was waiting near
  • it.
  • “Tha’s a bit late,” she said. “Where has tha’ been?”
  • “I’ve seen Dickon!” said Mary. “I’ve seen Dickon!”
  • “I knew he’d come,” said Martha exultantly. “How does tha’ like him?”
  • “I think—I think he’s beautiful!” said Mary in a determined voice.
  • Martha looked rather taken aback but she looked pleased, too.
  • “Well,” she said, “he’s th’ best lad as ever was born, but us never
  • thought he was handsome. His nose turns up too much.”
  • “I like it to turn up,” said Mary.
  • “An’ his eyes is so round,” said Martha, a trifle doubtful. “Though
  • they’re a nice color.”
  • “I like them round,” said Mary. “And they are exactly the color of the
  • sky over the moor.”
  • Martha beamed with satisfaction.
  • “Mother says he made ’em that color with always lookin’ up at th’ birds
  • an’ th’ clouds. But he has got a big mouth, hasn’t he, now?”
  • “I love his big mouth,” said Mary obstinately. “I wish mine were just
  • like it.”
  • Martha chuckled delightedly.
  • “It’d look rare an’ funny in thy bit of a face,” she said. “But I
  • knowed it would be that way when tha’ saw him. How did tha’ like th’
  • seeds an’ th’ garden tools?”
  • “How did you know he brought them?” asked Mary.
  • “Eh! I never thought of him not bringin’ ’em. He’d be sure to bring ’em
  • if they was in Yorkshire. He’s such a trusty lad.”
  • Mary was afraid that she might begin to ask difficult questions, but
  • she did not. She was very much interested in the seeds and gardening
  • tools, and there was only one moment when Mary was frightened. This was
  • when she began to ask where the flowers were to be planted.
  • “Who did tha’ ask about it?” she inquired.
  • “I haven’t asked anybody yet,” said Mary, hesitating.
  • “Well, I wouldn’t ask th’ head gardener. He’s too grand, Mr. Roach is.”
  • “I’ve never seen him,” said Mary. “I’ve only seen undergardeners and
  • Ben Weatherstaff.”
  • “If I was you, I’d ask Ben Weatherstaff,” advised Martha. “He’s not
  • half as bad as he looks, for all he’s so crabbed. Mr. Craven lets him
  • do what he likes because he was here when Mrs. Craven was alive, an’ he
  • used to make her laugh. She liked him. Perhaps he’d find you a corner
  • somewhere out o’ the way.”
  • “If it was out of the way and no one wanted it, no one _could_ mind my
  • having it, could they?” Mary said anxiously.
  • “There wouldn’t be no reason,” answered Martha. “You wouldn’t do no
  • harm.”
  • Mary ate her dinner as quickly as she could and when she rose from the
  • table she was going to run to her room to put on her hat again, but
  • Martha stopped her.
  • “I’ve got somethin’ to tell you,” she said. “I thought I’d let you eat
  • your dinner first. Mr. Craven came back this mornin’ and I think he
  • wants to see you.”
  • Mary turned quite pale.
  • “Oh!” she said. “Why! Why! He didn’t want to see me when I came. I
  • heard Pitcher say he didn’t.”
  • “Well,” explained Martha, “Mrs. Medlock says it’s because o’ mother.
  • She was walkin’ to Thwaite village an’ she met him. She’d never spoke
  • to him before, but Mrs. Craven had been to our cottage two or three
  • times. He’d forgot, but mother hadn’t an’ she made bold to stop him. I
  • don’t know what she said to him about you but she said somethin’ as put
  • him in th’ mind to see you before he goes away again, tomorrow.”
  • “Oh!” cried Mary, “is he going away tomorrow? I am so glad!”
  • “He’s goin’ for a long time. He mayn’t come back till autumn or winter.
  • He’s goin’ to travel in foreign places. He’s always doin’ it.”
  • “Oh! I’m so glad—so glad!” said Mary thankfully.
  • If he did not come back until winter, or even autumn, there would be
  • time to watch the secret garden come alive. Even if he found out then
  • and took it away from her she would have had that much at least.
  • “When do you think he will want to see—”
  • She did not finish the sentence, because the door opened, and Mrs.
  • Medlock walked in. She had on her best black dress and cap, and her
  • collar was fastened with a large brooch with a picture of a man’s face
  • on it. It was a colored photograph of Mr. Medlock who had died years
  • ago, and she always wore it when she was dressed up. She looked nervous
  • and excited.
  • “Your hair’s rough,” she said quickly. “Go and brush it. Martha, help
  • her to slip on her best dress. Mr. Craven sent me to bring her to him
  • in his study.”
  • All the pink left Mary’s cheeks. Her heart began to thump and she felt
  • herself changing into a stiff, plain, silent child again. She did not
  • even answer Mrs. Medlock, but turned and walked into her bedroom,
  • followed by Martha. She said nothing while her dress was changed, and
  • her hair brushed, and after she was quite tidy she followed Mrs.
  • Medlock down the corridors, in silence. What was there for her to say?
  • She was obliged to go and see Mr. Craven and he would not like her, and
  • she would not like him. She knew what he would think of her.
  • She was taken to a part of the house she had not been into before. At
  • last Mrs. Medlock knocked at a door, and when someone said, “Come in,”
  • they entered the room together. A man was sitting in an armchair before
  • the fire, and Mrs. Medlock spoke to him.
  • “This is Miss Mary, sir,” she said.
  • “You can go and leave her here. I will ring for you when I want you to
  • take her away,” said Mr. Craven.
  • When she went out and closed the door, Mary could only stand waiting, a
  • plain little thing, twisting her thin hands together. She could see
  • that the man in the chair was not so much a hunchback as a man with
  • high, rather crooked shoulders, and he had black hair streaked with
  • white. He turned his head over his high shoulders and spoke to her.
  • “Come here!” he said.
  • Mary went to him.
  • He was not ugly. His face would have been handsome if it had not been
  • so miserable. He looked as if the sight of her worried and fretted him
  • and as if he did not know what in the world to do with her.
  • “Are you well?” he asked.
  • “Yes,” answered Mary.
  • “Do they take good care of you?”
  • “Yes.”
  • He rubbed his forehead fretfully as he looked her over.
  • “You are very thin,” he said.
  • “I am getting fatter,” Mary answered in what she knew was her stiffest
  • way.
  • What an unhappy face he had! His black eyes seemed as if they scarcely
  • saw her, as if they were seeing something else, and he could hardly
  • keep his thoughts upon her.
  • “I forgot you,” he said. “How could I remember you? I intended to send
  • you a governess or a nurse, or someone of that sort, but I forgot.”
  • “Please,” began Mary. “Please—” and then the lump in her throat choked
  • her.
  • “What do you want to say?” he inquired.
  • “I am—I am too big for a nurse,” said Mary. “And please—please don’t
  • make me have a governess yet.”
  • He rubbed his forehead again and stared at her.
  • “That was what the Sowerby woman said,” he muttered absent-mindedly.
  • Then Mary gathered a scrap of courage.
  • “Is she—is she Martha’s mother?” she stammered.
  • “Yes, I think so,” he replied.
  • “She knows about children,” said Mary. “She has twelve. She knows.”
  • He seemed to rouse himself.
  • “What do you want to do?”
  • “I want to play out of doors,” Mary answered, hoping that her voice did
  • not tremble. “I never liked it in India. It makes me hungry here, and I
  • am getting fatter.”
  • He was watching her.
  • “Mrs. Sowerby said it would do you good. Perhaps it will,” he said.
  • “She thought you had better get stronger before you had a governess.”
  • “It makes me feel strong when I play and the wind comes over the moor,”
  • argued Mary.
  • “Where do you play?” he asked next.
  • “Everywhere,” gasped Mary. “Martha’s mother sent me a skipping-rope. I
  • skip and run—and I look about to see if things are beginning to stick
  • up out of the earth. I don’t do any harm.”
  • “Don’t look so frightened,” he said in a worried voice. “You could not
  • do any harm, a child like you! You may do what you like.”
  • Mary put her hand up to her throat because she was afraid he might see
  • the excited lump which she felt jump into it. She came a step nearer to
  • him.
  • “May I?” she said tremulously.
  • Her anxious little face seemed to worry him more than ever.
  • “Don’t look so frightened,” he exclaimed. “Of course you may. I am your
  • guardian, though I am a poor one for any child. I cannot give you time
  • or attention. I am too ill, and wretched and distracted; but I wish you
  • to be happy and comfortable. I don’t know anything about children, but
  • Mrs. Medlock is to see that you have all you need. I sent for you today
  • because Mrs. Sowerby said I ought to see you. Her daughter had talked
  • about you. She thought you needed fresh air and freedom and running
  • about.”
  • “She knows all about children,” Mary said again in spite of herself.
  • “She ought to,” said Mr. Craven. “I thought her rather bold to stop me
  • on the moor, but she said—Mrs. Craven had been kind to her.” It seemed
  • hard for him to speak his dead wife’s name. “She is a respectable
  • woman. Now I have seen you I think she said sensible things. Play out
  • of doors as much as you like. It’s a big place and you may go where you
  • like and amuse yourself as you like. Is there anything you want?” as if
  • a sudden thought had struck him. “Do you want toys, books, dolls?”
  • “Might I,” quavered Mary, “might I have a bit of earth?”
  • In her eagerness she did not realize how queer the words would sound
  • and that they were not the ones she had meant to say. Mr. Craven looked
  • quite startled.
  • “Earth!” he repeated. “What do you mean?”
  • “To plant seeds in—to make things grow—to see them come alive,” Mary
  • faltered.
  • He gazed at her a moment and then passed his hand quickly over his
  • eyes.
  • “Do you—care about gardens so much,” he said slowly.
  • “I didn’t know about them in India,” said Mary. “I was always ill and
  • tired and it was too hot. I sometimes made little beds in the sand and
  • stuck flowers in them. But here it is different.”
  • Mr. Craven got up and began to walk slowly across the room.
  • “A bit of earth,” he said to himself, and Mary thought that somehow she
  • must have reminded him of something. When he stopped and spoke to her
  • his dark eyes looked almost soft and kind.
  • “You can have as much earth as you want,” he said. “You remind me of
  • someone else who loved the earth and things that grow. When you see a
  • bit of earth you want,” with something like a smile, “take it, child,
  • and make it come alive.”
  • “May I take it from anywhere—if it’s not wanted?”
  • “Anywhere,” he answered. “There! You must go now, I am tired.” He
  • touched the bell to call Mrs. Medlock. “Good-by. I shall be away all
  • summer.”
  • Mrs. Medlock came so quickly that Mary thought she must have been
  • waiting in the corridor.
  • “Mrs. Medlock,” Mr. Craven said to her, “now I have seen the child I
  • understand what Mrs. Sowerby meant. She must be less delicate before
  • she begins lessons. Give her simple, healthy food. Let her run wild in
  • the garden. Don’t look after her too much. She needs liberty and fresh
  • air and romping about. Mrs. Sowerby is to come and see her now and then
  • and she may sometimes go to the cottage.”
  • Mrs. Medlock looked pleased. She was relieved to hear that she need not
  • “look after” Mary too much. She had felt her a tiresome charge and had
  • indeed seen as little of her as she dared. In addition to this she was
  • fond of Martha’s mother.
  • “Thank you, sir,” she said. “Susan Sowerby and me went to school
  • together and she’s as sensible and good-hearted a woman as you’d find
  • in a day’s walk. I never had any children myself and she’s had twelve,
  • and there never was healthier or better ones. Miss Mary can get no harm
  • from them. I’d always take Susan Sowerby’s advice about children
  • myself. She’s what you might call healthy-minded—if you understand me.”
  • “I understand,” Mr. Craven answered. “Take Miss Mary away now and send
  • Pitcher to me.”
  • When Mrs. Medlock left her at the end of her own corridor Mary flew
  • back to her room. She found Martha waiting there. Martha had, in fact,
  • hurried back after she had removed the dinner service.
  • “I can have my garden!” cried Mary. “I may have it where I like! I am
  • not going to have a governess for a long time! Your mother is coming to
  • see me and I may go to your cottage! He says a little girl like me
  • could not do any harm and I may do what I like—anywhere!”
  • “Eh!” said Martha delightedly, “that was nice of him wasn’t it?”
  • “Martha,” said Mary solemnly, “he is really a nice man, only his face
  • is so miserable and his forehead is all drawn together.”
  • She ran as quickly as she could to the garden. She had been away so
  • much longer than she had thought she should and she knew Dickon would
  • have to set out early on his five-mile walk. When she slipped through
  • the door under the ivy, she saw he was not working where she had left
  • him. The gardening tools were laid together under a tree. She ran to
  • them, looking all round the place, but there was no Dickon to be seen.
  • He had gone away and the secret garden was empty—except for the robin
  • who had just flown across the wall and sat on a standard rose-bush
  • watching her.
  • “He’s gone,” she said woefully. “Oh! was he—was he—was he only a wood
  • fairy?”
  • Something white fastened to the standard rose-bush caught her eye. It
  • was a piece of paper, in fact, it was a piece of the letter she had
  • printed for Martha to send to Dickon. It was fastened on the bush with
  • a long thorn, and in a minute she knew Dickon had left it there. There
  • were some roughly printed letters on it and a sort of picture. At first
  • she could not tell what it was. Then she saw it was meant for a nest
  • with a bird sitting on it. Underneath were the printed letters and they
  • said:
  • “I will cum bak.”
  • CHAPTER XIII
  • “I AM COLIN”
  • Mary took the picture back to the house when she went to her supper and
  • she showed it to Martha.
  • “Eh!” said Martha with great pride. “I never knew our Dickon was as
  • clever as that. That there’s a picture of a missel thrush on her nest,
  • as large as life an’ twice as natural.”
  • Then Mary knew Dickon had meant the picture to be a message. He had
  • meant that she might be sure he would keep her secret. Her garden was
  • her nest and she was like a missel thrush. Oh, how she did like that
  • queer, common boy!
  • She hoped he would come back the very next day and she fell asleep
  • looking forward to the morning.
  • But you never know what the weather will do in Yorkshire, particularly
  • in the springtime. She was awakened in the night by the sound of rain
  • beating with heavy drops against her window. It was pouring down in
  • torrents and the wind was “wuthering” round the corners and in the
  • chimneys of the huge old house. Mary sat up in bed and felt miserable
  • and angry.
  • “The rain is as contrary as I ever was,” she said. “It came because it
  • knew I did not want it.”
  • She threw herself back on her pillow and buried her face. She did not
  • cry, but she lay and hated the sound of the heavily beating rain, she
  • hated the wind and its “wuthering.” She could not go to sleep again.
  • The mournful sound kept her awake because she felt mournful herself. If
  • she had felt happy it would probably have lulled her to sleep. How it
  • “wuthered” and how the big raindrops poured down and beat against the
  • pane!
  • “It sounds just like a person lost on the moor and wandering on and on
  • crying,” she said.
  • She had been lying awake turning from side to side for about an hour,
  • when suddenly something made her sit up in bed and turn her head toward
  • the door listening. She listened and she listened.
  • “It isn’t the wind now,” she said in a loud whisper. “That isn’t the
  • wind. It is different. It is that crying I heard before.”
  • The door of her room was ajar and the sound came down the corridor, a
  • far-off faint sound of fretful crying. She listened for a few minutes
  • and each minute she became more and more sure. She felt as if she must
  • find out what it was. It seemed even stranger than the secret garden
  • and the buried key. Perhaps the fact that she was in a rebellious mood
  • made her bold. She put her foot out of bed and stood on the floor.
  • “I am going to find out what it is,” she said. “Everybody is in bed and
  • I don’t care about Mrs. Medlock—I don’t care!”
  • There was a candle by her bedside and she took it up and went softly
  • out of the room. The corridor looked very long and dark, but she was
  • too excited to mind that. She thought she remembered the corners she
  • must turn to find the short corridor with the door covered with
  • tapestry—the one Mrs. Medlock had come through the day she lost
  • herself. The sound had come up that passage. So she went on with her
  • dim light, almost feeling her way, her heart beating so loud that she
  • fancied she could hear it. The far-off faint crying went on and led
  • her. Sometimes it stopped for a moment or so and then began again. Was
  • this the right corner to turn? She stopped and thought. Yes it was.
  • Down this passage and then to the left, and then up two broad steps,
  • and then to the right again. Yes, there was the tapestry door.
  • She pushed it open very gently and closed it behind her, and she stood
  • in the corridor and could hear the crying quite plainly, though it was
  • not loud. It was on the other side of the wall at her left and a few
  • yards farther on there was a door. She could see a glimmer of light
  • coming from beneath it. The Someone was crying in that room, and it was
  • quite a young Someone.
  • So she walked to the door and pushed it open, and there she was
  • standing in the room!
  • It was a big room with ancient, handsome furniture in it. There was a
  • low fire glowing faintly on the hearth and a night light burning by the
  • side of a carved four-posted bed hung with brocade, and on the bed was
  • lying a boy, crying fretfully.
  • Mary wondered if she was in a real place or if she had fallen asleep
  • again and was dreaming without knowing it.
  • The boy had a sharp, delicate face the color of ivory and he seemed to
  • have eyes too big for it. He had also a lot of hair which tumbled over
  • his forehead in heavy locks and made his thin face seem smaller. He
  • looked like a boy who had been ill, but he was crying more as if he
  • were tired and cross than as if he were in pain.
  • Mary stood near the door with her candle in her hand, holding her
  • breath. Then she crept across the room, and, as she drew nearer, the
  • light attracted the boy’s attention and he turned his head on his
  • pillow and stared at her, his gray eyes opening so wide that they
  • seemed immense.
  • “Who are you?” he said at last in a half-frightened whisper. “Are you a
  • ghost?”
  • “No, I am not,” Mary answered, her own whisper sounding half
  • frightened. “Are you one?”
  • He stared and stared and stared. Mary could not help noticing what
  • strange eyes he had. They were agate gray and they looked too big for
  • his face because they had black lashes all round them.
  • “No,” he replied after waiting a moment or so. “I am Colin.”
  • “Who is Colin?” she faltered.
  • “I am Colin Craven. Who are you?”
  • “I am Mary Lennox. Mr. Craven is my uncle.”
  • “He is my father,” said the boy.
  • “Your father!” gasped Mary. “No one ever told me he had a boy! Why
  • didn’t they?”
  • “Come here,” he said, still keeping his strange eyes fixed on her with
  • an anxious expression.
  • She came close to the bed and he put out his hand and touched her.
  • “You are real, aren’t you?” he said. “I have such real dreams very
  • often. You might be one of them.”
  • Mary had slipped on a woolen wrapper before she left her room and she
  • put a piece of it between his fingers.
  • “Rub that and see how thick and warm it is,” she said. “I will pinch
  • you a little if you like, to show you how real I am. For a minute I
  • thought you might be a dream too.”
  • “Where did you come from?” he asked.
  • “From my own room. The wind wuthered so I couldn’t go to sleep and I
  • heard someone crying and wanted to find out who it was. What were you
  • crying for?”
  • “Because I couldn’t go to sleep either and my head ached. Tell me your
  • name again.”
  • “Mary Lennox. Did no one ever tell you I had come to live here?”
  • He was still fingering the fold of her wrapper, but he began to look a
  • little more as if he believed in her reality.
  • “No,” he answered. “They daren’t.”
  • “Why?” asked Mary.
  • “Because I should have been afraid you would see me. I won’t let people
  • see me and talk me over.”
  • “Why?” Mary asked again, feeling more mystified every moment.
  • “Because I am like this always, ill and having to lie down. My father
  • won’t let people talk me over either. The servants are not allowed to
  • speak about me. If I live I may be a hunchback, but I shan’t live. My
  • father hates to think I may be like him.”
  • “Oh, what a queer house this is!” Mary said. “What a queer house!
  • Everything is a kind of secret. Rooms are locked up and gardens are
  • locked up—and you! Have you been locked up?”
  • “No. I stay in this room because I don’t want to be moved out of it. It
  • tires me too much.”
  • “Does your father come and see you?” Mary ventured.
  • “Sometimes. Generally when I am asleep. He doesn’t want to see me.”
  • “Why?” Mary could not help asking again.
  • A sort of angry shadow passed over the boy’s face.
  • “My mother died when I was born and it makes him wretched to look at
  • me. He thinks I don’t know, but I’ve heard people talking. He almost
  • hates me.”
  • “He hates the garden, because she died,” said Mary half speaking to
  • herself.
  • “What garden?” the boy asked.
  • “Oh! just—just a garden she used to like,” Mary stammered. “Have you
  • been here always?”
  • “Nearly always. Sometimes I have been taken to places at the seaside,
  • but I won’t stay because people stare at me. I used to wear an iron
  • thing to keep my back straight, but a grand doctor came from London to
  • see me and said it was stupid. He told them to take it off and keep me
  • out in the fresh air. I hate fresh air and I don’t want to go out.”
  • “I didn’t when first I came here,” said Mary. “Why do you keep looking
  • at me like that?”
  • “Because of the dreams that are so real,” he answered rather fretfully.
  • “Sometimes when I open my eyes I don’t believe I’m awake.”
  • “We’re both awake,” said Mary. She glanced round the room with its high
  • ceiling and shadowy corners and dim fire-light. “It looks quite like a
  • dream, and it’s the middle of the night, and everybody in the house is
  • asleep—everybody but us. We are wide awake.”
  • “I don’t want it to be a dream,” the boy said restlessly.
  • Mary thought of something all at once.
  • “If you don’t like people to see you,” she began, “do you want me to go
  • away?”
  • He still held the fold of her wrapper and he gave it a little pull.
  • “No,” he said. “I should be sure you were a dream if you went. If you
  • are real, sit down on that big footstool and talk. I want to hear about
  • you.”
  • Mary put down her candle on the table near the bed and sat down on the
  • cushioned stool. She did not want to go away at all. She wanted to stay
  • in the mysterious hidden-away room and talk to the mysterious boy.
  • “What do you want me to tell you?” she said.
  • He wanted to know how long she had been at Misselthwaite; he wanted to
  • know which corridor her room was on; he wanted to know what she had
  • been doing; if she disliked the moor as he disliked it; where she had
  • lived before she came to Yorkshire. She answered all these questions
  • and many more and he lay back on his pillow and listened. He made her
  • tell him a great deal about India and about her voyage across the
  • ocean. She found out that because he had been an invalid he had not
  • learned things as other children had. One of his nurses had taught him
  • to read when he was quite little and he was always reading and looking
  • at pictures in splendid books.
  • Though his father rarely saw him when he was awake, he was given all
  • sorts of wonderful things to amuse himself with. He never seemed to
  • have been amused, however. He could have anything he asked for and was
  • never made to do anything he did not like to do.
  • “Everyone is obliged to do what pleases me,” he said indifferently. “It
  • makes me ill to be angry. No one believes I shall live to grow up.”
  • He said it as if he was so accustomed to the idea that it had ceased to
  • matter to him at all. He seemed to like the sound of Mary’s voice. As
  • she went on talking he listened in a drowsy, interested way. Once or
  • twice she wondered if he were not gradually falling into a doze. But at
  • last he asked a question which opened up a new subject.
  • “How old are you?” he asked.
  • “I am ten,” answered Mary, forgetting herself for the moment, “and so
  • are you.”
  • “How do you know that?” he demanded in a surprised voice.
  • “Because when you were born the garden door was locked and the key was
  • buried. And it has been locked for ten years.”
  • Colin half sat up, turning toward her, leaning on his elbows.
  • “What garden door was locked? Who did it? Where was the key buried?” he
  • exclaimed as if he were suddenly very much interested.
  • “It—it was the garden Mr. Craven hates,” said Mary nervously. “He
  • locked the door. No one—no one knew where he buried the key.”
  • “What sort of a garden is it?” Colin persisted eagerly.
  • “No one has been allowed to go into it for ten years,” was Mary’s
  • careful answer.
  • But it was too late to be careful. He was too much like herself. He too
  • had had nothing to think about and the idea of a hidden garden
  • attracted him as it had attracted her. He asked question after
  • question. Where was it? Had she never looked for the door? Had she
  • never asked the gardeners?
  • “They won’t talk about it,” said Mary. “I think they have been told not
  • to answer questions.”
  • “I would make them,” said Colin.
  • “Could you?” Mary faltered, beginning to feel frightened. If he could
  • make people answer questions, who knew what might happen!
  • “Everyone is obliged to please me. I told you that,” he said. “If I
  • were to live, this place would sometime belong to me. They all know
  • that. I would make them tell me.”
  • Mary had not known that she herself had been spoiled, but she could see
  • quite plainly that this mysterious boy had been. He thought that the
  • whole world belonged to him. How peculiar he was and how coolly he
  • spoke of not living.
  • “Do you think you won’t live?” she asked, partly because she was
  • curious and partly in hope of making him forget the garden.
  • “I don’t suppose I shall,” he answered as indifferently as he had
  • spoken before. “Ever since I remember anything I have heard people say
  • I shan’t. At first they thought I was too little to understand and now
  • they think I don’t hear. But I do. My doctor is my father’s cousin. He
  • is quite poor and if I die he will have all Misselthwaite when my
  • father is dead. I should think he wouldn’t want me to live.”
  • “Do you want to live?” inquired Mary.
  • “No,” he answered, in a cross, tired fashion. “But I don’t want to die.
  • When I feel ill I lie here and think about it until I cry and cry.”
  • “I have heard you crying three times,” Mary said, “but I did not know
  • who it was. Were you crying about that?” She did so want him to forget
  • the garden.
  • “I dare say,” he answered. “Let us talk about something else. Talk
  • about that garden. Don’t you want to see it?”
  • “Yes,” answered Mary, in quite a low voice.
  • “I do,” he went on persistently. “I don’t think I ever really wanted to
  • see anything before, but I want to see that garden. I want the key dug
  • up. I want the door unlocked. I would let them take me there in my
  • chair. That would be getting fresh air. I am going to make them open
  • the door.”
  • He had become quite excited and his strange eyes began to shine like
  • stars and looked more immense than ever.
  • “They have to please me,” he said. “I will make them take me there and
  • I will let you go, too.”
  • Mary’s hands clutched each other. Everything would be
  • spoiled—everything! Dickon would never come back. She would never again
  • feel like a missel thrush with a safe-hidden nest.
  • “Oh, don’t—don’t—don’t—don’t do that!” she cried out.
  • He stared as if he thought she had gone crazy!
  • “Why?” he exclaimed. “You said you wanted to see it.”
  • “I do,” she answered almost with a sob in her throat, “but if you make
  • them open the door and take you in like that it will never be a secret
  • again.”
  • He leaned still farther forward.
  • “A secret,” he said. “What do you mean? Tell me.”
  • Mary’s words almost tumbled over one another.
  • “You see—you see,” she panted, “if no one knows but ourselves—if there
  • was a door, hidden somewhere under the ivy—if there was—and we could
  • find it; and if we could slip through it together and shut it behind
  • us, and no one knew anyone was inside and we called it our garden and
  • pretended that—that we were missel thrushes and it was our nest, and if
  • we played there almost every day and dug and planted seeds and made it
  • all come alive—”
  • “Is it dead?” he interrupted her.
  • “It soon will be if no one cares for it,” she went on. “The bulbs will
  • live but the roses—”
  • He stopped her again as excited as she was herself.
  • “What are bulbs?” he put in quickly.
  • “They are daffodils and lilies and snowdrops. They are working in the
  • earth now—pushing up pale green points because the spring is coming.”
  • “Is the spring coming?” he said. “What is it like? You don’t see it in
  • rooms if you are ill.”
  • “It is the sun shining on the rain and the rain falling on the
  • sunshine, and things pushing up and working under the earth,” said
  • Mary. “If the garden was a secret and we could get into it we could
  • watch the things grow bigger every day, and see how many roses are
  • alive. Don’t you see? Oh, don’t you see how much nicer it would be if
  • it was a secret?”
  • He dropped back on his pillow and lay there with an odd expression on
  • his face.
  • “I never had a secret,” he said, “except that one about not living to
  • grow up. They don’t know I know that, so it is a sort of secret. But I
  • like this kind better.”
  • “If you won’t make them take you to the garden,” pleaded Mary,
  • “perhaps—I feel almost sure I can find out how to get in sometime. And
  • then—if the doctor wants you to go out in your chair, and if you can
  • always do what you want to do, perhaps—perhaps we might find some boy
  • who would push you, and we could go alone and it would always be a
  • secret garden.”
  • “I should—like—that,” he said very slowly, his eyes looking dreamy. “I
  • should like that. I should not mind fresh air in a secret garden.”
  • Mary began to recover her breath and feel safer because the idea of
  • keeping the secret seemed to please him. She felt almost sure that if
  • she kept on talking and could make him see the garden in his mind as
  • she had seen it he would like it so much that he could not bear to
  • think that everybody might tramp in to it when they chose.
  • “I’ll tell you what I _think_ it would be like, if we could go into
  • it,” she said. “It has been shut up so long things have grown into a
  • tangle perhaps.”
  • He lay quite still and listened while she went on talking about the
  • roses which _might_ have clambered from tree to tree and hung
  • down—about the many birds which _might_ have built their nests there
  • because it was so safe. And then she told him about the robin and Ben
  • Weatherstaff, and there was so much to tell about the robin and it was
  • so easy and safe to talk about it that she ceased to be afraid. The
  • robin pleased him so much that he smiled until he looked almost
  • beautiful, and at first Mary had thought that he was even plainer than
  • herself, with his big eyes and heavy locks of hair.
  • “I did not know birds could be like that,” he said. “But if you stay in
  • a room you never see things. What a lot of things you know. I feel as
  • if you had been inside that garden.”
  • She did not know what to say, so she did not say anything. He evidently
  • did not expect an answer and the next moment he gave her a surprise.
  • “I am going to let you look at something,” he said. “Do you see that
  • rose-colored silk curtain hanging on the wall over the mantel-piece?”
  • Mary had not noticed it before, but she looked up and saw it. It was a
  • curtain of soft silk hanging over what seemed to be some picture.
  • “Yes,” she answered.
  • “There is a cord hanging from it,” said Colin. “Go and pull it.”
  • Mary got up, much mystified, and found the cord. When she pulled it the
  • silk curtain ran back on rings and when it ran back it uncovered a
  • picture. It was the picture of a girl with a laughing face. She had
  • bright hair tied up with a blue ribbon and her gay, lovely eyes were
  • exactly like Colin’s unhappy ones, agate gray and looking twice as big
  • as they really were because of the black lashes all round them.
  • “She is my mother,” said Colin complainingly. “I don’t see why she
  • died. Sometimes I hate her for doing it.”
  • “How queer!” said Mary.
  • “If she had lived I believe I should not have been ill always,” he
  • grumbled. “I dare say I should have lived, too. And my father would not
  • have hated to look at me. I dare say I should have had a strong back.
  • Draw the curtain again.”
  • Mary did as she was told and returned to her footstool.
  • “She is much prettier than you,” she said, “but her eyes are just like
  • yours—at least they are the same shape and color. Why is the curtain
  • drawn over her?”
  • He moved uncomfortably.
  • “I made them do it,” he said. “Sometimes I don’t like to see her
  • looking at me. She smiles too much when I am ill and miserable.
  • Besides, she is mine and I don’t want everyone to see her.”
  • There were a few moments of silence and then Mary spoke.
  • “What would Mrs. Medlock do if she found out that I had been here?” she
  • inquired.
  • “She would do as I told her to do,” he answered. “And I should tell her
  • that I wanted you to come here and talk to me every day. I am glad you
  • came.”
  • “So am I,” said Mary. “I will come as often as I can, but”—she
  • hesitated—“I shall have to look every day for the garden door.”
  • “Yes, you must,” said Colin, “and you can tell me about it afterward.”
  • He lay thinking a few minutes, as he had done before, and then he spoke
  • again.
  • “I think you shall be a secret, too,” he said. “I will not tell them
  • until they find out. I can always send the nurse out of the room and
  • say that I want to be by myself. Do you know Martha?”
  • “Yes, I know her very well,” said Mary. “She waits on me.”
  • He nodded his head toward the outer corridor.
  • “She is the one who is asleep in the other room. The nurse went away
  • yesterday to stay all night with her sister and she always makes Martha
  • attend to me when she wants to go out. Martha shall tell you when to
  • come here.”
  • Then Mary understood Martha’s troubled look when she had asked
  • questions about the crying.
  • “Martha knew about you all the time?” she said.
  • “Yes; she often attends to me. The nurse likes to get away from me and
  • then Martha comes.”
  • “I have been here a long time,” said Mary. “Shall I go away now? Your
  • eyes look sleepy.”
  • “I wish I could go to sleep before you leave me,” he said rather shyly.
  • “Shut your eyes,” said Mary, drawing her footstool closer, “and I will
  • do what my Ayah used to do in India. I will pat your hand and stroke it
  • and sing something quite low.”
  • “I should like that perhaps,” he said drowsily.
  • Somehow she was sorry for him and did not want him to lie awake, so she
  • leaned against the bed and began to stroke and pat his hand and sing a
  • very low little chanting song in Hindustani.
  • “That is nice,” he said more drowsily still, and she went on chanting
  • and stroking, but when she looked at him again his black lashes were
  • lying close against his cheeks, for his eyes were shut and he was fast
  • asleep. So she got up softly, took her candle and crept away without
  • making a sound.
  • CHAPTER XIV
  • A YOUNG RAJAH
  • The moor was hidden in mist when the morning came, and the rain had not
  • stopped pouring down. There could be no going out of doors. Martha was
  • so busy that Mary had no opportunity of talking to her, but in the
  • afternoon she asked her to come and sit with her in the nursery. She
  • came bringing the stocking she was always knitting when she was doing
  • nothing else.
  • “What’s the matter with thee?” she asked as soon as they sat down.
  • “Tha’ looks as if tha’d somethin’ to say.”
  • “I have. I have found out what the crying was,” said Mary.
  • Martha let her knitting drop on her knee and gazed at her with startled
  • eyes.
  • “Tha’ hasn’t!” she exclaimed. “Never!”
  • “I heard it in the night,” Mary went on. “And I got up and went to see
  • where it came from. It was Colin. I found him.”
  • Martha’s face became red with fright.
  • “Eh! Miss Mary!” she said half crying. “Tha’ shouldn’t have done
  • it—tha’ shouldn’t! Tha’ll get me in trouble. I never told thee nothin’
  • about him—but tha’ll get me in trouble. I shall lose my place and
  • what’ll mother do!”
  • “You won’t lose your place,” said Mary. “He was glad I came. We talked
  • and talked and he said he was glad I came.”
  • “Was he?” cried Martha. “Art tha’ sure? Tha’ doesn’t know what he’s
  • like when anything vexes him. He’s a big lad to cry like a baby, but
  • when he’s in a passion he’ll fair scream just to frighten us. He knows
  • us daren’t call our souls our own.”
  • “He wasn’t vexed,” said Mary. “I asked him if I should go away and he
  • made me stay. He asked me questions and I sat on a big footstool and
  • talked to him about India and about the robin and gardens. He wouldn’t
  • let me go. He let me see his mother’s picture. Before I left him I sang
  • him to sleep.”
  • Martha fairly gasped with amazement.
  • “I can scarcely believe thee!” she protested. “It’s as if tha’d walked
  • straight into a lion’s den. If he’d been like he is most times he’d
  • have throwed himself into one of his tantrums and roused th’ house. He
  • won’t let strangers look at him.”
  • “He let me look at him. I looked at him all the time and he looked at
  • me. We stared!” said Mary.
  • “I don’t know what to do!” cried agitated Martha. “If Mrs. Medlock
  • finds out, she’ll think I broke orders and told thee and I shall be
  • packed back to mother.”
  • “He is not going to tell Mrs. Medlock anything about it yet. It’s to be
  • a sort of secret just at first,” said Mary firmly. “And he says
  • everybody is obliged to do as he pleases.”
  • “Aye, that’s true enough—th’ bad lad!” sighed Martha, wiping her
  • forehead with her apron.
  • “He says Mrs. Medlock must. And he wants me to come and talk to him
  • every day. And you are to tell me when he wants me.”
  • “Me!” said Martha; “I shall lose my place—I shall for sure!”
  • “You can’t if you are doing what he wants you to do and everybody is
  • ordered to obey him,” Mary argued.
  • “Does tha’ mean to say,” cried Martha with wide open eyes, “that he was
  • nice to thee!”
  • “I think he almost liked me,” Mary answered.
  • “Then tha’ must have bewitched him!” decided Martha, drawing a long
  • breath.
  • “Do you mean Magic?” inquired Mary. “I’ve heard about Magic in India,
  • but I can’t make it. I just went into his room and I was so surprised
  • to see him I stood and stared. And then he turned round and stared at
  • me. And he thought I was a ghost or a dream and I thought perhaps he
  • was. And it was so queer being there alone together in the middle of
  • the night and not knowing about each other. And we began to ask each
  • other questions. And when I asked him if I must go away he said I must
  • not.”
  • “Th’ world’s comin’ to a end!” gasped Martha.
  • “What is the matter with him?” asked Mary.
  • “Nobody knows for sure and certain,” said Martha. “Mr. Craven went off
  • his head like when he was born. Th’ doctors thought he’d have to be put
  • in a ’sylum. It was because Mrs. Craven died like I told you. He
  • wouldn’t set eyes on th’ baby. He just raved and said it’d be another
  • hunchback like him and it’d better die.”
  • “Is Colin a hunchback?” Mary asked. “He didn’t look like one.”
  • “He isn’t yet,” said Martha. “But he began all wrong. Mother said that
  • there was enough trouble and raging in th’ house to set any child
  • wrong. They was afraid his back was weak an’ they’ve always been takin’
  • care of it—keepin’ him lyin’ down and not lettin’ him walk. Once they
  • made him wear a brace but he fretted so he was downright ill. Then a
  • big doctor came to see him an’ made them take it off. He talked to th’
  • other doctor quite rough—in a polite way. He said there’d been too much
  • medicine and too much lettin’ him have his own way.”
  • “I think he’s a very spoiled boy,” said Mary.
  • “He’s th’ worst young nowt as ever was!” said Martha. “I won’t say as
  • he hasn’t been ill a good bit. He’s had coughs an’ colds that’s nearly
  • killed him two or three times. Once he had rheumatic fever an’ once he
  • had typhoid. Eh! Mrs. Medlock did get a fright then. He’d been out of
  • his head an’ she was talkin’ to th’ nurse, thinkin’ he didn’t know
  • nothin’, an’ she said, ‘He’ll die this time sure enough, an’ best thing
  • for him an’ for everybody.’ An’ she looked at him an’ there he was with
  • his big eyes open, starin’ at her as sensible as she was herself. She
  • didn’t know wha’d happen but he just stared at her an’ says, ‘You give
  • me some water an’ stop talkin’.’”
  • “Do you think he will die?” asked Mary.
  • “Mother says there’s no reason why any child should live that gets no
  • fresh air an’ doesn’t do nothin’ but lie on his back an’ read
  • picture-books an’ take medicine. He’s weak and hates th’ trouble o’
  • bein’ taken out o’ doors, an’ he gets cold so easy he says it makes him
  • ill.”
  • Mary sat and looked at the fire.
  • “I wonder,” she said slowly, “if it would not do him good to go out
  • into a garden and watch things growing. It did me good.”
  • “One of th’ worst fits he ever had,” said Martha, “was one time they
  • took him out where the roses is by the fountain. He’d been readin’ in a
  • paper about people gettin’ somethin’ he called ‘rose cold’ an’ he began
  • to sneeze an’ said he’d got it an’ then a new gardener as didn’t know
  • th’ rules passed by an’ looked at him curious. He threw himself into a
  • passion an’ he said he’d looked at him because he was going to be a
  • hunchback. He cried himself into a fever an’ was ill all night.”
  • “If he ever gets angry at me, I’ll never go and see him again,” said
  • Mary.
  • “He’ll have thee if he wants thee,” said Martha. “Tha’ may as well know
  • that at th’ start.”
  • Very soon afterward a bell rang and she rolled up her knitting.
  • “I dare say th’ nurse wants me to stay with him a bit,” she said. “I
  • hope he’s in a good temper.”
  • She was out of the room about ten minutes and then she came back with a
  • puzzled expression.
  • “Well, tha’ has bewitched him,” she said. “He’s up on his sofa with his
  • picture-books. He’s told the nurse to stay away until six o’clock. I’m
  • to wait in the next room. Th’ minute she was gone he called me to him
  • an’ says, ‘I want Mary Lennox to come and talk to me, and remember
  • you’re not to tell anyone.’ You’d better go as quick as you can.”
  • Mary was quite willing to go quickly. She did not want to see Colin as
  • much as she wanted to see Dickon; but she wanted to see him very much.
  • There was a bright fire on the hearth when she entered his room, and in
  • the daylight she saw it was a very beautiful room indeed. There were
  • rich colors in the rugs and hangings and pictures and books on the
  • walls which made it look glowing and comfortable even in spite of the
  • gray sky and falling rain. Colin looked rather like a picture himself.
  • He was wrapped in a velvet dressing-gown and sat against a big brocaded
  • cushion. He had a red spot on each cheek.
  • “Come in,” he said. “I’ve been thinking about you all morning.”
  • “I’ve been thinking about you, too,” answered Mary. “You don’t know how
  • frightened Martha is. She says Mrs. Medlock will think she told me
  • about you and then she will be sent away.”
  • He frowned.
  • “Go and tell her to come here,” he said. “She is in the next room.”
  • Mary went and brought her back. Poor Martha was shaking in her shoes.
  • Colin was still frowning.
  • “Have you to do what I please or have you not?” he demanded.
  • “I have to do what you please, sir,” Martha faltered, turning quite
  • red.
  • “Has Medlock to do what I please?”
  • “Everybody has, sir,” said Martha.
  • “Well, then, if I order you to bring Miss Mary to me, how can Medlock
  • send you away if she finds it out?”
  • “Please don’t let her, sir,” pleaded Martha.
  • “I’ll send _her_ away if she dares to say a word about such a thing,”
  • said Master Craven grandly. “She wouldn’t like that, I can tell you.”
  • “Thank you, sir,” bobbing a curtsy, “I want to do my duty, sir.”
  • “What I want is your duty” said Colin more grandly still. “I’ll take
  • care of you. Now go away.”
  • When the door closed behind Martha, Colin found Mistress Mary gazing at
  • him as if he had set her wondering.
  • “Why do you look at me like that?” he asked her. “What are you thinking
  • about?”
  • “I am thinking about two things.”
  • “What are they? Sit down and tell me.”
  • “This is the first one,” said Mary, seating herself on the big stool.
  • “Once in India I saw a boy who was a Rajah. He had rubies and emeralds
  • and diamonds stuck all over him. He spoke to his people just as you
  • spoke to Martha. Everybody had to do everything he told them—in a
  • minute. I think they would have been killed if they hadn’t.”
  • “I shall make you tell me about Rajahs presently,” he said, “but first
  • tell me what the second thing was.”
  • “I was thinking,” said Mary, “how different you are from Dickon.”
  • “Who is Dickon?” he said. “What a queer name!”
  • She might as well tell him, she thought she could talk about Dickon
  • without mentioning the secret garden. She had liked to hear Martha talk
  • about him. Besides, she longed to talk about him. It would seem to
  • bring him nearer.
  • “He is Martha’s brother. He is twelve years old,” she explained. “He is
  • not like anyone else in the world. He can charm foxes and squirrels and
  • birds just as the natives in India charm snakes. He plays a very soft
  • tune on a pipe and they come and listen.”
  • There were some big books on a table at his side and he dragged one
  • suddenly toward him.
  • “There is a picture of a snake-charmer in this,” he exclaimed. “Come
  • and look at it.”
  • The book was a beautiful one with superb colored illustrations and he
  • turned to one of them.
  • “Can he do that?” he asked eagerly.
  • “He played on his pipe and they listened,” Mary explained. “But he
  • doesn’t call it Magic. He says it’s because he lives on the moor so
  • much and he knows their ways. He says he feels sometimes as if he was a
  • bird or a rabbit himself, he likes them so. I think he asked the robin
  • questions. It seemed as if they talked to each other in soft chirps.”
  • Colin lay back on his cushion and his eyes grew larger and larger and
  • the spots on his cheeks burned.
  • “Tell me some more about him,” he said.
  • “He knows all about eggs and nests,” Mary went on. “And he knows where
  • foxes and badgers and otters live. He keeps them secret so that other
  • boys won’t find their holes and frighten them. He knows about
  • everything that grows or lives on the moor.”
  • “Does he like the moor?” said Colin. “How can he when it’s such a
  • great, bare, dreary place?”
  • “It’s the most beautiful place,” protested Mary. “Thousands of lovely
  • things grow on it and there are thousands of little creatures all busy
  • building nests and making holes and burrows and chippering or singing
  • or squeaking to each other. They are so busy and having such fun under
  • the earth or in the trees or heather. It’s their world.”
  • “How do you know all that?” said Colin, turning on his elbow to look at
  • her.
  • “I have never been there once, really,” said Mary suddenly remembering.
  • “I only drove over it in the dark. I thought it was hideous. Martha
  • told me about it first and then Dickon. When Dickon talks about it you
  • feel as if you saw things and heard them and as if you were standing in
  • the heather with the sun shining and the gorse smelling like honey—and
  • all full of bees and butterflies.”
  • “You never see anything if you are ill,” said Colin restlessly. He
  • looked like a person listening to a new sound in the distance and
  • wondering what it was.
  • “You can’t if you stay in a room,” said Mary.
  • “I couldn’t go on the moor,” he said in a resentful tone.
  • Mary was silent for a minute and then she said something bold.
  • “You might—sometime.”
  • He moved as if he were startled.
  • “Go on the moor! How could I? I am going to die.”
  • “How do you know?” said Mary unsympathetically. She didn’t like the way
  • he had of talking about dying. She did not feel very sympathetic. She
  • felt rather as if he almost boasted about it.
  • “Oh, I’ve heard it ever since I remember,” he answered crossly. “They
  • are always whispering about it and thinking I don’t notice. They wish I
  • would, too.”
  • Mistress Mary felt quite contrary. She pinched her lips together.
  • “If they wished I would,” she said, “I wouldn’t. Who wishes you would?”
  • “The servants—and of course Dr. Craven because he would get
  • Misselthwaite and be rich instead of poor. He daren’t say so, but he
  • always looks cheerful when I am worse. When I had typhoid fever his
  • face got quite fat. I think my father wishes it, too.”
  • “I don’t believe he does,” said Mary quite obstinately.
  • That made Colin turn and look at her again.
  • “Don’t you?” he said.
  • And then he lay back on his cushion and was still, as if he were
  • thinking. And there was quite a long silence. Perhaps they were both of
  • them thinking strange things children do not usually think of.
  • “I like the grand doctor from London, because he made them take the
  • iron thing off,” said Mary at last “Did he say you were going to die?”
  • “No.”
  • “What did he say?”
  • “He didn’t whisper,” Colin answered. “Perhaps he knew I hated
  • whispering. I heard him say one thing quite aloud. He said, ‘The lad
  • might live if he would make up his mind to it. Put him in the humor.’
  • It sounded as if he was in a temper.”
  • “I’ll tell you who would put you in the humor, perhaps,” said Mary
  • reflecting. She felt as if she would like this thing to be settled one
  • way or the other. “I believe Dickon would. He’s always talking about
  • live things. He never talks about dead things or things that are ill.
  • He’s always looking up in the sky to watch birds flying—or looking down
  • at the earth to see something growing. He has such round blue eyes and
  • they are so wide open with looking about. And he laughs such a big
  • laugh with his wide mouth—and his cheeks are as red—as red as
  • cherries.”
  • She pulled her stool nearer to the sofa and her expression quite
  • changed at the remembrance of the wide curving mouth and wide open
  • eyes.
  • “See here,” she said. “Don’t let us talk about dying; I don’t like it.
  • Let us talk about living. Let us talk and talk about Dickon. And then
  • we will look at your pictures.”
  • It was the best thing she could have said. To talk about Dickon meant
  • to talk about the moor and about the cottage and the fourteen people
  • who lived in it on sixteen shillings a week—and the children who got
  • fat on the moor grass like the wild ponies. And about Dickon’s
  • mother—and the skipping-rope—and the moor with the sun on it—and about
  • pale green points sticking up out of the black sod. And it was all so
  • alive that Mary talked more than she had ever talked before—and Colin
  • both talked and listened as he had never done either before. And they
  • both began to laugh over nothings as children will when they are happy
  • together. And they laughed so that in the end they were making as much
  • noise as if they had been two ordinary healthy natural ten-year-old
  • creatures—instead of a hard, little, unloving girl and a sickly boy who
  • believed that he was going to die.
  • They enjoyed themselves so much that they forgot the pictures and they
  • forgot about the time. They had been laughing quite loudly over Ben
  • Weatherstaff and his robin, and Colin was actually sitting up as if he
  • had forgotten about his weak back, when he suddenly remembered
  • something.
  • “Do you know there is one thing we have never once thought of,” he
  • said. “We are cousins.”
  • It seemed so queer that they had talked so much and never remembered
  • this simple thing that they laughed more than ever, because they had
  • got into the humor to laugh at anything. And in the midst of the fun
  • the door opened and in walked Dr. Craven and Mrs. Medlock.
  • Dr. Craven started in actual alarm and Mrs. Medlock almost fell back
  • because he had accidentally bumped against her.
  • “Good Lord!” exclaimed poor Mrs. Medlock with her eyes almost starting
  • out of her head. “Good Lord!”
  • “What is this?” said Dr. Craven, coming forward. “What does it mean?”
  • Then Mary was reminded of the boy Rajah again. Colin answered as if
  • neither the doctor’s alarm nor Mrs. Medlock’s terror were of the
  • slightest consequence. He was as little disturbed or frightened as if
  • an elderly cat and dog had walked into the room.
  • “This is my cousin, Mary Lennox,” he said. “I asked her to come and
  • talk to me. I like her. She must come and talk to me whenever I send
  • for her.”
  • Dr. Craven turned reproachfully to Mrs. Medlock.
  • “Oh, sir” she panted. “I don’t know how it’s happened. There’s not a
  • servant on the place tha’d dare to talk—they all have their orders.”
  • “Nobody told her anything,” said Colin. “She heard me crying and found
  • me herself. I am glad she came. Don’t be silly, Medlock.”
  • Mary saw that Dr. Craven did not look pleased, but it was quite plain
  • that he dare not oppose his patient. He sat down by Colin and felt his
  • pulse.
  • “I am afraid there has been too much excitement. Excitement is not good
  • for you, my boy,” he said.
  • “I should be excited if she kept away,” answered Colin, his eyes
  • beginning to look dangerously sparkling. “I am better. She makes me
  • better. The nurse must bring up her tea with mine. We will have tea
  • together.”
  • Mrs. Medlock and Dr. Craven looked at each other in a troubled way, but
  • there was evidently nothing to be done.
  • “He does look rather better, sir,” ventured Mrs. Medlock.
  • “But”—thinking the matter over—“he looked better this morning before
  • she came into the room.”
  • “She came into the room last night. She stayed with me a long time. She
  • sang a Hindustani song to me and it made me go to sleep,” said Colin.
  • “I was better when I wakened up. I wanted my breakfast. I want my tea
  • now. Tell nurse, Medlock.”
  • Dr. Craven did not stay very long. He talked to the nurse for a few
  • minutes when she came into the room and said a few words of warning to
  • Colin. He must not talk too much; he must not forget that he was ill;
  • he must not forget that he was very easily tired. Mary thought that
  • there seemed to be a number of uncomfortable things he was not to
  • forget.
  • Colin looked fretful and kept his strange black-lashed eyes fixed on
  • Dr. Craven’s face.
  • “I _want_ to forget it,” he said at last. “She makes me forget it. That
  • is why I want her.”
  • Dr. Craven did not look happy when he left the room. He gave a puzzled
  • glance at the little girl sitting on the large stool. She had become a
  • stiff, silent child again as soon as he entered and he could not see
  • what the attraction was. The boy actually did look brighter,
  • however—and he sighed rather heavily as he went down the corridor.
  • “They are always wanting me to eat things when I don’t want to,” said
  • Colin, as the nurse brought in the tea and put it on the table by the
  • sofa. “Now, if you’ll eat I will. Those muffins look so nice and hot.
  • Tell me about Rajahs.”
  • CHAPTER XV
  • NEST BUILDING
  • After another week of rain the high arch of blue sky appeared again and
  • the sun which poured down was quite hot. Though there had been no
  • chance to see either the secret garden or Dickon, Mistress Mary had
  • enjoyed herself very much. The week had not seemed long. She had spent
  • hours of every day with Colin in his room, talking about Rajahs or
  • gardens or Dickon and the cottage on the moor. They had looked at the
  • splendid books and pictures and sometimes Mary had read things to
  • Colin, and sometimes he had read a little to her. When he was amused
  • and interested she thought he scarcely looked like an invalid at all,
  • except that his face was so colorless and he was always on the sofa.
  • “You are a sly young one to listen and get out of your bed to go
  • following things up like you did that night,” Mrs. Medlock said once.
  • “But there’s no saying it’s not been a sort of blessing to the lot of
  • us. He’s not had a tantrum or a whining fit since you made friends. The
  • nurse was just going to give up the case because she was so sick of
  • him, but she says she doesn’t mind staying now you’ve gone on duty with
  • her,” laughing a little.
  • In her talks with Colin, Mary had tried to be very cautious about the
  • secret garden. There were certain things she wanted to find out from
  • him, but she felt that she must find them out without asking him direct
  • questions. In the first place, as she began to like to be with him, she
  • wanted to discover whether he was the kind of boy you could tell a
  • secret to. He was not in the least like Dickon, but he was evidently so
  • pleased with the idea of a garden no one knew anything about that she
  • thought perhaps he could be trusted. But she had not known him long
  • enough to be sure. The second thing she wanted to find out was this: If
  • he could be trusted—if he really could—wouldn’t it be possible to take
  • him to the garden without having anyone find it out? The grand doctor
  • had said that he must have fresh air and Colin had said that he would
  • not mind fresh air in a secret garden. Perhaps if he had a great deal
  • of fresh air and knew Dickon and the robin and saw things growing he
  • might not think so much about dying. Mary had seen herself in the glass
  • sometimes lately when she had realized that she looked quite a
  • different creature from the child she had seen when she arrived from
  • India. This child looked nicer. Even Martha had seen a change in her.
  • “Th’ air from th’ moor has done thee good already,” she had said.
  • “Tha’rt not nigh so yeller and tha’rt not nigh so scrawny. Even tha’
  • hair doesn’t slamp down on tha’ head so flat. It’s got some life in it
  • so as it sticks out a bit.”
  • “It’s like me,” said Mary. “It’s growing stronger and fatter. I’m sure
  • there’s more of it.”
  • “It looks it, for sure,” said Martha, ruffling it up a little round her
  • face. “Tha’rt not half so ugly when it’s that way an’ there’s a bit o’
  • red in tha’ cheeks.”
  • If gardens and fresh air had been good for her perhaps they would be
  • good for Colin. But then, if he hated people to look at him, perhaps he
  • would not like to see Dickon.
  • “Why does it make you angry when you are looked at?” she inquired one
  • day.
  • “I always hated it,” he answered, “even when I was very little. Then
  • when they took me to the seaside and I used to lie in my carriage
  • everybody used to stare and ladies would stop and talk to my nurse and
  • then they would begin to whisper and I knew then they were saying I
  • shouldn’t live to grow up. Then sometimes the ladies would pat my
  • cheeks and say ‘Poor child!’ Once when a lady did that I screamed out
  • loud and bit her hand. She was so frightened she ran away.”
  • “She thought you had gone mad like a dog,” said Mary, not at all
  • admiringly.
  • “I don’t care what she thought,” said Colin, frowning.
  • “I wonder why you didn’t scream and bite me when I came into your
  • room?” said Mary. Then she began to smile slowly.
  • “I thought you were a ghost or a dream,” he said. “You can’t bite a
  • ghost or a dream, and if you scream they don’t care.”
  • “Would you hate it if—if a boy looked at you?” Mary asked uncertainly.
  • He lay back on his cushion and paused thoughtfully.
  • “There’s one boy,” he said quite slowly, as if he were thinking over
  • every word, “there’s one boy I believe I shouldn’t mind. It’s that boy
  • who knows where the foxes live—Dickon.”
  • “I’m sure you wouldn’t mind him,” said Mary.
  • “The birds don’t and other animals,” he said, still thinking it over,
  • “perhaps that’s why I shouldn’t. He’s a sort of animal charmer and I am
  • a boy animal.”
  • Then he laughed and she laughed too; in fact it ended in their both
  • laughing a great deal and finding the idea of a boy animal hiding in
  • his hole very funny indeed.
  • What Mary felt afterward was that she need not fear about Dickon.
  • On that first morning when the sky was blue again Mary wakened very
  • early. The sun was pouring in slanting rays through the blinds and
  • there was something so joyous in the sight of it that she jumped out of
  • bed and ran to the window. She drew up the blinds and opened the window
  • itself and a great waft of fresh, scented air blew in upon her. The
  • moor was blue and the whole world looked as if something Magic had
  • happened to it. There were tender little fluting sounds here and there
  • and everywhere, as if scores of birds were beginning to tune up for a
  • concert. Mary put her hand out of the window and held it in the sun.
  • “It’s warm—warm!” she said. “It will make the green points push up and
  • up and up, and it will make the bulbs and roots work and struggle with
  • all their might under the earth.”
  • She kneeled down and leaned out of the window as far as she could,
  • breathing big breaths and sniffing the air until she laughed because
  • she remembered what Dickon’s mother had said about the end of his nose
  • quivering like a rabbit’s.
  • “It must be very early,” she said. “The little clouds are all pink and
  • I’ve never seen the sky look like this. No one is up. I don’t even hear
  • the stable boys.”
  • A sudden thought made her scramble to her feet.
  • “I can’t wait! I am going to see the garden!”
  • She had learned to dress herself by this time and she put on her
  • clothes in five minutes. She knew a small side door which she could
  • unbolt herself and she flew downstairs in her stocking feet and put on
  • her shoes in the hall. She unchained and unbolted and unlocked and when
  • the door was open she sprang across the step with one bound, and there
  • she was standing on the grass, which seemed to have turned green, and
  • with the sun pouring down on her and warm sweet wafts about her and the
  • fluting and twittering and singing coming from every bush and tree. She
  • clasped her hands for pure joy and looked up in the sky and it was so
  • blue and pink and pearly and white and flooded with springtime light
  • that she felt as if she must flute and sing aloud herself and knew that
  • thrushes and robins and skylarks could not possibly help it. She ran
  • around the shrubs and paths towards the secret garden.
  • “It is all different already,” she said. “The grass is greener and
  • things are sticking up everywhere and things are uncurling and green
  • buds of leaves are showing. This afternoon I am sure Dickon will come.”
  • The long warm rain had done strange things to the herbaceous beds which
  • bordered the walk by the lower wall. There were things sprouting and
  • pushing out from the roots of clumps of plants and there were actually
  • here and there glimpses of royal purple and yellow unfurling among the
  • stems of crocuses. Six months before Mistress Mary would not have seen
  • how the world was waking up, but now she missed nothing.
  • When she had reached the place where the door hid itself under the ivy,
  • she was startled by a curious loud sound. It was the caw—caw of a crow
  • and it came from the top of the wall, and when she looked up, there sat
  • a big glossy-plumaged blue-black bird, looking down at her very wisely
  • indeed. She had never seen a crow so close before and he made her a
  • little nervous, but the next moment he spread his wings and flapped
  • away across the garden. She hoped he was not going to stay inside and
  • she pushed the door open wondering if he would. When she got fairly
  • into the garden she saw that he probably did intend to stay because he
  • had alighted on a dwarf apple-tree and under the apple-tree was lying a
  • little reddish animal with a Bushy tail, and both of them were watching
  • the stooping body and rust-red head of Dickon, who was kneeling on the
  • grass working hard.
  • Mary flew across the grass to him.
  • “Oh, Dickon! Dickon!” she cried out. “How could you get here so early!
  • How could you! The sun has only just got up!”
  • He got up himself, laughing and glowing, and tousled; his eyes like a
  • bit of the sky.
  • “Eh!” he said. “I was up long before him. How could I have stayed abed!
  • Th’ world’s all fair begun again this mornin’, it has. An’ it’s workin’
  • an’ hummin’ an’ scratchin’ an’ pipin’ an’ nest-buildin’ an’ breathin’
  • out scents, till you’ve got to be out on it ’stead o’ lyin’ on your
  • back. When th’ sun did jump up, th’ moor went mad for joy, an’ I was in
  • the midst of th’ heather, an’ I run like mad myself, shoutin’ an’
  • singin’. An’ I come straight here. I couldn’t have stayed away. Why,
  • th’ garden was lyin’ here waitin’!”
  • Mary put her hands on her chest, panting, as if she had been running
  • herself.
  • “Oh, Dickon! Dickon!” she said. “I’m so happy I can scarcely breathe!”
  • Seeing him talking to a stranger, the little bushy-tailed animal rose
  • from its place under the tree and came to him, and the rook, cawing
  • once, flew down from its branch and settled quietly on his shoulder.
  • “This is th’ little fox cub,” he said, rubbing the little reddish
  • animal’s head. “It’s named Captain. An’ this here’s Soot. Soot he flew
  • across th’ moor with me an’ Captain he run same as if th’ hounds had
  • been after him. They both felt same as I did.”
  • Neither of the creatures looked as if he were the least afraid of Mary.
  • When Dickon began to walk about, Soot stayed on his shoulder and
  • Captain trotted quietly close to his side.
  • “See here!” said Dickon. “See how these has pushed up, an’ these an’
  • these! An’ Eh! Look at these here!”
  • He threw himself upon his knees and Mary went down beside him. They had
  • come upon a whole clump of crocuses burst into purple and orange and
  • gold. Mary bent her face down and kissed and kissed them.
  • “You never kiss a person in that way,” she said when she lifted her
  • head. “Flowers are so different.”
  • He looked puzzled but smiled.
  • “Eh!” he said, “I’ve kissed mother many a time that way when I come in
  • from th’ moor after a day’s roamin’ an’ she stood there at th’ door in
  • th’ sun, lookin’ so glad an’ comfortable.”
  • They ran from one part of the garden to another and found so many
  • wonders that they were obliged to remind themselves that they must
  • whisper or speak low. He showed her swelling leafbuds on rose branches
  • which had seemed dead. He showed her ten thousand new green points
  • pushing through the mould. They put their eager young noses close to
  • the earth and sniffed its warmed springtime breathing; they dug and
  • pulled and laughed low with rapture until Mistress Mary’s hair was as
  • tumbled as Dickon’s and her cheeks were almost as poppy red as his.
  • There was every joy on earth in the secret garden that morning, and in
  • the midst of them came a delight more delightful than all, because it
  • was more wonderful. Swiftly something flew across the wall and darted
  • through the trees to a close grown corner, a little flare of
  • red-breasted bird with something hanging from its beak. Dickon stood
  • quite still and put his hand on Mary almost as if they had suddenly
  • found themselves laughing in a church.
  • “We munnot stir,” he whispered in broad Yorkshire. “We munnot scarce
  • breathe. I knowed he was mate-huntin’ when I seed him last. It’s Ben
  • Weatherstaff’s robin. He’s buildin’ his nest. He’ll stay here if us
  • don’t flight him.”
  • They settled down softly upon the grass and sat there without moving.
  • “Us mustn’t seem as if us was watchin’ him too close,” said Dickon.
  • “He’d be out with us for good if he got th’ notion us was interferin’
  • now. He’ll be a good bit different till all this is over. He’s settin’
  • up housekeepin’. He’ll be shyer an’ readier to take things ill. He’s
  • got no time for visitin’ an’ gossipin’. Us must keep still a bit an’
  • try to look as if us was grass an’ trees an’ bushes. Then when he’s got
  • used to seein’ us I’ll chirp a bit an’ he’ll know us’ll not be in his
  • way.”
  • Mistress Mary was not at all sure that she knew, as Dickon seemed to,
  • how to try to look like grass and trees and bushes. But he had said the
  • queer thing as if it were the simplest and most natural thing in the
  • world, and she felt it must be quite easy to him, and indeed she
  • watched him for a few minutes carefully, wondering if it was possible
  • for him to quietly turn green and put out branches and leaves. But he
  • only sat wonderfully still, and when he spoke dropped his voice to such
  • a softness that it was curious that she could hear him, but she could.
  • “It’s part o’ th’ springtime, this nest-buildin’ is,” he said. “I
  • warrant it’s been goin’ on in th’ same way every year since th’ world
  • was begun. They’ve got their way o’ thinkin’ and doin’ things an’ a
  • body had better not meddle. You can lose a friend in springtime easier
  • than any other season if you’re too curious.”
  • “If we talk about him I can’t help looking at him,” Mary said as softly
  • as possible. “We must talk of something else. There is something I want
  • to tell you.”
  • “He’ll like it better if us talks o’ somethin’ else,” said Dickon.
  • “What is it tha’s got to tell me?”
  • “Well—do you know about Colin?” she whispered.
  • He turned his head to look at her.
  • “What does tha’ know about him?” he asked.
  • “I’ve seen him. I have been to talk to him every day this week. He
  • wants me to come. He says I’m making him forget about being ill and
  • dying,” answered Mary.
  • Dickon looked actually relieved as soon as the surprise died away from
  • his round face.
  • “I am glad o’ that,” he exclaimed. “I’m right down glad. It makes me
  • easier. I knowed I must say nothin’ about him an’ I don’t like havin’
  • to hide things.”
  • “Don’t you like hiding the garden?” said Mary.
  • “I’ll never tell about it,” he answered. “But I says to mother,
  • ‘Mother,’ I says, ‘I got a secret to keep. It’s not a bad ’un, tha’
  • knows that. It’s no worse than hidin’ where a bird’s nest is. Tha’
  • doesn’t mind it, does tha’?’”
  • Mary always wanted to hear about mother.
  • “What did she say?” she asked, not at all afraid to hear.
  • Dickon grinned sweet-temperedly.
  • “It was just like her, what she said,” he answered. “She give my head a
  • bit of a rub an’ laughed an’ she says, ‘Eh, lad, tha’ can have all th’
  • secrets tha’ likes. I’ve knowed thee twelve year’.’”
  • “How did you know about Colin?” asked Mary.
  • “Everybody as knowed about Mester Craven knowed there was a little lad
  • as was like to be a cripple, an’ they knowed Mester Craven didn’t like
  • him to be talked about. Folks is sorry for Mester Craven because Mrs.
  • Craven was such a pretty young lady an’ they was so fond of each other.
  • Mrs. Medlock stops in our cottage whenever she goes to Thwaite an’ she
  • doesn’t mind talkin’ to mother before us children, because she knows us
  • has been brought up to be trusty. How did tha’ find out about him?
  • Martha was in fine trouble th’ last time she came home. She said tha’d
  • heard him frettin’ an’ tha’ was askin’ questions an’ she didn’t know
  • what to say.”
  • Mary told him her story about the midnight wuthering of the wind which
  • had wakened her and about the faint far-off sounds of the complaining
  • voice which had led her down the dark corridors with her candle and had
  • ended with her opening of the door of the dimly lighted room with the
  • carven four-posted bed in the corner. When she described the small
  • ivory-white face and the strange black-rimmed eyes Dickon shook his
  • head.
  • “Them’s just like his mother’s eyes, only hers was always laughin’,
  • they say,” he said. “They say as Mr. Craven can’t bear to see him when
  • he’s awake an’ it’s because his eyes is so like his mother’s an’ yet
  • looks so different in his miserable bit of a face.”
  • “Do you think he wants to die?” whispered Mary.
  • “No, but he wishes he’d never been born. Mother she says that’s th’
  • worst thing on earth for a child. Them as is not wanted scarce ever
  • thrives. Mester Craven he’d buy anythin’ as money could buy for th’
  • poor lad but he’d like to forget as he’s on earth. For one thing, he’s
  • afraid he’ll look at him some day and find he’s growed hunchback.”
  • “Colin’s so afraid of it himself that he won’t sit up,” said Mary. “He
  • says he’s always thinking that if he should feel a lump coming he
  • should go crazy and scream himself to death.”
  • “Eh! he oughtn’t to lie there thinkin’ things like that,” said Dickon.
  • “No lad could get well as thought them sort o’ things.”
  • The fox was lying on the grass close by him, looking up to ask for a
  • pat now and then, and Dickon bent down and rubbed his neck softly and
  • thought a few minutes in silence. Presently he lifted his head and
  • looked round the garden.
  • “When first we got in here,” he said, “it seemed like everything was
  • gray. Look round now and tell me if tha’ doesn’t see a difference.”
  • Mary looked and caught her breath a little.
  • “Why!” she cried, “the gray wall is changing. It is as if a green mist
  • were creeping over it. It’s almost like a green gauze veil.”
  • “Aye,” said Dickon. “An’ it’ll be greener and greener till th’ gray’s
  • all gone. Can tha’ guess what I was thinkin’?”
  • “I know it was something nice,” said Mary eagerly. “I believe it was
  • something about Colin.”
  • “I was thinkin’ that if he was out here he wouldn’t be watchin’ for
  • lumps to grow on his back; he’d be watchin’ for buds to break on th’
  • rose-bushes, an’ he’d likely be healthier,” explained Dickon. “I was
  • wonderin’ if us could ever get him in th’ humor to come out here an’
  • lie under th’ trees in his carriage.”
  • “I’ve been wondering that myself. I’ve thought of it almost every time
  • I’ve talked to him,” said Mary. “I’ve wondered if he could keep a
  • secret and I’ve wondered if we could bring him here without anyone
  • seeing us. I thought perhaps you could push his carriage. The doctor
  • said he must have fresh air and if he wants us to take him out no one
  • dare disobey him. He won’t go out for other people and perhaps they
  • will be glad if he will go out with us. He could order the gardeners to
  • keep away so they wouldn’t find out.”
  • Dickon was thinking very hard as he scratched Captain’s back.
  • “It’d be good for him, I’ll warrant,” he said. “Us’d not be thinkin’
  • he’d better never been born. Us’d be just two children watchin’ a
  • garden grow, an’ he’d be another. Two lads an’ a little lass just
  • lookin’ on at th’ springtime. I warrant it’d be better than doctor’s
  • stuff.”
  • “He’s been lying in his room so long and he’s always been so afraid of
  • his back that it has made him queer,” said Mary. “He knows a good many
  • things out of books but he doesn’t know anything else. He says he has
  • been too ill to notice things and he hates going out of doors and hates
  • gardens and gardeners. But he likes to hear about this garden because
  • it is a secret. I daren’t tell him much but he said he wanted to see
  • it.”
  • “Us’ll have him out here sometime for sure,” said Dickon. “I could push
  • his carriage well enough. Has tha’ noticed how th’ robin an’ his mate
  • has been workin’ while we’ve been sittin’ here? Look at him perched on
  • that branch wonderin’ where it’d be best to put that twig he’s got in
  • his beak.”
  • He made one of his low whistling calls and the robin turned his head
  • and looked at him inquiringly, still holding his twig. Dickon spoke to
  • him as Ben Weatherstaff did, but Dickon’s tone was one of friendly
  • advice.
  • “Wheres’ever tha’ puts it,” he said, “it’ll be all right. Tha’ knew how
  • to build tha’ nest before tha’ came out o’ th’ egg. Get on with thee,
  • lad. Tha’st got no time to lose.”
  • “Oh, I do like to hear you talk to him!” Mary said, laughing
  • delightedly. “Ben Weatherstaff scolds him and makes fun of him, and he
  • hops about and looks as if he understood every word, and I know he
  • likes it. Ben Weatherstaff says he is so conceited he would rather have
  • stones thrown at him than not be noticed.”
  • Dickon laughed too and went on talking.
  • “Tha’ knows us won’t trouble thee,” he said to the robin. “Us is near
  • bein’ wild things ourselves. Us is nest-buildin’ too, bless thee. Look
  • out tha’ doesn’t tell on us.”
  • And though the robin did not answer, because his beak was occupied,
  • Mary knew that when he flew away with his twig to his own corner of the
  • garden the darkness of his dew-bright eye meant that he would not tell
  • their secret for the world.
  • CHAPTER XVI
  • “I WON’T!” SAID MARY
  • They found a great deal to do that morning and Mary was late in
  • returning to the house and was also in such a hurry to get back to her
  • work that she quite forgot Colin until the last moment.
  • “Tell Colin that I can’t come and see him yet,” she said to Martha.
  • “I’m very busy in the garden.”
  • Martha looked rather frightened.
  • “Eh! Miss Mary,” she said, “it may put him all out of humor when I tell
  • him that.”
  • But Mary was not as afraid of him as other people were and she was not
  • a self-sacrificing person.
  • “I can’t stay,” she answered. “Dickon’s waiting for me;” and she ran
  • away.
  • The afternoon was even lovelier and busier than the morning had been.
  • Already nearly all the weeds were cleared out of the garden and most of
  • the roses and trees had been pruned or dug about. Dickon had brought a
  • spade of his own and he had taught Mary to use all her tools, so that
  • by this time it was plain that though the lovely wild place was not
  • likely to become a “gardener’s garden” it would be a wilderness of
  • growing things before the springtime was over.
  • “There’ll be apple blossoms an’ cherry blossoms overhead,” Dickon said,
  • working away with all his might. “An’ there’ll be peach an’ plum trees
  • in bloom against th’ walls, an’ th’ grass’ll be a carpet o’ flowers.”
  • The little fox and the rook were as happy and busy as they were, and
  • the robin and his mate flew backward and forward like tiny streaks of
  • lightning. Sometimes the rook flapped his black wings and soared away
  • over the tree-tops in the park. Each time he came back and perched near
  • Dickon and cawed several times as if he were relating his adventures,
  • and Dickon talked to him just as he had talked to the robin. Once when
  • Dickon was so busy that he did not answer him at first, Soot flew on to
  • his shoulders and gently tweaked his ear with his large beak. When Mary
  • wanted to rest a little Dickon sat down with her under a tree and once
  • he took his pipe out of his pocket and played the soft strange little
  • notes and two squirrels appeared on the wall and looked and listened.
  • “Tha’s a good bit stronger than tha’ was,” Dickon said, looking at her
  • as she was digging. “Tha’s beginning to look different, for sure.”
  • Mary was glowing with exercise and good spirits.
  • “I’m getting fatter and fatter every day,” she said quite exultantly.
  • “Mrs. Medlock will have to get me some bigger dresses. Martha says my
  • hair is growing thicker. It isn’t so flat and stringy.”
  • The sun was beginning to set and sending deep gold-colored rays
  • slanting under the trees when they parted.
  • “It’ll be fine tomorrow,” said Dickon. “I’ll be at work by sunrise.”
  • “So will I,” said Mary.
  • She ran back to the house as quickly as her feet would carry her. She
  • wanted to tell Colin about Dickon’s fox cub and the rook and about what
  • the springtime had been doing. She felt sure he would like to hear. So
  • it was not very pleasant when she opened the door of her room, to see
  • Martha standing waiting for her with a doleful face.
  • “What is the matter?” she asked. “What did Colin say when you told him
  • I couldn’t come?”
  • “Eh!” said Martha, “I wish tha’d gone. He was nigh goin’ into one o’
  • his tantrums. There’s been a nice to do all afternoon to keep him
  • quiet. He would watch the clock all th’ time.”
  • Mary’s lips pinched themselves together. She was no more used to
  • considering other people than Colin was and she saw no reason why an
  • ill-tempered boy should interfere with the thing she liked best. She
  • knew nothing about the pitifulness of people who had been ill and
  • nervous and who did not know that they could control their tempers and
  • need not make other people ill and nervous, too. When she had had a
  • headache in India she had done her best to see that everybody else also
  • had a headache or something quite as bad. And she felt she was quite
  • right; but of course now she felt that Colin was quite wrong.
  • He was not on his sofa when she went into his room. He was lying flat
  • on his back in bed and he did not turn his head toward her as she came
  • in. This was a bad beginning and Mary marched up to him with her stiff
  • manner.
  • “Why didn’t you get up?” she said.
  • “I did get up this morning when I thought you were coming,” he
  • answered, without looking at her. “I made them put me back in bed this
  • afternoon. My back ached and my head ached and I was tired. Why didn’t
  • you come?”
  • “I was working in the garden with Dickon,” said Mary.
  • Colin frowned and condescended to look at her.
  • “I won’t let that boy come here if you go and stay with him instead of
  • coming to talk to me,” he said.
  • Mary flew into a fine passion. She could fly into a passion without
  • making a noise. She just grew sour and obstinate and did not care what
  • happened.
  • “If you send Dickon away, I’ll never come into this room again!” she
  • retorted.
  • “You’ll have to if I want you,” said Colin.
  • “I won’t!” said Mary.
  • “I’ll make you,” said Colin. “They shall drag you in.”
  • “Shall they, Mr. Rajah!” said Mary fiercely. “They may drag me in but
  • they can’t make me talk when they get me here. I’ll sit and clench my
  • teeth and never tell you one thing. I won’t even look at you. I’ll
  • stare at the floor!”
  • They were a nice agreeable pair as they glared at each other. If they
  • had been two little street boys they would have sprung at each other
  • and had a rough-and-tumble fight. As it was, they did the next thing to
  • it.
  • “You are a selfish thing!” cried Colin.
  • “What are you?” said Mary. “Selfish people always say that. Anyone is
  • selfish who doesn’t do what they want. You’re more selfish than I am.
  • You’re the most selfish boy I ever saw.”
  • “I’m not!” snapped Colin. “I’m not as selfish as your fine Dickon is!
  • He keeps you playing in the dirt when he knows I am all by myself. He’s
  • selfish, if you like!”
  • Mary’s eyes flashed fire.
  • “He’s nicer than any other boy that ever lived!” she said. “He’s—he’s
  • like an angel!” It might sound rather silly to say that but she did not
  • care.
  • “A nice angel!” Colin sneered ferociously. “He’s a common cottage boy
  • off the moor!”
  • “He’s better than a common Rajah!” retorted Mary. “He’s a thousand
  • times better!”
  • Because she was the stronger of the two she was beginning to get the
  • better of him. The truth was that he had never had a fight with anyone
  • like himself in his life and, upon the whole, it was rather good for
  • him, though neither he nor Mary knew anything about that. He turned his
  • head on his pillow and shut his eyes and a big tear was squeezed out
  • and ran down his cheek. He was beginning to feel pathetic and sorry for
  • himself—not for anyone else.
  • “I’m not as selfish as you, because I’m always ill, and I’m sure there
  • is a lump coming on my back,” he said. “And I am going to die besides.”
  • “You’re not!” contradicted Mary unsympathetically.
  • He opened his eyes quite wide with indignation. He had never heard such
  • a thing said before. He was at once furious and slightly pleased, if a
  • person could be both at one time.
  • “I’m not?” he cried. “I am! You know I am! Everybody says so.”
  • “I don’t believe it!” said Mary sourly. “You just say that to make
  • people sorry. I believe you’re proud of it. I don’t believe it! If you
  • were a nice boy it might be true—but you’re too nasty!”
  • In spite of his invalid back Colin sat up in bed in quite a healthy
  • rage.
  • “Get out of the room!” he shouted and he caught hold of his pillow and
  • threw it at her. He was not strong enough to throw it far and it only
  • fell at her feet, but Mary’s face looked as pinched as a nutcracker.
  • “I’m going,” she said. “And I won’t come back!”
  • She walked to the door and when she reached it she turned round and
  • spoke again.
  • “I was going to tell you all sorts of nice things,” she said. “Dickon
  • brought his fox and his rook and I was going to tell you all about
  • them. Now I won’t tell you a single thing!”
  • She marched out of the door and closed it behind her, and there to her
  • great astonishment she found the trained nurse standing as if she had
  • been listening and, more amazing still—she was laughing. She was a big
  • handsome young woman who ought not to have been a trained nurse at all,
  • as she could not bear invalids and she was always making excuses to
  • leave Colin to Martha or anyone else who would take her place. Mary had
  • never liked her, and she simply stood and gazed up at her as she stood
  • giggling into her handkerchief..
  • “What are you laughing at?” she asked her.
  • “At you two young ones,” said the nurse. “It’s the best thing that
  • could happen to the sickly pampered thing to have someone to stand up
  • to him that’s as spoiled as himself;” and she laughed into her
  • handkerchief again. “If he’d had a young vixen of a sister to fight
  • with it would have been the saving of him.”
  • “Is he going to die?”
  • “I don’t know and I don’t care,” said the nurse. “Hysterics and temper
  • are half what ails him.”
  • “What are hysterics?” asked Mary.
  • “You’ll find out if you work him into a tantrum after this—but at any
  • rate you’ve given him something to have hysterics about, and I’m glad
  • of it.”
  • Mary went back to her room not feeling at all as she had felt when she
  • had come in from the garden. She was cross and disappointed but not at
  • all sorry for Colin. She had looked forward to telling him a great many
  • things and she had meant to try to make up her mind whether it would be
  • safe to trust him with the great secret. She had been beginning to
  • think it would be, but now she had changed her mind entirely. She would
  • never tell him and he could stay in his room and never get any fresh
  • air and die if he liked! It would serve him right! She felt so sour and
  • unrelenting that for a few minutes she almost forgot about Dickon and
  • the green veil creeping over the world and the soft wind blowing down
  • from the moor.
  • Martha was waiting for her and the trouble in her face had been
  • temporarily replaced by interest and curiosity. There was a wooden box
  • on the table and its cover had been removed and revealed that it was
  • full of neat packages.
  • “Mr. Craven sent it to you,” said Martha. “It looks as if it had
  • picture-books in it.”
  • Mary remembered what he had asked her the day she had gone to his room.
  • “Do you want anything—dolls—toys—books?” She opened the package
  • wondering if he had sent a doll, and also wondering what she should do
  • with it if he had. But he had not sent one. There were several
  • beautiful books such as Colin had, and two of them were about gardens
  • and were full of pictures. There were two or three games and there was
  • a beautiful little writing-case with a gold monogram on it and a gold
  • pen and inkstand.
  • Everything was so nice that her pleasure began to crowd her anger out
  • of her mind. She had not expected him to remember her at all and her
  • hard little heart grew quite warm.
  • “I can write better than I can print,” she said, “and the first thing I
  • shall write with that pen will be a letter to tell him I am much
  • obliged.”
  • If she had been friends with Colin she would have run to show him her
  • presents at once, and they would have looked at the pictures and read
  • some of the gardening books and perhaps tried playing the games, and he
  • would have enjoyed himself so much he would never once have thought he
  • was going to die or have put his hand on his spine to see if there was
  • a lump coming. He had a way of doing that which she could not bear. It
  • gave her an uncomfortable frightened feeling because he always looked
  • so frightened himself. He said that if he felt even quite a little lump
  • some day he should know his hunch had begun to grow. Something he had
  • heard Mrs. Medlock whispering to the nurse had given him the idea and
  • he had thought over it in secret until it was quite firmly fixed in his
  • mind. Mrs. Medlock had said his father’s back had begun to show its
  • crookedness in that way when he was a child. He had never told anyone
  • but Mary that most of his “tantrums” as they called them grew out of
  • his hysterical hidden fear. Mary had been sorry for him when he had
  • told her.
  • “He always began to think about it when he was cross or tired,” she
  • said to herself. “And he has been cross today. Perhaps—perhaps he has
  • been thinking about it all afternoon.”
  • She stood still, looking down at the carpet and thinking.
  • “I said I would never go back again—” she hesitated, knitting her
  • brows—“but perhaps, just perhaps, I will go and see—if he wants me—in
  • the morning. Perhaps he’ll try to throw his pillow at me again, but—I
  • think—I’ll go.”
  • CHAPTER XVII
  • A TANTRUM
  • She had got up very early in the morning and had worked hard in the
  • garden and she was tired and sleepy, so as soon as Martha had brought
  • her supper and she had eaten it, she was glad to go to bed. As she laid
  • her head on the pillow she murmured to herself:
  • “I’ll go out before breakfast and work with Dickon and then afterward—I
  • believe—I’ll go to see him.”
  • She thought it was the middle of the night when she was awakened by
  • such dreadful sounds that she jumped out of bed in an instant. What was
  • it—what was it? The next minute she felt quite sure she knew. Doors
  • were opened and shut and there were hurrying feet in the corridors and
  • someone was crying and screaming at the same time, screaming and crying
  • in a horrible way.
  • “It’s Colin,” she said. “He’s having one of those tantrums the nurse
  • called hysterics. How awful it sounds.”
  • As she listened to the sobbing screams she did not wonder that people
  • were so frightened that they gave him his own way in everything rather
  • than hear them. She put her hands over her ears and felt sick and
  • shivering.
  • “I don’t know what to do. I don’t know what to do,” she kept saying. “I
  • can’t bear it.”
  • Once she wondered if he would stop if she dared go to him and then she
  • remembered how he had driven her out of the room and thought that
  • perhaps the sight of her might make him worse. Even when she pressed
  • her hands more tightly over her ears she could not keep the awful
  • sounds out. She hated them so and was so terrified by them that
  • suddenly they began to make her angry and she felt as if she should
  • like to fly into a tantrum herself and frighten him as he was
  • frightening her. She was not used to anyone’s tempers but her own. She
  • took her hands from her ears and sprang up and stamped her foot.
  • “He ought to be stopped! Somebody ought to make him stop! Somebody
  • ought to beat him!” she cried out.
  • Just then she heard feet almost running down the corridor and her door
  • opened and the nurse came in. She was not laughing now by any means.
  • She even looked rather pale.
  • “He’s worked himself into hysterics,” she said in a great hurry. “He’ll
  • do himself harm. No one can do anything with him. You come and try,
  • like a good child. He likes you.”
  • “He turned me out of the room this morning,” said Mary, stamping her
  • foot with excitement.
  • The stamp rather pleased the nurse. The truth was that she had been
  • afraid she might find Mary crying and hiding her head under the
  • bed-clothes.
  • “That’s right,” she said. “You’re in the right humor. You go and scold
  • him. Give him something new to think of. Do go, child, as quick as ever
  • you can.”
  • It was not until afterward that Mary realized that the thing had been
  • funny as well as dreadful—that it was funny that all the grown-up
  • people were so frightened that they came to a little girl just because
  • they guessed she was almost as bad as Colin himself.
  • She flew along the corridor and the nearer she got to the screams the
  • higher her temper mounted. She felt quite wicked by the time she
  • reached the door. She slapped it open with her hand and ran across the
  • room to the four-posted bed.
  • “You stop!” she almost shouted. “You stop! I hate you! Everybody hates
  • you! I wish everybody would run out of the house and let you scream
  • yourself to death! You _will_ scream yourself to death in a minute, and
  • I wish you would!”
  • A nice sympathetic child could neither have thought nor said such
  • things, but it just happened that the shock of hearing them was the
  • best possible thing for this hysterical boy whom no one had ever dared
  • to restrain or contradict.
  • He had been lying on his face beating his pillow with his hands and he
  • actually almost jumped around, he turned so quickly at the sound of the
  • furious little voice. His face looked dreadful, white and red and
  • swollen, and he was gasping and choking; but savage little Mary did not
  • care an atom.
  • “If you scream another scream,” she said, “I’ll scream too—and I can
  • scream louder than you can and I’ll frighten you, I’ll frighten you!”
  • He actually had stopped screaming because she had startled him so. The
  • scream which had been coming almost choked him. The tears were
  • streaming down his face and he shook all over.
  • “I can’t stop!” he gasped and sobbed. “I can’t—I can’t!”
  • “You can!” shouted Mary. “Half that ails you is hysterics and
  • temper—just hysterics—hysterics—hysterics!” and she stamped each time
  • she said it.
  • “I felt the lump—I felt it,” choked out Colin. “I knew I should. I
  • shall have a hunch on my back and then I shall die,” and he began to
  • writhe again and turned on his face and sobbed and wailed but he didn’t
  • scream.
  • “You didn’t feel a lump!” contradicted Mary fiercely. “If you did it
  • was only a hysterical lump. Hysterics makes lumps. There’s nothing the
  • matter with your horrid back—nothing but hysterics! Turn over and let
  • me look at it!”
  • She liked the word “hysterics” and felt somehow as if it had an effect
  • on him. He was probably like herself and had never heard it before.
  • “Nurse,” she commanded, “come here and show me his back this minute!”
  • The nurse, Mrs. Medlock and Martha had been standing huddled together
  • near the door staring at her, their mouths half open. All three had
  • gasped with fright more than once. The nurse came forward as if she
  • were half afraid. Colin was heaving with great breathless sobs.
  • “Perhaps he—he won’t let me,” she hesitated in a low voice.
  • Colin heard her, however, and he gasped out between two sobs:
  • “Sh-show her! She-she’ll see then!”
  • It was a poor thin back to look at when it was bared. Every rib could
  • be counted and every joint of the spine, though Mistress Mary did not
  • count them as she bent over and examined them with a solemn savage
  • little face. She looked so sour and old-fashioned that the nurse turned
  • her head aside to hide the twitching of her mouth. There was just a
  • minute’s silence, for even Colin tried to hold his breath while Mary
  • looked up and down his spine, and down and up, as intently as if she
  • had been the great doctor from London.
  • “There’s not a single lump there!” she said at last. “There’s not a
  • lump as big as a pin—except backbone lumps, and you can only feel them
  • because you’re thin. I’ve got backbone lumps myself, and they used to
  • stick out as much as yours do, until I began to get fatter, and I am
  • not fat enough yet to hide them. There’s not a lump as big as a pin! If
  • you ever say there is again, I shall laugh!”
  • No one but Colin himself knew what effect those crossly spoken childish
  • words had on him. If he had ever had anyone to talk to about his secret
  • terrors—if he had ever dared to let himself ask questions—if he had had
  • childish companions and had not lain on his back in the huge closed
  • house, breathing an atmosphere heavy with the fears of people who were
  • most of them ignorant and tired of him, he would have found out that
  • most of his fright and illness was created by himself. But he had lain
  • and thought of himself and his aches and weariness for hours and days
  • and months and years. And now that an angry unsympathetic little girl
  • insisted obstinately that he was not as ill as he thought he was he
  • actually felt as if she might be speaking the truth.
  • “I didn’t know,” ventured the nurse, “that he thought he had a lump on
  • his spine. His back is weak because he won’t try to sit up. I could
  • have told him there was no lump there.” Colin gulped and turned his
  • face a little to look at her.
  • “C-could you?” he said pathetically.
  • “Yes, sir.”
  • “There!” said Mary, and she gulped too.
  • Colin turned on his face again and but for his long-drawn broken
  • breaths, which were the dying down of his storm of sobbing, he lay
  • still for a minute, though great tears streamed down his face and wet
  • the pillow. Actually the tears meant that a curious great relief had
  • come to him. Presently he turned and looked at the nurse again and
  • strangely enough he was not like a Rajah at all as he spoke to her.
  • “Do you think—I could—live to grow up?” he said.
  • The nurse was neither clever nor soft-hearted but she could repeat some
  • of the London doctor’s words.
  • “You probably will if you will do what you are told to do and not give
  • way to your temper, and stay out a great deal in the fresh air.”
  • Colin’s tantrum had passed and he was weak and worn out with crying and
  • this perhaps made him feel gentle. He put out his hand a little toward
  • Mary, and I am glad to say that, her own tantum having passed, she was
  • softened too and met him half-way with her hand, so that it was a sort
  • of making up.
  • “I’ll—I’ll go out with you, Mary,” he said. “I shan’t hate fresh air if
  • we can find—” He remembered just in time to stop himself from saying
  • “if we can find the secret garden” and he ended, “I shall like to go
  • out with you if Dickon will come and push my chair. I do so want to see
  • Dickon and the fox and the crow.”
  • The nurse remade the tumbled bed and shook and straightened the
  • pillows. Then she made Colin a cup of beef tea and gave a cup to Mary,
  • who really was very glad to get it after her excitement. Mrs. Medlock
  • and Martha gladly slipped away, and after everything was neat and calm
  • and in order the nurse looked as if she would very gladly slip away
  • also. She was a healthy young woman who resented being robbed of her
  • sleep and she yawned quite openly as she looked at Mary, who had pushed
  • her big footstool close to the four-posted bed and was holding Colin’s
  • hand.
  • “You must go back and get your sleep out,” she said. “He’ll drop off
  • after a while—if he’s not too upset. Then I’ll lie down myself in the
  • next room.”
  • “Would you like me to sing you that song I learned from my Ayah?” Mary
  • whispered to Colin.
  • His hand pulled hers gently and he turned his tired eyes on her
  • appealingly.
  • “Oh, yes!” he answered. “It’s such a soft song. I shall go to sleep in
  • a minute.”
  • “I will put him to sleep,” Mary said to the yawning nurse. “You can go
  • if you like.”
  • “Well,” said the nurse, with an attempt at reluctance. “If he doesn’t
  • go to sleep in half an hour you must call me.”
  • “Very well,” answered Mary.
  • The nurse was out of the room in a minute and as soon as she was gone
  • Colin pulled Mary’s hand again.
  • “I almost told,” he said; “but I stopped myself in time. I won’t talk
  • and I’ll go to sleep, but you said you had a whole lot of nice things
  • to tell me. Have you—do you think you have found out anything at all
  • about the way into the secret garden?”
  • Mary looked at his poor little tired face and swollen eyes and her
  • heart relented.
  • “Ye-es,” she answered, “I think I have. And if you will go to sleep I
  • will tell you tomorrow.” His hand quite trembled.
  • “Oh, Mary!” he said. “Oh, Mary! If I could get into it I think I should
  • live to grow up! Do you suppose that instead of singing the Ayah
  • song—you could just tell me softly as you did that first day what you
  • imagine it looks like inside? I am sure it will make me go to sleep.”
  • “Yes,” answered Mary. “Shut your eyes.”
  • He closed his eyes and lay quite still and she held his hand and began
  • to speak very slowly and in a very low voice.
  • “I think it has been left alone so long—that it has grown all into a
  • lovely tangle. I think the roses have climbed and climbed and climbed
  • until they hang from the branches and walls and creep over the
  • ground—almost like a strange gray mist. Some of them have died but
  • many—are alive and when the summer comes there will be curtains and
  • fountains of roses. I think the ground is full of daffodils and
  • snowdrops and lilies and iris working their way out of the dark. Now
  • the spring has begun—perhaps—perhaps—”
  • The soft drone of her voice was making him stiller and stiller and she
  • saw it and went on.
  • “Perhaps they are coming up through the grass—perhaps there are
  • clusters of purple crocuses and gold ones—even now. Perhaps the leaves
  • are beginning to break out and uncurl—and perhaps—the gray is changing
  • and a green gauze veil is creeping—and creeping over—everything. And
  • the birds are coming to look at it—because it is—so safe and still. And
  • perhaps—perhaps—perhaps—” very softly and slowly indeed, “the robin has
  • found a mate—and is building a nest.”
  • And Colin was asleep.
  • CHAPTER XVIII
  • “THA’ MUNNOT WASTE NO TIME”
  • Of course Mary did not waken early the next morning. She slept late
  • because she was tired, and when Martha brought her breakfast she told
  • her that though Colin was quite quiet he was ill and feverish as he
  • always was after he had worn himself out with a fit of crying. Mary ate
  • her breakfast slowly as she listened.
  • “He says he wishes tha’ would please go and see him as soon as tha’
  • can,” Martha said. “It’s queer what a fancy he’s took to thee. Tha’ did
  • give it him last night for sure—didn’t tha? Nobody else would have
  • dared to do it. Eh! poor lad! He’s been spoiled till salt won’t save
  • him. Mother says as th’ two worst things as can happen to a child is
  • never to have his own way—or always to have it. She doesn’t know which
  • is th’ worst. Tha’ was in a fine temper tha’self, too. But he says to
  • me when I went into his room, ‘Please ask Miss Mary if she’ll please
  • come an’ talk to me?’ Think o’ him saying please! Will you go, Miss?”
  • “I’ll run and see Dickon first,” said Mary. “No, I’ll go and see Colin
  • first and tell him—I know what I’ll tell him,” with a sudden
  • inspiration.
  • She had her hat on when she appeared in Colin’s room and for a second
  • he looked disappointed. He was in bed. His face was pitifully white and
  • there were dark circles round his eyes.
  • “I’m glad you came,” he said. “My head aches and I ache all over
  • because I’m so tired. Are you going somewhere?”
  • Mary went and leaned against his bed.
  • “I won’t be long,” she said. “I’m going to Dickon, but I’ll come back.
  • Colin, it’s—it’s something about the garden.”
  • His whole face brightened and a little color came into it.
  • “Oh! is it?” he cried out. “I dreamed about it all night. I heard you
  • say something about gray changing into green, and I dreamed I was
  • standing in a place all filled with trembling little green leaves—and
  • there were birds on nests everywhere and they looked so soft and still.
  • I’ll lie and think about it until you come back.”
  • In five minutes Mary was with Dickon in their garden. The fox and the
  • crow were with him again and this time he had brought two tame
  • squirrels.
  • “I came over on the pony this mornin’,” he said. “Eh! he is a good
  • little chap—Jump is! I brought these two in my pockets. This here one
  • he’s called Nut an’ this here other one’s called Shell.”
  • When he said “Nut” one squirrel leaped on to his right shoulder and
  • when he said “Shell” the other one leaped on to his left shoulder.
  • When they sat down on the grass with Captain curled at their feet, Soot
  • solemnly listening on a tree and Nut and Shell nosing about close to
  • them, it seemed to Mary that it would be scarcely bearable to leave
  • such delightfulness, but when she began to tell her story somehow the
  • look in Dickon’s funny face gradually changed her mind. She could see
  • he felt sorrier for Colin than she did. He looked up at the sky and all
  • about him.
  • “Just listen to them birds—th’ world seems full of ’em—all whistlin’
  • an’ pipin’,” he said. “Look at ’em dartin’ about, an’ hearken at ’em
  • callin’ to each other. Come springtime seems like as if all th’ world’s
  • callin’. The leaves is uncurlin’ so you can see ’em—an’, my word, th’
  • nice smells there is about!” sniffing with his happy turned-up nose.
  • “An’ that poor lad lyin’ shut up an’ seein’ so little that he gets to
  • thinkin’ o’ things as sets him screamin’. Eh! my! we mun get him out
  • here—we mun get him watchin’ an listenin’ an’ sniffin’ up th’ air an’
  • get him just soaked through wi’ sunshine. An’ we munnot lose no time
  • about it.”
  • When he was very much interested he often spoke quite broad Yorkshire
  • though at other times he tried to modify his dialect so that Mary could
  • better understand. But she loved his broad Yorkshire and had in fact
  • been trying to learn to speak it herself. So she spoke a little now.
  • “Aye, that we mun,” she said (which meant “Yes, indeed, we must”).
  • “I’ll tell thee what us’ll do first,” she proceeded, and Dickon
  • grinned, because when the little wench tried to twist her tongue into
  • speaking Yorkshire it amused him very much. “He’s took a graidely fancy
  • to thee. He wants to see thee and he wants to see Soot an’ Captain.
  • When I go back to the house to talk to him I’ll ax him if tha’ canna’
  • come an’ see him tomorrow mornin’—an’ bring tha’ creatures wi’ thee—an’
  • then—in a bit, when there’s more leaves out, an’ happen a bud or two,
  • we’ll get him to come out an’ tha’ shall push him in his chair an’
  • we’ll bring him here an’ show him everything.”
  • When she stopped she was quite proud of herself. She had never made a
  • long speech in Yorkshire before and she had remembered very well.
  • “Tha’ mun talk a bit o’ Yorkshire like that to Mester Colin,” Dickon
  • chuckled. “Tha’ll make him laugh an’ there’s nowt as good for ill folk
  • as laughin’ is. Mother says she believes as half a hour’s good laugh
  • every mornin’ ’ud cure a chap as was makin’ ready for typhus fever.”
  • “I’m going to talk Yorkshire to him this very day,” said Mary,
  • chuckling herself.
  • The garden had reached the time when every day and every night it
  • seemed as if Magicians were passing through it drawing loveliness out
  • of the earth and the boughs with wands. It was hard to go away and
  • leave it all, particularly as Nut had actually crept on to her dress
  • and Shell had scrambled down the trunk of the apple-tree they sat under
  • and stayed there looking at her with inquiring eyes. But she went back
  • to the house and when she sat down close to Colin’s bed he began to
  • sniff as Dickon did though not in such an experienced way.
  • “You smell like flowers and—and fresh things,” he cried out quite
  • joyously. “What is it you smell of? It’s cool and warm and sweet all at
  • the same time.”
  • “It’s th’ wind from th’ moor,” said Mary. “It comes o’ sittin’ on th’
  • grass under a tree wi’ Dickon an’ wi’ Captain an’ Soot an’ Nut an’
  • Shell. It’s th’ springtime an’ out o’ doors an’ sunshine as smells so
  • graidely.”
  • She said it as broadly as she could, and you do not know how broadly
  • Yorkshire sounds until you have heard someone speak it. Colin began to
  • laugh.
  • “What are you doing?” he said. “I never heard you talk like that
  • before. How funny it sounds.”
  • “I’m givin’ thee a bit o’ Yorkshire,” answered Mary triumphantly. “I
  • canna’ talk as graidely as Dickon an’ Martha can but tha’ sees I can
  • shape a bit. Doesn’t tha’ understand a bit o’ Yorkshire when tha’ hears
  • it? An’ tha’ a Yorkshire lad thysel’ bred an’ born! Eh! I wonder tha’rt
  • not ashamed o’ thy face.”
  • And then she began to laugh too and they both laughed until they could
  • not stop themselves and they laughed until the room echoed and Mrs.
  • Medlock opening the door to come in drew back into the corridor and
  • stood listening amazed.
  • “Well, upon my word!” she said, speaking rather broad Yorkshire herself
  • because there was no one to hear her and she was so astonished.
  • “Whoever heard th’ like! Whoever on earth would ha’ thought it!”
  • There was so much to talk about. It seemed as if Colin could never hear
  • enough of Dickon and Captain and Soot and Nut and Shell and the pony
  • whose name was Jump. Mary had run round into the wood with Dickon to
  • see Jump. He was a tiny little shaggy moor pony with thick locks
  • hanging over his eyes and with a pretty face and a nuzzling velvet
  • nose. He was rather thin with living on moor grass but he was as tough
  • and wiry as if the muscle in his little legs had been made of steel
  • springs. He had lifted his head and whinnied softly the moment he saw
  • Dickon and he had trotted up to him and put his head across his
  • shoulder and then Dickon had talked into his ear and Jump had talked
  • back in odd little whinnies and puffs and snorts. Dickon had made him
  • give Mary his small front hoof and kiss her on her cheek with his
  • velvet muzzle.
  • “Does he really understand everything Dickon says?” Colin asked.
  • “It seems as if he does,” answered Mary. “Dickon says anything will
  • understand if you’re friends with it for sure, but you have to be
  • friends for sure.”
  • Colin lay quiet a little while and his strange gray eyes seemed to be
  • staring at the wall, but Mary saw he was thinking.
  • “I wish I was friends with things,” he said at last, “but I’m not. I
  • never had anything to be friends with, and I can’t bear people.”
  • “Can’t you bear me?” asked Mary.
  • “Yes, I can,” he answered. “It’s funny but I even like you.”
  • “Ben Weatherstaff said I was like him,” said Mary. “He said he’d
  • warrant we’d both got the same nasty tempers. I think you are like him
  • too. We are all three alike—you and I and Ben Weatherstaff. He said we
  • were neither of us much to look at and we were as sour as we looked.
  • But I don’t feel as sour as I used to before I knew the robin and
  • Dickon.”
  • “Did you feel as if you hated people?”
  • “Yes,” answered Mary without any affectation. “I should have detested
  • you if I had seen you before I saw the robin and Dickon.”
  • Colin put out his thin hand and touched her.
  • “Mary,” he said, “I wish I hadn’t said what I did about sending Dickon
  • away. I hated you when you said he was like an angel and I laughed at
  • you but—but perhaps he is.”
  • “Well, it was rather funny to say it,” she admitted frankly, “because
  • his nose does turn up and he has a big mouth and his clothes have
  • patches all over them and he talks broad Yorkshire, but—but if an angel
  • did come to Yorkshire and live on the moor—if there was a Yorkshire
  • angel—I believe he’d understand the green things and know how to make
  • them grow and he would know how to talk to the wild creatures as Dickon
  • does and they’d know he was friends for sure.”
  • “I shouldn’t mind Dickon looking at me,” said Colin; “I want to see
  • him.”
  • “I’m glad you said that,” answered Mary, “because—because—”
  • Quite suddenly it came into her mind that this was the minute to tell
  • him. Colin knew something new was coming.
  • “Because what?” he cried eagerly.
  • Mary was so anxious that she got up from her stool and came to him and
  • caught hold of both his hands.
  • “Can I trust you? I trusted Dickon because birds trusted him. Can I
  • trust you—for sure—_for sure?_” she implored.
  • Her face was so solemn that he almost whispered his answer.
  • “Yes—yes!”
  • “Well, Dickon will come to see you tomorrow morning, and he’ll bring
  • his creatures with him.”
  • “Oh! Oh!” Colin cried out in delight.
  • “But that’s not all,” Mary went on, almost pale with solemn excitement.
  • “The rest is better. There is a door into the garden. I found it. It is
  • under the ivy on the wall.”
  • If he had been a strong healthy boy Colin would probably have shouted
  • “Hooray! Hooray! Hooray!” but he was weak and rather hysterical; his
  • eyes grew bigger and bigger and he gasped for breath.
  • “Oh! Mary!” he cried out with a half sob. “Shall I see it? Shall I get
  • into it? Shall I _live_ to get into it?” and he clutched her hands and
  • dragged her toward him.
  • “Of course you’ll see it!” snapped Mary indignantly. “Of course you’ll
  • live to get into it! Don’t be silly!”
  • And she was so un-hysterical and natural and childish that she brought
  • him to his senses and he began to laugh at himself and a few minutes
  • afterward she was sitting on her stool again telling him not what she
  • imagined the secret garden to be like but what it really was, and
  • Colin’s aches and tiredness were forgotten and he was listening
  • enraptured.
  • “It is just what you thought it would be,” he said at last. “It sounds
  • just as if you had really seen it. You know I said that when you told
  • me first.”
  • Mary hesitated about two minutes and then boldly spoke the truth.
  • “I had seen it—and I had been in,” she said. “I found the key and got
  • in weeks ago. But I daren’t tell you—I daren’t because I was so afraid
  • I couldn’t trust you—_for sure!_”
  • CHAPTER XIX
  • “IT HAS COME!”
  • Of course Dr. Craven had been sent for the morning after Colin had had
  • his tantrum. He was always sent for at once when such a thing occurred
  • and he always found, when he arrived, a white shaken boy lying on his
  • bed, sulky and still so hysterical that he was ready to break into
  • fresh sobbing at the least word. In fact, Dr. Craven dreaded and
  • detested the difficulties of these visits. On this occasion he was away
  • from Misselthwaite Manor until afternoon.
  • “How is he?” he asked Mrs. Medlock rather irritably when he arrived.
  • “He will break a blood-vessel in one of those fits some day. The boy is
  • half insane with hysteria and self-indulgence.”
  • “Well, sir,” answered Mrs. Medlock, “you’ll scarcely believe your eyes
  • when you see him. That plain sour-faced child that’s almost as bad as
  • himself has just bewitched him. How she’s done it there’s no telling.
  • The Lord knows she’s nothing to look at and you scarcely ever hear her
  • speak, but she did what none of us dare do. She just flew at him like a
  • little cat last night, and stamped her feet and ordered him to stop
  • screaming, and somehow she startled him so that he actually did stop,
  • and this afternoon—well just come up and see, sir. It’s past
  • crediting.”
  • The scene which Dr. Craven beheld when he entered his patient’s room
  • was indeed rather astonishing to him. As Mrs. Medlock opened the door
  • he heard laughing and chattering. Colin was on his sofa in his
  • dressing-gown and he was sitting up quite straight looking at a picture
  • in one of the garden books and talking to the plain child who at that
  • moment could scarcely be called plain at all because her face was so
  • glowing with enjoyment.
  • “Those long spires of blue ones—we’ll have a lot of those,” Colin was
  • announcing. “They’re called Del-phin-iums.”
  • “Dickon says they’re larkspurs made big and grand,” cried Mistress
  • Mary. “There are clumps there already.”
  • Then they saw Dr. Craven and stopped. Mary became quite still and Colin
  • looked fretful.
  • “I am sorry to hear you were ill last night, my boy,” Dr. Craven said a
  • trifle nervously. He was rather a nervous man.
  • “I’m better now—much better,” Colin answered, rather like a Rajah. “I’m
  • going out in my chair in a day or two if it is fine. I want some fresh
  • air.”
  • Dr. Craven sat down by him and felt his pulse and looked at him
  • curiously.
  • “It must be a very fine day,” he said, “and you must be very careful
  • not to tire yourself.”
  • “Fresh air won’t tire me,” said the young Rajah.
  • As there had been occasions when this same young gentleman had shrieked
  • aloud with rage and had insisted that fresh air would give him cold and
  • kill him, it is not to be wondered at that his doctor felt somewhat
  • startled.
  • “I thought you did not like fresh air,” he said.
  • “I don’t when I am by myself,” replied the Rajah; “but my cousin is
  • going out with me.”
  • “And the nurse, of course?” suggested Dr. Craven.
  • “No, I will not have the nurse,” so magnificently that Mary could not
  • help remembering how the young native Prince had looked with his
  • diamonds and emeralds and pearls stuck all over him and the great
  • rubies on the small dark hand he had waved to command his servants to
  • approach with salaams and receive his orders.
  • “My cousin knows how to take care of me. I am always better when she is
  • with me. She made me better last night. A very strong boy I know will
  • push my carriage.”
  • Dr. Craven felt rather alarmed. If this tiresome hysterical boy should
  • chance to get well he himself would lose all chance of inheriting
  • Misselthwaite; but he was not an unscrupulous man, though he was a weak
  • one, and he did not intend to let him run into actual danger.
  • “He must be a strong boy and a steady boy,” he said. “And I must know
  • something about him. Who is he? What is his name?”
  • “It’s Dickon,” Mary spoke up suddenly. She felt somehow that everybody
  • who knew the moor must know Dickon. And she was right, too. She saw
  • that in a moment Dr. Craven’s serious face relaxed into a relieved
  • smile.
  • “Oh, Dickon,” he said. “If it is Dickon you will be safe enough. He’s
  • as strong as a moor pony, is Dickon.”
  • “And he’s trusty,” said Mary. “He’s th’ trustiest lad i’ Yorkshire.”
  • She had been talking Yorkshire to Colin and she forgot herself.
  • “Did Dickon teach you that?” asked Dr. Craven, laughing outright.
  • “I’m learning it as if it was French,” said Mary rather coldly. “It’s
  • like a native dialect in India. Very clever people try to learn them. I
  • like it and so does Colin.”
  • “Well, well,” he said. “If it amuses you perhaps it won’t do you any
  • harm. Did you take your bromide last night, Colin?”
  • “No,” Colin answered. “I wouldn’t take it at first and after Mary made
  • me quiet she talked me to sleep—in a low voice—about the spring
  • creeping into a garden.”
  • “That sounds soothing,” said Dr. Craven, more perplexed than ever and
  • glancing sideways at Mistress Mary sitting on her stool and looking
  • down silently at the carpet. “You are evidently better, but you must
  • remember—”
  • “I don’t want to remember,” interrupted the Rajah, appearing again.
  • “When I lie by myself and remember I begin to have pains everywhere and
  • I think of things that make me begin to scream because I hate them so.
  • If there was a doctor anywhere who could make you forget you were ill
  • instead of remembering it I would have him brought here.” And he waved
  • a thin hand which ought really to have been covered with royal signet
  • rings made of rubies. “It is because my cousin makes me forget that she
  • makes me better.”
  • Dr. Craven had never made such a short stay after a “tantrum”; usually
  • he was obliged to remain a very long time and do a great many things.
  • This afternoon he did not give any medicine or leave any new orders and
  • he was spared any disagreeable scenes. When he went downstairs he
  • looked very thoughtful and when he talked to Mrs. Medlock in the
  • library she felt that he was a much puzzled man.
  • “Well, sir,” she ventured, “could you have believed it?”
  • “It is certainly a new state of affairs,” said the doctor. “And there’s
  • no denying it is better than the old one.”
  • “I believe Susan Sowerby’s right—I do that,” said Mrs. Medlock. “I
  • stopped in her cottage on my way to Thwaite yesterday and had a bit of
  • talk with her. And she says to me, ‘Well, Sarah Ann, she mayn’t be a
  • good child, an’ she mayn’t be a pretty one, but she’s a child, an’
  • children needs children.’ We went to school together, Susan Sowerby and
  • me.”
  • “She’s the best sick nurse I know,” said Dr. Craven. “When I find her
  • in a cottage I know the chances are that I shall save my patient.”
  • Mrs. Medlock smiled. She was fond of Susan Sowerby.
  • “She’s got a way with her, has Susan,” she went on quite volubly. “I’ve
  • been thinking all morning of one thing she said yesterday. She says,
  • ‘Once when I was givin’ th’ children a bit of a preach after they’d
  • been fightin’ I ses to ’em all, “When I was at school my jography told
  • as th’ world was shaped like a orange an’ I found out before I was ten
  • that th’ whole orange doesn’t belong to nobody. No one owns more than
  • his bit of a quarter an’ there’s times it seems like there’s not enow
  • quarters to go round. But don’t you—none o’ you—think as you own th’
  • whole orange or you’ll find out you’re mistaken, an’ you won’t find it
  • out without hard knocks.” ‘What children learns from children,’ she
  • says, ‘is that there’s no sense in grabbin’ at th’ whole orange—peel
  • an’ all. If you do you’ll likely not get even th’ pips, an’ them’s too
  • bitter to eat.’”
  • “She’s a shrewd woman,” said Dr. Craven, putting on his coat.
  • “Well, she’s got a way of saying things,” ended Mrs. Medlock, much
  • pleased. “Sometimes I’ve said to her, ‘Eh! Susan, if you was a
  • different woman an’ didn’t talk such broad Yorkshire I’ve seen the
  • times when I should have said you was clever.’”
  • That night Colin slept without once awakening and when he opened his
  • eyes in the morning he lay still and smiled without knowing it—smiled
  • because he felt so curiously comfortable. It was actually nice to be
  • awake, and he turned over and stretched his limbs luxuriously. He felt
  • as if tight strings which had held him had loosened themselves and let
  • him go. He did not know that Dr. Craven would have said that his nerves
  • had relaxed and rested themselves. Instead of lying and staring at the
  • wall and wishing he had not awakened, his mind was full of the plans he
  • and Mary had made yesterday, of pictures of the garden and of Dickon
  • and his wild creatures. It was so nice to have things to think about.
  • And he had not been awake more than ten minutes when he heard feet
  • running along the corridor and Mary was at the door. The next minute
  • she was in the room and had run across to his bed, bringing with her a
  • waft of fresh air full of the scent of the morning.
  • “You’ve been out! You’ve been out! There’s that nice smell of leaves!”
  • he cried.
  • She had been running and her hair was loose and blown and she was
  • bright with the air and pink-cheeked, though he could not see it.
  • “It’s so beautiful!” she said, a little breathless with her speed. “You
  • never saw anything so beautiful! It has _come!_ I thought it had come
  • that other morning, but it was only coming. It is here now! It has
  • come, the Spring! Dickon says so!”
  • “Has it?” cried Colin, and though he really knew nothing about it he
  • felt his heart beat. He actually sat up in bed.
  • “Open the window!” he added, laughing half with joyful excitement and
  • half at his own fancy. “Perhaps we may hear golden trumpets!”
  • And though he laughed, Mary was at the window in a moment and in a
  • moment more it was opened wide and freshness and softness and scents
  • and birds’ songs were pouring through.
  • “That’s fresh air,” she said. “Lie on your back and draw in long
  • breaths of it. That’s what Dickon does when he’s lying on the moor. He
  • says he feels it in his veins and it makes him strong and he feels as
  • if he could live forever and ever. Breathe it and breathe it.”
  • She was only repeating what Dickon had told her, but she caught Colin’s
  • fancy.
  • “’Forever and ever’! Does it make him feel like that?” he said, and he
  • did as she told him, drawing in long deep breaths over and over again
  • until he felt that something quite new and delightful was happening to
  • him.
  • Mary was at his bedside again.
  • “Things are crowding up out of the earth,” she ran on in a hurry. “And
  • there are flowers uncurling and buds on everything and the green veil
  • has covered nearly all the gray and the birds are in such a hurry about
  • their nests for fear they may be too late that some of them are even
  • fighting for places in the secret garden. And the rose-bushes look as
  • wick as wick can be, and there are primroses in the lanes and woods,
  • and the seeds we planted are up, and Dickon has brought the fox and the
  • crow and the squirrels and a new-born lamb.”
  • And then she paused for breath. The new-born lamb Dickon had found
  • three days before lying by its dead mother among the gorse bushes on
  • the moor. It was not the first motherless lamb he had found and he knew
  • what to do with it. He had taken it to the cottage wrapped in his
  • jacket and he had let it lie near the fire and had fed it with warm
  • milk. It was a soft thing with a darling silly baby face and legs
  • rather long for its body. Dickon had carried it over the moor in his
  • arms and its feeding bottle was in his pocket with a squirrel, and when
  • Mary had sat under a tree with its limp warmness huddled on her lap she
  • had felt as if she were too full of strange joy to speak. A lamb—a
  • lamb! A living lamb who lay on your lap like a baby!
  • She was describing it with great joy and Colin was listening and
  • drawing in long breaths of air when the nurse entered. She started a
  • little at the sight of the open window. She had sat stifling in the
  • room many a warm day because her patient was sure that open windows
  • gave people cold.
  • “Are you sure you are not chilly, Master Colin?” she inquired.
  • “No,” was the answer. “I am breathing long breaths of fresh air. It
  • makes you strong. I am going to get up to the sofa for breakfast. My
  • cousin will have breakfast with me.”
  • The nurse went away, concealing a smile, to give the order for two
  • breakfasts. She found the servants’ hall a more amusing place than the
  • invalid’s chamber and just now everybody wanted to hear the news from
  • upstairs. There was a great deal of joking about the unpopular young
  • recluse who, as the cook said, “had found his master, and good for
  • him.” The servants’ hall had been very tired of the tantrums, and the
  • butler, who was a man with a family, had more than once expressed his
  • opinion that the invalid would be all the better “for a good hiding.”
  • When Colin was on his sofa and the breakfast for two was put upon the
  • table he made an announcement to the nurse in his most Rajah-like
  • manner.
  • “A boy, and a fox, and a crow, and two squirrels, and a new-born lamb,
  • are coming to see me this morning. I want them brought upstairs as soon
  • as they come,” he said. “You are not to begin playing with the animals
  • in the servants’ hall and keep them there. I want them here.”
  • The nurse gave a slight gasp and tried to conceal it with a cough.
  • “Yes, sir,” she answered.
  • “I’ll tell you what you can do,” added Colin, waving his hand. “You can
  • tell Martha to bring them here. The boy is Martha’s brother. His name
  • is Dickon and he is an animal charmer.”
  • “I hope the animals won’t bite, Master Colin,” said the nurse.
  • “I told you he was a charmer,” said Colin austerely. “Charmers’ animals
  • never bite.”
  • “There are snake-charmers in India,” said Mary. “And they can put their
  • snakes’ heads in their mouths.”
  • “Goodness!” shuddered the nurse.
  • They ate their breakfast with the morning air pouring in upon them.
  • Colin’s breakfast was a very good one and Mary watched him with serious
  • interest.
  • “You will begin to get fatter just as I did,” she said. “I never wanted
  • my breakfast when I was in India and now I always want it.”
  • “I wanted mine this morning,” said Colin. “Perhaps it was the fresh
  • air. When do you think Dickon will come?”
  • He was not long in coming. In about ten minutes Mary held up her hand.
  • “Listen!” she said. “Did you hear a caw?”
  • Colin listened and heard it, the oddest sound in the world to hear
  • inside a house, a hoarse “caw-caw.”
  • “Yes,” he answered.
  • “That’s Soot,” said Mary. “Listen again. Do you hear a bleat—a tiny
  • one?”
  • “Oh, yes!” cried Colin, quite flushing.
  • “That’s the new-born lamb,” said Mary. “He’s coming.”
  • Dickon’s moorland boots were thick and clumsy and though he tried to
  • walk quietly they made a clumping sound as he walked through the long
  • corridors. Mary and Colin heard him marching—marching, until he passed
  • through the tapestry door on to the soft carpet of Colin’s own passage.
  • “If you please, sir,” announced Martha, opening the door, “if you
  • please, sir, here’s Dickon an’ his creatures.”
  • Dickon came in smiling his nicest wide smile. The new-born lamb was in
  • his arms and the little red fox trotted by his side. Nut sat on his
  • left shoulder and Soot on his right and Shell’s head and paws peeped
  • out of his coat pocket.
  • Colin slowly sat up and stared and stared—as he had stared when he
  • first saw Mary; but this was a stare of wonder and delight. The truth
  • was that in spite of all he had heard he had not in the least
  • understood what this boy would be like and that his fox and his crow
  • and his squirrels and his lamb were so near to him and his friendliness
  • that they seemed almost to be part of himself. Colin had never talked
  • to a boy in his life and he was so overwhelmed by his own pleasure and
  • curiosity that he did not even think of speaking.
  • But Dickon did not feel the least shy or awkward. He had not felt
  • embarrassed because the crow had not known his language and had only
  • stared and had not spoken to him the first time they met. Creatures
  • were always like that until they found out about you. He walked over to
  • Colin’s sofa and put the new-born lamb quietly on his lap, and
  • immediately the little creature turned to the warm velvet dressing-gown
  • and began to nuzzle and nuzzle into its folds and butt its tight-curled
  • head with soft impatience against his side. Of course no boy could have
  • helped speaking then.
  • “What is it doing?” cried Colin. “What does it want?”
  • “It wants its mother,” said Dickon, smiling more and more. “I brought
  • it to thee a bit hungry because I knowed tha’d like to see it feed.”
  • He knelt down by the sofa and took a feeding-bottle from his pocket.
  • “Come on, little ’un,” he said, turning the small woolly white head
  • with a gentle brown hand. “This is what tha’s after. Tha’ll get more
  • out o’ this than tha’ will out o’ silk velvet coats. There now,” and he
  • pushed the rubber tip of the bottle into the nuzzling mouth and the
  • lamb began to suck it with ravenous ecstasy.
  • After that there was no wondering what to say. By the time the lamb
  • fell asleep questions poured forth and Dickon answered them all. He
  • told them how he had found the lamb just as the sun was rising three
  • mornings ago. He had been standing on the moor listening to a skylark
  • and watching him swing higher and higher into the sky until he was only
  • a speck in the heights of blue.
  • “I’d almost lost him but for his song an’ I was wonderin’ how a chap
  • could hear it when it seemed as if he’d get out o’ th’ world in a
  • minute—an’ just then I heard somethin’ else far off among th’ gorse
  • bushes. It was a weak bleatin’ an’ I knowed it was a new lamb as was
  • hungry an’ I knowed it wouldn’t be hungry if it hadn’t lost its mother
  • somehow, so I set off searchin’. Eh! I did have a look for it. I went
  • in an’ out among th’ gorse bushes an’ round an’ round an’ I always
  • seemed to take th’ wrong turnin’. But at last I seed a bit o’ white by
  • a rock on top o’ th’ moor an’ I climbed up an’ found th’ little ’un
  • half dead wi’ cold an’ clemmin’.”
  • While he talked, Soot flew solemnly in and out of the open window and
  • cawed remarks about the scenery while Nut and Shell made excursions
  • into the big trees outside and ran up and down trunks and explored
  • branches. Captain curled up near Dickon, who sat on the hearth-rug from
  • preference.
  • They looked at the pictures in the gardening books and Dickon knew all
  • the flowers by their country names and knew exactly which ones were
  • already growing in the secret garden.
  • “I couldna’ say that there name,” he said, pointing to one under which
  • was written “Aquilegia,” “but us calls that a columbine, an’ that there
  • one it’s a snapdragon and they both grow wild in hedges, but these is
  • garden ones an’ they’re bigger an’ grander. There’s some big clumps o’
  • columbine in th’ garden. They’ll look like a bed o’ blue an’ white
  • butterflies flutterin’ when they’re out.”
  • “I’m going to see them,” cried Colin. “I am going to see them!”
  • “Aye, that tha’ mun,” said Mary quite seriously. “An’ tha’ munnot lose
  • no time about it.”
  • CHAPTER XX
  • “I SHALL LIVE FOREVER—AND EVER—AND EVER!”
  • But they were obliged to wait more than a week because first there came
  • some very windy days and then Colin was threatened with a cold, which
  • two things happening one after the other would no doubt have thrown him
  • into a rage but that there was so much careful and mysterious planning
  • to do and almost every day Dickon came in, if only for a few minutes,
  • to talk about what was happening on the moor and in the lanes and
  • hedges and on the borders of streams. The things he had to tell about
  • otters’ and badgers’ and water-rats’ houses, not to mention birds’
  • nests and field-mice and their burrows, were enough to make you almost
  • tremble with excitement when you heard all the intimate details from an
  • animal charmer and realized with what thrilling eagerness and anxiety
  • the whole busy underworld was working.
  • “They’re same as us,” said Dickon, “only they have to build their homes
  • every year. An’ it keeps ’em so busy they fair scuffle to get ’em
  • done.”
  • The most absorbing thing, however, was the preparations to be made
  • before Colin could be transported with sufficient secrecy to the
  • garden. No one must see the chair-carriage and Dickon and Mary after
  • they turned a certain corner of the shrubbery and entered upon the walk
  • outside the ivied walls. As each day passed, Colin had become more and
  • more fixed in his feeling that the mystery surrounding the garden was
  • one of its greatest charms. Nothing must spoil that. No one must ever
  • suspect that they had a secret. People must think that he was simply
  • going out with Mary and Dickon because he liked them and did not object
  • to their looking at him. They had long and quite delightful talks about
  • their route. They would go up this path and down that one and cross the
  • other and go round among the fountain flower-beds as if they were
  • looking at the “bedding-out plants” the head gardener, Mr. Roach, had
  • been having arranged. That would seem such a rational thing to do that
  • no one would think it at all mysterious. They would turn into the
  • shrubbery walks and lose themselves until they came to the long walls.
  • It was almost as serious and elaborately thought out as the plans of
  • march made by great generals in time of war.
  • Rumors of the new and curious things which were occurring in the
  • invalid’s apartments had of course filtered through the servants’ hall
  • into the stable yards and out among the gardeners, but notwithstanding
  • this, Mr. Roach was startled one day when he received orders from
  • Master Colin’s room to the effect that he must report himself in the
  • apartment no outsider had ever seen, as the invalid himself desired to
  • speak to him.
  • “Well, well,” he said to himself as he hurriedly changed his coat,
  • “what’s to do now? His Royal Highness that wasn’t to be looked at
  • calling up a man he’s never set eyes on.”
  • Mr. Roach was not without curiosity. He had never caught even a glimpse
  • of the boy and had heard a dozen exaggerated stories about his uncanny
  • looks and ways and his insane tempers. The thing he had heard oftenest
  • was that he might die at any moment and there had been numerous
  • fanciful descriptions of a humped back and helpless limbs, given by
  • people who had never seen him.
  • “Things are changing in this house, Mr. Roach,” said Mrs. Medlock, as
  • she led him up the back staircase to the corridor on to which opened
  • the hitherto mysterious chamber.
  • “Let’s hope they’re changing for the better, Mrs. Medlock,” he
  • answered.
  • “They couldn’t well change for the worse,” she continued; “and queer as
  • it all is there’s them as finds their duties made a lot easier to stand
  • up under. Don’t you be surprised, Mr. Roach, if you find yourself in
  • the middle of a menagerie and Martha Sowerby’s Dickon more at home than
  • you or me could ever be.”
  • There really was a sort of Magic about Dickon, as Mary always privately
  • believed. When Mr. Roach heard his name he smiled quite leniently.
  • “He’d be at home in Buckingham Palace or at the bottom of a coal mine,”
  • he said. “And yet it’s not impudence, either. He’s just fine, is that
  • lad.”
  • It was perhaps well he had been prepared or he might have been
  • startled. When the bedroom door was opened a large crow, which seemed
  • quite at home perched on the high back of a carven chair, announced the
  • entrance of a visitor by saying “Caw—Caw” quite loudly. In spite of
  • Mrs. Medlock’s warning, Mr. Roach only just escaped being sufficiently
  • undignified to jump backward.
  • The young Rajah was neither in bed nor on his sofa. He was sitting in
  • an armchair and a young lamb was standing by him shaking its tail in
  • feeding-lamb fashion as Dickon knelt giving it milk from its bottle. A
  • squirrel was perched on Dickon’s bent back attentively nibbling a nut.
  • The little girl from India was sitting on a big footstool looking on.
  • “Here is Mr. Roach, Master Colin,” said Mrs. Medlock.
  • The young Rajah turned and looked his servitor over—at least that was
  • what the head gardener felt happened.
  • “Oh, you are Roach, are you?” he said. “I sent for you to give you some
  • very important orders.”
  • “Very good, sir,” answered Roach, wondering if he was to receive
  • instructions to fell all the oaks in the park or to transform the
  • orchards into water-gardens.
  • “I am going out in my chair this afternoon,” said Colin. “If the fresh
  • air agrees with me I may go out every day. When I go, none of the
  • gardeners are to be anywhere near the Long Walk by the garden walls. No
  • one is to be there. I shall go out about two o’clock and everyone must
  • keep away until I send word that they may go back to their work.”
  • “Very good, sir,” replied Mr. Roach, much relieved to hear that the
  • oaks might remain and that the orchards were safe.
  • “Mary,” said Colin, turning to her, “what is that thing you say in
  • India when you have finished talking and want people to go?”
  • “You say, ‘You have my permission to go,’” answered Mary.
  • The Rajah waved his hand.
  • “You have my permission to go, Roach,” he said. “But, remember, this is
  • very important.”
  • “Caw—Caw!” remarked the crow hoarsely but not impolitely.
  • “Very good, sir. Thank you, sir,” said Mr. Roach, and Mrs. Medlock took
  • him out of the room.
  • Outside in the corridor, being a rather good-natured man, he smiled
  • until he almost laughed.
  • “My word!” he said, “he’s got a fine lordly way with him, hasn’t he?
  • You’d think he was a whole Royal Family rolled into one—Prince Consort
  • and all.”
  • “Eh!” protested Mrs. Medlock, “we’ve had to let him trample all over
  • everyone of us ever since he had feet and he thinks that’s what folks
  • was born for.”
  • “Perhaps he’ll grow out of it, if he lives,” suggested Mr. Roach.
  • “Well, there’s one thing pretty sure,” said Mrs. Medlock. “If he does
  • live and that Indian child stays here I’ll warrant she teaches him that
  • the whole orange does not belong to him, as Susan Sowerby says. And
  • he’ll be likely to find out the size of his own quarter.”
  • Inside the room Colin was leaning back on his cushions.
  • “It’s all safe now,” he said. “And this afternoon I shall see it—this
  • afternoon I shall be in it!”
  • Dickon went back to the garden with his creatures and Mary stayed with
  • Colin. She did not think he looked tired but he was very quiet before
  • their lunch came and he was quiet while they were eating it. She
  • wondered why and asked him about it.
  • “What big eyes you’ve got, Colin,” she said. “When you are thinking
  • they get as big as saucers. What are you thinking about now?”
  • “I can’t help thinking about what it will look like,” he answered.
  • “The garden?” asked Mary.
  • “The springtime,” he said. “I was thinking that I’ve really never seen
  • it before. I scarcely ever went out and when I did go I never looked at
  • it. I didn’t even think about it.”
  • “I never saw it in India because there wasn’t any,” said Mary.
  • Shut in and morbid as his life had been, Colin had more imagination
  • than she had and at least he had spent a good deal of time looking at
  • wonderful books and pictures.
  • “That morning when you ran in and said ‘It’s come! It’s come!’, you
  • made me feel quite queer. It sounded as if things were coming with a
  • great procession and big bursts and wafts of music. I’ve a picture like
  • it in one of my books—crowds of lovely people and children with
  • garlands and branches with blossoms on them, everyone laughing and
  • dancing and crowding and playing on pipes. That was why I said,
  • ‘Perhaps we shall hear golden trumpets’ and told you to throw open the
  • window.”
  • “How funny!” said Mary. “That’s really just what it feels like. And if
  • all the flowers and leaves and green things and birds and wild
  • creatures danced past at once, what a crowd it would be! I’m sure
  • they’d dance and sing and flute and that would be the wafts of music.”
  • They both laughed but it was not because the idea was laughable but
  • because they both so liked it.
  • A little later the nurse made Colin ready. She noticed that instead of
  • lying like a log while his clothes were put on he sat up and made some
  • efforts to help himself, and he talked and laughed with Mary all the
  • time.
  • “This is one of his good days, sir,” she said to Dr. Craven, who
  • dropped in to inspect him. “He’s in such good spirits that it makes him
  • stronger.”
  • “I’ll call in again later in the afternoon, after he has come in,” said
  • Dr. Craven. “I must see how the going out agrees with him. I wish,” in
  • a very low voice, “that he would let you go with him.”
  • “I’d rather give up the case this moment, sir, than even stay here
  • while it’s suggested,” answered the nurse. With sudden firmness.
  • “I hadn’t really decided to suggest it,” said the doctor, with his
  • slight nervousness. “We’ll try the experiment. Dickon’s a lad I’d trust
  • with a new-born child.”
  • The strongest footman in the house carried Colin downstairs and put him
  • in his wheeled chair near which Dickon waited outside. After the
  • manservant had arranged his rugs and cushions the Rajah waved his hand
  • to him and to the nurse.
  • “You have my permission to go,” he said, and they both disappeared
  • quickly and it must be confessed giggled when they were safely inside
  • the house.
  • Dickon began to push the wheeled chair slowly and steadily. Mistress
  • Mary walked beside it and Colin leaned back and lifted his face to the
  • sky. The arch of it looked very high and the small snowy clouds seemed
  • like white birds floating on outspread wings below its crystal
  • blueness. The wind swept in soft big breaths down from the moor and was
  • strange with a wild clear scented sweetness. Colin kept lifting his
  • thin chest to draw it in, and his big eyes looked as if it were they
  • which were listening—listening, instead of his ears.
  • “There are so many sounds of singing and humming and calling out,” he
  • said. “What is that scent the puffs of wind bring?”
  • “It’s gorse on th’ moor that’s openin’ out,” answered Dickon. “Eh! th’
  • bees are at it wonderful today.”
  • Not a human creature was to be caught sight of in the paths they took.
  • In fact every gardener or gardener’s lad had been witched away. But
  • they wound in and out among the shrubbery and out and round the
  • fountain beds, following their carefully planned route for the mere
  • mysterious pleasure of it. But when at last they turned into the Long
  • Walk by the ivied walls the excited sense of an approaching thrill made
  • them, for some curious reason they could not have explained, begin to
  • speak in whispers.
  • “This is it,” breathed Mary. “This is where I used to walk up and down
  • and wonder and wonder.”
  • “Is it?” cried Colin, and his eyes began to search the ivy with eager
  • curiousness. “But I can see nothing,” he whispered. “There is no door.”
  • “That’s what I thought,” said Mary.
  • Then there was a lovely breathless silence and the chair wheeled on.
  • “That is the garden where Ben Weatherstaff works,” said Mary.
  • “Is it?” said Colin.
  • A few yards more and Mary whispered again.
  • “This is where the robin flew over the wall,” she said.
  • “Is it?” cried Colin. “Oh! I wish he’d come again!”
  • “And that,” said Mary with solemn delight, pointing under a big lilac
  • bush, “is where he perched on the little heap of earth and showed me
  • the key.”
  • Then Colin sat up.
  • “Where? Where? There?” he cried, and his eyes were as big as the wolf’s
  • in Red Riding-Hood, when Red Riding-Hood felt called upon to remark on
  • them. Dickon stood still and the wheeled chair stopped.
  • “And this,” said Mary, stepping on to the bed close to the ivy, “is
  • where I went to talk to him when he chirped at me from the top of the
  • wall. And this is the ivy the wind blew back,” and she took hold of the
  • hanging green curtain.
  • “Oh! is it—is it!” gasped Colin.
  • “And here is the handle, and here is the door. Dickon push him in—push
  • him in quickly!”
  • And Dickon did it with one strong, steady, splendid push.
  • But Colin had actually dropped back against his cushions, even though
  • he gasped with delight, and he had covered his eyes with his hands and
  • held them there shutting out everything until they were inside and the
  • chair stopped as if by magic and the door was closed. Not till then did
  • he take them away and look round and round and round as Dickon and Mary
  • had done. And over walls and earth and trees and swinging sprays and
  • tendrils the fair green veil of tender little leaves had crept, and in
  • the grass under the trees and the gray urns in the alcoves and here and
  • there everywhere were touches or splashes of gold and purple and white
  • and the trees were showing pink and snow above his head and there were
  • fluttering of wings and faint sweet pipes and humming and scents and
  • scents. And the sun fell warm upon his face like a hand with a lovely
  • touch. And in wonder Mary and Dickon stood and stared at him. He looked
  • so strange and different because a pink glow of color had actually
  • crept all over him—ivory face and neck and hands and all.
  • “I shall get well! I shall get well!” he cried out. “Mary! Dickon! I
  • shall get well! And I shall live forever and ever and ever!”
  • CHAPTER XXI
  • BEN WEATHERSTAFF
  • One of the strange things about living in the world is that it is only
  • now and then one is quite sure one is going to live forever and ever
  • and ever. One knows it sometimes when one gets up at the tender solemn
  • dawn-time and goes out and stands alone and throws one’s head far back
  • and looks up and up and watches the pale sky slowly changing and
  • flushing and marvelous unknown things happening until the East almost
  • makes one cry out and one’s heart stands still at the strange
  • unchanging majesty of the rising of the sun—which has been happening
  • every morning for thousands and thousands and thousands of years. One
  • knows it then for a moment or so. And one knows it sometimes when one
  • stands by oneself in a wood at sunset and the mysterious deep gold
  • stillness slanting through and under the branches seems to be saying
  • slowly again and again something one cannot quite hear, however much
  • one tries. Then sometimes the immense quiet of the dark blue at night
  • with millions of stars waiting and watching makes one sure; and
  • sometimes a sound of far-off music makes it true; and sometimes a look
  • in someone’s eyes.
  • And it was like that with Colin when he first saw and heard and felt
  • the Springtime inside the four high walls of a hidden garden. That
  • afternoon the whole world seemed to devote itself to being perfect and
  • radiantly beautiful and kind to one boy. Perhaps out of pure heavenly
  • goodness the spring came and crowned everything it possibly could into
  • that one place. More than once Dickon paused in what he was doing and
  • stood still with a sort of growing wonder in his eyes, shaking his head
  • softly.
  • “Eh! it is graidely,” he said. “I’m twelve goin’ on thirteen an’
  • there’s a lot o’ afternoons in thirteen years, but seems to me like I
  • never seed one as graidely as this ’ere.”
  • “Aye, it is a graidely one,” said Mary, and she sighed for mere joy.
  • “I’ll warrant it’s the graidelest one as ever was in this world.”
  • “Does tha’ think,” said Colin with dreamy carefulness, “as happen it
  • was made loike this ’ere all o’ purpose for me?”
  • “My word!” cried Mary admiringly, “that there is a bit o’ good
  • Yorkshire. Tha’rt shapin’ first-rate—that tha’ art.”
  • And delight reigned.
  • They drew the chair under the plum-tree, which was snow-white with
  • blossoms and musical with bees. It was like a king’s canopy, a fairy
  • king’s. There were flowering cherry-trees near and apple-trees whose
  • buds were pink and white, and here and there one had burst open wide.
  • Between the blossoming branches of the canopy bits of blue sky looked
  • down like wonderful eyes.
  • Mary and Dickon worked a little here and there and Colin watched them.
  • They brought him things to look at—buds which were opening, buds which
  • were tight closed, bits of twig whose leaves were just showing green,
  • the feather of a woodpecker which had dropped on the grass, the empty
  • shell of some bird early hatched. Dickon pushed the chair slowly round
  • and round the garden, stopping every other moment to let him look at
  • wonders springing out of the earth or trailing down from trees. It was
  • like being taken in state round the country of a magic king and queen
  • and shown all the mysterious riches it contained.
  • “I wonder if we shall see the robin?” said Colin.
  • “Tha’ll see him often enow after a bit,” answered Dickon. “When th’
  • eggs hatches out th’ little chap he’ll be kep’ so busy it’ll make his
  • head swim. Tha’ll see him flyin’ backward an’ for’ard carryin’ worms
  • nigh as big as himsel’ an’ that much noise goin’ on in th’ nest when he
  • gets there as fair flusters him so as he scarce knows which big mouth
  • to drop th’ first piece in. An’ gapin’ beaks an’ squawks on every side.
  • Mother says as when she sees th’ work a robin has to keep them gapin’
  • beaks filled, she feels like she was a lady with nothin’ to do. She
  • says she’s seen th’ little chaps when it seemed like th’ sweat must be
  • droppin’ off ’em, though folk can’t see it.”
  • This made them giggle so delightedly that they were obliged to cover
  • their mouths with their hands, remembering that they must not be heard.
  • Colin had been instructed as to the law of whispers and low voices
  • several days before. He liked the mysteriousness of it and did his
  • best, but in the midst of excited enjoyment it is rather difficult
  • never to laugh above a whisper.
  • Every moment of the afternoon was full of new things and every hour the
  • sunshine grew more golden. The wheeled chair had been drawn back under
  • the canopy and Dickon had sat down on the grass and had just drawn out
  • his pipe when Colin saw something he had not had time to notice before.
  • “That’s a very old tree over there, isn’t it?” he said.
  • Dickon looked across the grass at the tree and Mary looked and there
  • was a brief moment of stillness.
  • “Yes,” answered Dickon, after it, and his low voice had a very gentle
  • sound.
  • Mary gazed at the tree and thought.
  • “The branches are quite gray and there’s not a single leaf anywhere,”
  • Colin went on. “It’s quite dead, isn’t it?”
  • “Aye,” admitted Dickon. “But them roses as has climbed all over it will
  • near hide every bit o’ th’ dead wood when they’re full o’ leaves an’
  • flowers. It won’t look dead then. It’ll be th’ prettiest of all.”
  • Mary still gazed at the tree and thought.
  • “It looks as if a big branch had been broken off,” said Colin. “I
  • wonder how it was done.”
  • “It’s been done many a year,” answered Dickon. “Eh!” with a sudden
  • relieved start and laying his hand on Colin. “Look at that robin! There
  • he is! He’s been foragin’ for his mate.”
  • Colin was almost too late but he just caught sight of him, the flash of
  • red-breasted bird with something in his beak. He darted through the
  • greenness and into the close-grown corner and was out of sight. Colin
  • leaned back on his cushion again, laughing a little.
  • “He’s taking her tea to her. Perhaps it’s five o’clock. I think I’d
  • like some tea myself.”
  • And so they were safe.
  • “It was Magic which sent the robin,” said Mary secretly to Dickon
  • afterward. “I know it was Magic.” For both she and Dickon had been
  • afraid Colin might ask something about the tree whose branch had broken
  • off ten years ago and they had talked it over together and Dickon had
  • stood and rubbed his head in a troubled way.
  • “We mun look as if it wasn’t no different from th’ other trees,” he had
  • said. “We couldn’t never tell him how it broke, poor lad. If he says
  • anything about it we mun—we mun try to look cheerful.”
  • “Aye, that we mun,” had answered Mary.
  • But she had not felt as if she looked cheerful when she gazed at the
  • tree. She wondered and wondered in those few moments if there was any
  • reality in that other thing Dickon had said. He had gone on rubbing his
  • rust-red hair in a puzzled way, but a nice comforted look had begun to
  • grow in his blue eyes.
  • “Mrs. Craven was a very lovely young lady,” he had gone on rather
  • hesitatingly. “An’ mother she thinks maybe she’s about Misselthwaite
  • many a time lookin’ after Mester Colin, same as all mothers do when
  • they’re took out o’ th’ world. They have to come back, tha’ sees.
  • Happen she’s been in the garden an’ happen it was her set us to work,
  • an’ told us to bring him here.”
  • Mary had thought he meant something about Magic. She was a great
  • believer in Magic. Secretly she quite believed that Dickon worked
  • Magic, of course good Magic, on everything near him and that was why
  • people liked him so much and wild creatures knew he was their friend.
  • She wondered, indeed, if it were not possible that his gift had brought
  • the robin just at the right moment when Colin asked that dangerous
  • question. She felt that his Magic was working all the afternoon and
  • making Colin look like an entirely different boy. It did not seem
  • possible that he could be the crazy creature who had screamed and
  • beaten and bitten his pillow. Even his ivory whiteness seemed to
  • change. The faint glow of color which had shown on his face and neck
  • and hands when he first got inside the garden really never quite died
  • away. He looked as if he were made of flesh instead of ivory or wax.
  • They saw the robin carry food to his mate two or three times, and it
  • was so suggestive of afternoon tea that Colin felt they must have some.
  • “Go and make one of the men servants bring some in a basket to the
  • rhododendron walk,” he said. “And then you and Dickon can bring it
  • here.”
  • It was an agreeable idea, easily carried out, and when the white cloth
  • was spread upon the grass, with hot tea and buttered toast and
  • crumpets, a delightfully hungry meal was eaten, and several birds on
  • domestic errands paused to inquire what was going on and were led into
  • investigating crumbs with great activity. Nut and Shell whisked up
  • trees with pieces of cake and Soot took the entire half of a buttered
  • crumpet into a corner and pecked at and examined and turned it over and
  • made hoarse remarks about it until he decided to swallow it all
  • joyfully in one gulp.
  • The afternoon was dragging towards its mellow hour. The sun was
  • deepening the gold of its lances, the bees were going home and the
  • birds were flying past less often. Dickon and Mary were sitting on the
  • grass, the tea-basket was repacked ready to be taken back to the house,
  • and Colin was lying against his cushions with his heavy locks pushed
  • back from his forehead and his face looking quite a natural color.
  • “I don’t want this afternoon to go,” he said; “but I shall come back
  • tomorrow, and the day after, and the day after, and the day after.”
  • “You’ll get plenty of fresh air, won’t you?” said Mary.
  • “I’m going to get nothing else,” he answered. “I’ve seen the spring now
  • and I’m going to see the summer. I’m going to see everything grow here.
  • I’m going to grow here myself.”
  • “That tha’ will,” said Dickon. “Us’ll have thee walkin’ about here an’
  • diggin’ same as other folk afore long.”
  • Colin flushed tremendously.
  • “Walk!” he said. “Dig! Shall I?”
  • Dickon’s glance at him was delicately cautious. Neither he nor Mary had
  • ever asked if anything was the matter with his legs.
  • “For sure tha’ will,” he said stoutly. “Tha—tha’s got legs o’ thine
  • own, same as other folks!”
  • Mary was rather frightened until she heard Colin’s answer.
  • “Nothing really ails them,” he said, “but they are so thin and weak.
  • They shake so that I’m afraid to try to stand on them.”
  • Both Mary and Dickon drew a relieved breath.
  • “When tha’ stops bein’ afraid tha’lt stand on ’em,” Dickon said with
  • renewed cheer. “An’ tha’lt stop bein’ afraid in a bit.”
  • “I shall?” said Colin, and he lay still as if he were wondering about
  • things.
  • They were really very quiet for a little while. The sun was dropping
  • lower. It was that hour when everything stills itself, and they really
  • had had a busy and exciting afternoon. Colin looked as if he were
  • resting luxuriously. Even the creatures had ceased moving about and had
  • drawn together and were resting near them. Soot had perched on a low
  • branch and drawn up one leg and dropped the gray film drowsily over his
  • eyes. Mary privately thought he looked as if he might snore in a
  • minute.
  • In the midst of this stillness it was rather startling when Colin half
  • lifted his head and exclaimed in a loud suddenly alarmed whisper:
  • “Who is that man?”
  • Dickon and Mary scrambled to their feet.
  • “Man!” they both cried in low quick voices.
  • Colin pointed to the high wall.
  • “Look!” he whispered excitedly. “Just look!”
  • Mary and Dickon wheeled about and looked. There was Ben Weatherstaff’s
  • indignant face glaring at them over the wall from the top of a ladder!
  • He actually shook his fist at Mary.
  • “If I wasn’t a bachelder, an’ tha’ was a wench o’ mine,” he cried, “I’d
  • give thee a hidin’!”
  • He mounted another step threateningly as if it were his energetic
  • intention to jump down and deal with her; but as she came toward him he
  • evidently thought better of it and stood on the top step of his ladder
  • shaking his fist down at her.
  • “I never thowt much o’ thee!” he harangued. “I couldna’ abide thee th’
  • first time I set eyes on thee. A scrawny buttermilk-faced young besom,
  • allus askin’ questions an’ pokin’ tha’ nose where it wasna, wanted. I
  • never knowed how tha’ got so thick wi’ me. If it hadna’ been for th’
  • robin— Drat him—”
  • “Ben Weatherstaff,” called out Mary, finding her breath. She stood
  • below him and called up to him with a sort of gasp. “Ben Weatherstaff,
  • it was the robin who showed me the way!”
  • Then it did seem as if Ben really would scramble down on her side of
  • the wall, he was so outraged.
  • “Tha’ young bad ’un!” he called down at her. “Layin’ tha’ badness on a
  • robin—not but what he’s impidint enow for anythin’. Him showin’ thee
  • th’ way! Him! Eh! tha’ young nowt”—she could see his next words burst
  • out because he was overpowered by curiosity—“however i’ this world did
  • tha’ get in?”
  • “It was the robin who showed me the way,” she protested obstinately.
  • “He didn’t know he was doing it but he did. And I can’t tell you from
  • here while you’re shaking your fist at me.”
  • He stopped shaking his fist very suddenly at that very moment and his
  • jaw actually dropped as he stared over her head at something he saw
  • coming over the grass toward him.
  • At the first sound of his torrent of words Colin had been so surprised
  • that he had only sat up and listened as if he were spellbound. But in
  • the midst of it he had recovered himself and beckoned imperiously to
  • Dickon.
  • “Wheel me over there!” he commanded. “Wheel me quite close and stop
  • right in front of him!”
  • And this, if you please, this is what Ben Weatherstaff beheld and which
  • made his jaw drop. A wheeled chair with luxurious cushions and robes
  • which came toward him looking rather like some sort of State Coach
  • because a young Rajah leaned back in it with royal command in his great
  • black-rimmed eyes and a thin white hand extended haughtily toward him.
  • And it stopped right under Ben Weatherstaff’s nose. It was really no
  • wonder his mouth dropped open.
  • “Do you know who I am?” demanded the Rajah.
  • How Ben Weatherstaff stared! His red old eyes fixed themselves on what
  • was before him as if he were seeing a ghost. He gazed and gazed and
  • gulped a lump down his throat and did not say a word.
  • “Do you know who I am?” demanded Colin still more imperiously.
  • “Answer!”
  • Ben Weatherstaff put his gnarled hand up and passed it over his eyes
  • and over his forehead and then he did answer in a queer shaky voice.
  • “Who tha’ art?” he said. “Aye, that I do—wi’ tha’ mother’s eyes starin’
  • at me out o’ tha’ face. Lord knows how tha’ come here. But tha’rt th’
  • poor cripple.”
  • Colin forgot that he had ever had a back. His face flushed scarlet and
  • he sat bolt upright.
  • “I’m not a cripple!” he cried out furiously. “I’m not!”
  • “He’s not!” cried Mary, almost shouting up the wall in her fierce
  • indignation. “He’s not got a lump as big as a pin! I looked and there
  • was none there—not one!”
  • Ben Weatherstaff passed his hand over his forehead again and gazed as
  • if he could never gaze enough. His hand shook and his mouth shook and
  • his voice shook. He was an ignorant old man and a tactless old man and
  • he could only remember the things he had heard.
  • “Tha’—tha’ hasn’t got a crooked back?” he said hoarsely.
  • “No!” shouted Colin.
  • “Tha’—tha’ hasn’t got crooked legs?” quavered Ben more hoarsely yet.
  • It was too much. The strength which Colin usually threw into his
  • tantrums rushed through him now in a new way. Never yet had he been
  • accused of crooked legs—even in whispers—and the perfectly simple
  • belief in their existence which was revealed by Ben Weatherstaff’s
  • voice was more than Rajah flesh and blood could endure. His anger and
  • insulted pride made him forget everything but this one moment and
  • filled him with a power he had never known before, an almost unnatural
  • strength.
  • “Come here!” he shouted to Dickon, and he actually began to tear the
  • coverings off his lower limbs and disentangle himself. “Come here! Come
  • here! This minute!”
  • Dickon was by his side in a second. Mary caught her breath in a short
  • gasp and felt herself turn pale.
  • “He can do it! He can do it! He can do it! He can!” she gabbled over to
  • herself under her breath as fast as ever she could.
  • There was a brief fierce scramble, the rugs were tossed on the ground,
  • Dickon held Colin’s arm, the thin legs were out, the thin feet were on
  • the grass. Colin was standing upright—upright—as straight as an arrow
  • and looking strangely tall—his head thrown back and his strange eyes
  • flashing lightning.
  • “Look at me!” he flung up at Ben Weatherstaff. “Just look at me—you!
  • Just look at me!”
  • “He’s as straight as I am!” cried Dickon. “He’s as straight as any lad
  • i’ Yorkshire!”
  • What Ben Weatherstaff did Mary thought queer beyond measure. He choked
  • and gulped and suddenly tears ran down his weather-wrinkled cheeks as
  • he struck his old hands together.
  • “Eh!” he burst forth, “th’ lies folk tells! Tha’rt as thin as a lath
  • an’ as white as a wraith, but there’s not a knob on thee. Tha’lt make a
  • mon yet. God bless thee!”
  • Dickon held Colin’s arm strongly but the boy had not begun to falter.
  • He stood straighter and straighter and looked Ben Weatherstaff in the
  • face.
  • “I’m your master,” he said, “when my father is away. And you are to
  • obey me. This is my garden. Don’t dare to say a word about it! You get
  • down from that ladder and go out to the Long Walk and Miss Mary will
  • meet you and bring you here. I want to talk to you. We did not want
  • you, but now you will have to be in the secret. Be quick!”
  • Ben Weatherstaff’s crabbed old face was still wet with that one queer
  • rush of tears. It seemed as if he could not take his eyes from thin
  • straight Colin standing on his feet with his head thrown back.
  • “Eh! lad,” he almost whispered. “Eh! my lad!” And then remembering
  • himself he suddenly touched his hat gardener fashion and said, “Yes,
  • sir! Yes, sir!” and obediently disappeared as he descended the ladder.
  • CHAPTER XXII
  • WHEN THE SUN WENT DOWN
  • When his head was out of sight Colin turned to Mary.
  • “Go and meet him,” he said; and Mary flew across the grass to the door
  • under the ivy.
  • Dickon was watching him with sharp eyes. There were scarlet spots on
  • his cheeks and he looked amazing, but he showed no signs of falling.
  • “I can stand,” he said, and his head was still held up and he said it
  • quite grandly.
  • “I told thee tha’ could as soon as tha’ stopped bein’ afraid,” answered
  • Dickon. “An’ tha’s stopped.”
  • “Yes, I’ve stopped,” said Colin.
  • Then suddenly he remembered something Mary had said.
  • “Are you making Magic?” he asked sharply.
  • Dickon’s curly mouth spread in a cheerful grin.
  • “Tha’s doin’ Magic thysel’,” he said. “It’s same Magic as made these
  • ’ere work out o’ th’ earth,” and he touched with his thick boot a clump
  • of crocuses in the grass.
  • Colin looked down at them.
  • “Aye,” he said slowly, “there couldna’ be bigger Magic than that
  • there—there couldna’ be.”
  • He drew himself up straighter than ever.
  • “I’m going to walk to that tree,” he said, pointing to one a few feet
  • away from him. “I’m going to be standing when Weatherstaff comes here.
  • I can rest against the tree if I like. When I want to sit down I will
  • sit down, but not before. Bring a rug from the chair.”
  • He walked to the tree and though Dickon held his arm he was wonderfully
  • steady. When he stood against the tree trunk it was not too plain that
  • he supported himself against it, and he still held himself so straight
  • that he looked tall.
  • When Ben Weatherstaff came through the door in the wall he saw him
  • standing there and he heard Mary muttering something under her breath.
  • “What art sayin’?” he asked rather testily because he did not want his
  • attention distracted from the long thin straight boy figure and proud
  • face.
  • But she did not tell him. What she was saying was this:
  • “You can do it! You can do it! I told you you could! You can do it! You
  • can do it! You _can!_”
  • She was saying it to Colin because she wanted to make Magic and keep
  • him on his feet looking like that. She could not bear that he should
  • give in before Ben Weatherstaff. He did not give in. She was uplifted
  • by a sudden feeling that he looked quite beautiful in spite of his
  • thinness. He fixed his eyes on Ben Weatherstaff in his funny imperious
  • way.
  • “Look at me!” he commanded. “Look at me all over! Am I a hunchback?
  • Have I got crooked legs?”
  • Ben Weatherstaff had not quite got over his emotion, but he had
  • recovered a little and answered almost in his usual way.
  • “Not tha’,” he said. “Nowt o’ th’ sort. What’s tha’ been doin’ with
  • thysel’—hidin’ out o’ sight an’ lettin’ folk think tha’ was cripple an’
  • half-witted?”
  • “Half-witted!” said Colin angrily. “Who thought that?”
  • “Lots o’ fools,” said Ben. “Th’ world’s full o’ jackasses brayin’ an’
  • they never bray nowt but lies. What did tha’ shut thysel’ up for?”
  • “Everyone thought I was going to die,” said Colin shortly. “I’m not!”
  • And he said it with such decision Ben Weatherstaff looked him over, up
  • and down, down and up.
  • “Tha’ die!” he said with dry exultation. “Nowt o’ th’ sort! Tha’s got
  • too much pluck in thee. When I seed thee put tha’ legs on th’ ground in
  • such a hurry I knowed tha’ was all right. Sit thee down on th’ rug a
  • bit young Mester an’ give me thy orders.”
  • There was a queer mixture of crabbed tenderness and shrewd
  • understanding in his manner. Mary had poured out speech as rapidly as
  • she could as they had come down the Long Walk. The chief thing to be
  • remembered, she had told him, was that Colin was getting well—getting
  • well. The garden was doing it. No one must let him remember about
  • having humps and dying.
  • The Rajah condescended to seat himself on a rug under the tree.
  • “What work do you do in the gardens, Weatherstaff?” he inquired.
  • “Anythin’ I’m told to do,” answered old Ben. “I’m kep’ on by
  • favor—because she liked me.”
  • “She?” said Colin.
  • “Tha’ mother,” answered Ben Weatherstaff.
  • “My mother?” said Colin, and he looked about him quietly. “This was her
  • garden, wasn’t it?”
  • “Aye, it was that!” and Ben Weatherstaff looked about him too. “She
  • were main fond of it.”
  • “It is my garden now. I am fond of it. I shall come here every day,”
  • announced Colin. “But it is to be a secret. My orders are that no one
  • is to know that we come here. Dickon and my cousin have worked and made
  • it come alive. I shall send for you sometimes to help—but you must come
  • when no one can see you.”
  • Ben Weatherstaff’s face twisted itself in a dry old smile.
  • “I’ve come here before when no one saw me,” he said.
  • “What!” exclaimed Colin. “When?”
  • “Th’ last time I was here,” rubbing his chin and looking round, “was
  • about two year’ ago.”
  • “But no one has been in it for ten years!” cried Colin.
  • “There was no door!”
  • “I’m no one,” said old Ben dryly. “An’ I didn’t come through th’ door.
  • I come over th’ wall. Th’ rheumatics held me back th’ last two year’.”
  • “Tha’ come an’ did a bit o’ prunin’!” cried Dickon. “I couldn’t make
  • out how it had been done.”
  • “She was so fond of it—she was!” said Ben Weatherstaff slowly. “An’ she
  • was such a pretty young thing. She says to me once, ‘Ben,’ says she
  • laughin’, ‘if ever I’m ill or if I go away you must take care of my
  • roses.’ When she did go away th’ orders was no one was ever to come
  • nigh. But I come,” with grumpy obstinacy. “Over th’ wall I come—until
  • th’ rheumatics stopped me—an’ I did a bit o’ work once a year. She’d
  • gave her order first.”
  • “It wouldn’t have been as wick as it is if tha’ hadn’t done it,” said
  • Dickon. “I did wonder.”
  • “I’m glad you did it, Weatherstaff,” said Colin. “You’ll know how to
  • keep the secret.”
  • “Aye, I’ll know, sir,” answered Ben. “An’ it’ll be easier for a man wi’
  • rheumatics to come in at th’ door.”
  • On the grass near the tree Mary had dropped her trowel. Colin stretched
  • out his hand and took it up. An odd expression came into his face and
  • he began to scratch at the earth. His thin hand was weak enough but
  • presently as they watched him—Mary with quite breathless interest—he
  • drove the end of the trowel into the soil and turned some over.
  • “You can do it! You can do it!” said Mary to herself. “I tell you, you
  • can!”
  • Dickon’s round eyes were full of eager curiousness but he said not a
  • word. Ben Weatherstaff looked on with interested face.
  • Colin persevered. After he had turned a few trowelfuls of soil he spoke
  • exultantly to Dickon in his best Yorkshire.
  • “Tha’ said as tha’d have me walkin’ about here same as other folk—an’
  • tha’ said tha’d have me diggin’. I thowt tha’ was just leein’ to please
  • me. This is only th’ first day an’ I’ve walked—an’ here I am diggin’.”
  • Ben Weatherstaff’s mouth fell open again when he heard him, but he
  • ended by chuckling.
  • “Eh!” he said, “that sounds as if tha’d got wits enow. Tha’rt a
  • Yorkshire lad for sure. An’ tha’rt diggin’, too. How’d tha’ like to
  • plant a bit o’ somethin’? I can get thee a rose in a pot.”
  • “Go and get it!” said Colin, digging excitedly. “Quick! Quick!”
  • It was done quickly enough indeed. Ben Weatherstaff went his way
  • forgetting rheumatics. Dickon took his spade and dug the hole deeper
  • and wider than a new digger with thin white hands could make it. Mary
  • slipped out to run and bring back a watering-can. When Dickon had
  • deepened the hole Colin went on turning the soft earth over and over.
  • He looked up at the sky, flushed and glowing with the strangely new
  • exercise, slight as it was.
  • “I want to do it before the sun goes quite—quite down,” he said.
  • Mary thought that perhaps the sun held back a few minutes just on
  • purpose. Ben Weatherstaff brought the rose in its pot from the
  • greenhouse. He hobbled over the grass as fast as he could. He had begun
  • to be excited, too. He knelt down by the hole and broke the pot from
  • the mould.
  • “Here, lad,” he said, handing the plant to Colin. “Set it in the earth
  • thysel’ same as th’ king does when he goes to a new place.”
  • The thin white hands shook a little and Colin’s flush grew deeper as he
  • set the rose in the mould and held it while old Ben made firm the
  • earth. It was filled in and pressed down and made steady. Mary was
  • leaning forward on her hands and knees. Soot had flown down and marched
  • forward to see what was being done. Nut and Shell chattered about it
  • from a cherry-tree.
  • “It’s planted!” said Colin at last. “And the sun is only slipping over
  • the edge. Help me up, Dickon. I want to be standing when it goes.
  • That’s part of the Magic.”
  • And Dickon helped him, and the Magic—or whatever it was—so gave him
  • strength that when the sun did slip over the edge and end the strange
  • lovely afternoon for them there he actually stood on his two
  • feet—laughing.
  • CHAPTER XXIII
  • MAGIC
  • Dr. Craven had been waiting some time at the house when they returned
  • to it. He had indeed begun to wonder if it might not be wise to send
  • someone out to explore the garden paths. When Colin was brought back to
  • his room the poor man looked him over seriously.
  • “You should not have stayed so long,” he said. “You must not overexert
  • yourself.”
  • “I am not tired at all,” said Colin. “It has made me well. Tomorrow I
  • am going out in the morning as well as in the afternoon.”
  • “I am not sure that I can allow it,” answered Dr. Craven. “I am afraid
  • it would not be wise.”
  • “It would not be wise to try to stop me,” said Colin quite seriously.
  • “I am going.”
  • Even Mary had found out that one of Colin’s chief peculiarities was
  • that he did not know in the least what a rude little brute he was with
  • his way of ordering people about. He had lived on a sort of desert
  • island all his life and as he had been the king of it he had made his
  • own manners and had had no one to compare himself with. Mary had indeed
  • been rather like him herself and since she had been at Misselthwaite
  • had gradually discovered that her own manners had not been of the kind
  • which is usual or popular. Having made this discovery she naturally
  • thought it of enough interest to communicate to Colin. So she sat and
  • looked at him curiously for a few minutes after Dr. Craven had gone.
  • She wanted to make him ask her why she was doing it and of course she
  • did.
  • “What are you looking at me for?” he said.
  • “I’m thinking that I am rather sorry for Dr. Craven.”
  • “So am I,” said Colin calmly, but not without an air of some
  • satisfaction. “He won’t get Misselthwaite at all now I’m not going to
  • die.”
  • “I’m sorry for him because of that, of course,” said Mary, “but I was
  • thinking just then that it must have been very horrid to have had to be
  • polite for ten years to a boy who was always rude. I would never have
  • done it.”
  • “Am I rude?” Colin inquired undisturbedly.
  • “If you had been his own boy and he had been a slapping sort of man,”
  • said Mary, “he would have slapped you.”
  • “But he daren’t,” said Colin.
  • “No, he daren’t,” answered Mistress Mary, thinking the thing out quite
  • without prejudice. “Nobody ever dared to do anything you didn’t
  • like—because you were going to die and things like that. You were such
  • a poor thing.”
  • “But,” announced Colin stubbornly, “I am not going to be a poor thing.
  • I won’t let people think I’m one. I stood on my feet this afternoon.”
  • “It is always having your own way that has made you so queer,” Mary
  • went on, thinking aloud.
  • Colin turned his head, frowning.
  • “Am I queer?” he demanded.
  • “Yes,” answered Mary, “very. But you needn’t be cross,” she added
  • impartially, “because so am I queer—and so is Ben Weatherstaff. But I
  • am not as queer as I was before I began to like people and before I
  • found the garden.”
  • “I don’t want to be queer,” said Colin. “I am not going to be,” and he
  • frowned again with determination.
  • He was a very proud boy. He lay thinking for a while and then Mary saw
  • his beautiful smile begin and gradually change his whole face.
  • “I shall stop being queer,” he said, “if I go every day to the garden.
  • There is Magic in there—good Magic, you know, Mary. I am sure there
  • is.”
  • “So am I,” said Mary.
  • “Even if it isn’t real Magic,” Colin said, “we can pretend it is.
  • _Something_ is there—_something!_”
  • “It’s Magic,” said Mary, “but not black. It’s as white as snow.”
  • They always called it Magic and indeed it seemed like it in the months
  • that followed—the wonderful months—the radiant months—the amazing ones.
  • Oh! the things which happened in that garden! If you have never had a
  • garden you cannot understand, and if you have had a garden you will
  • know that it would take a whole book to describe all that came to pass
  • there. At first it seemed that green things would never cease pushing
  • their way through the earth, in the grass, in the beds, even in the
  • crevices of the walls. Then the green things began to show buds and the
  • buds began to unfurl and show color, every shade of blue, every shade
  • of purple, every tint and hue of crimson. In its happy days flowers had
  • been tucked away into every inch and hole and corner. Ben Weatherstaff
  • had seen it done and had himself scraped out mortar from between the
  • bricks of the wall and made pockets of earth for lovely clinging things
  • to grow on. Iris and white lilies rose out of the grass in sheaves, and
  • the green alcoves filled themselves with amazing armies of the blue and
  • white flower lances of tall delphiniums or columbines or campanulas.
  • “She was main fond o’ them—she was,” Ben Weatherstaff said. “She liked
  • them things as was allus pointin’ up to th’ blue sky, she used to tell.
  • Not as she was one o’ them as looked down on th’ earth—not her. She
  • just loved it but she said as th’ blue sky allus looked so joyful.”
  • The seeds Dickon and Mary had planted grew as if fairies had tended
  • them. Satiny poppies of all tints danced in the breeze by the score,
  • gaily defying flowers which had lived in the garden for years and which
  • it might be confessed seemed rather to wonder how such new people had
  • got there. And the roses—the roses! Rising out of the grass, tangled
  • round the sun-dial, wreathing the tree trunks and hanging from their
  • branches, climbing up the walls and spreading over them with long
  • garlands falling in cascades—they came alive day by day, hour by hour.
  • Fair fresh leaves, and buds—and buds—tiny at first but swelling and
  • working Magic until they burst and uncurled into cups of scent
  • delicately spilling themselves over their brims and filling the garden
  • air.
  • Colin saw it all, watching each change as it took place. Every morning
  • he was brought out and every hour of each day when it didn’t rain he
  • spent in the garden. Even gray days pleased him. He would lie on the
  • grass “watching things growing,” he said. If you watched long enough,
  • he declared, you could see buds unsheath themselves. Also you could
  • make the acquaintance of strange busy insect things running about on
  • various unknown but evidently serious errands, sometimes carrying tiny
  • scraps of straw or feather or food, or climbing blades of grass as if
  • they were trees from whose tops one could look out to explore the
  • country. A mole throwing up its mound at the end of its burrow and
  • making its way out at last with the long-nailed paws which looked so
  • like elfish hands, had absorbed him one whole morning. Ants’ ways,
  • beetles’ ways, bees’ ways, frogs’ ways, birds’ ways, plants’ ways, gave
  • him a new world to explore and when Dickon revealed them all and added
  • foxes’ ways, otters’ ways, ferrets’ ways, squirrels’ ways, and trout’
  • and water-rats’ and badgers’ ways, there was no end to the things to
  • talk about and think over.
  • And this was not the half of the Magic. The fact that he had really
  • once stood on his feet had set Colin thinking tremendously and when
  • Mary told him of the spell she had worked he was excited and approved
  • of it greatly. He talked of it constantly.
  • “Of course there must be lots of Magic in the world,” he said wisely
  • one day, “but people don’t know what it is like or how to make it.
  • Perhaps the beginning is just to say nice things are going to happen
  • until you make them happen. I am going to try and experiment.”
  • The next morning when they went to the secret garden he sent at once
  • for Ben Weatherstaff. Ben came as quickly as he could and found the
  • Rajah standing on his feet under a tree and looking very grand but also
  • very beautifully smiling.
  • “Good morning, Ben Weatherstaff,” he said. “I want you and Dickon and
  • Miss Mary to stand in a row and listen to me because I am going to tell
  • you something very important.”
  • “Aye, aye, sir!” answered Ben Weatherstaff, touching his forehead. (One
  • of the long concealed charms of Ben Weatherstaff was that in his
  • boyhood he had once run away to sea and had made voyages. So he could
  • reply like a sailor.)
  • “I am going to try a scientific experiment,” explained the Rajah. “When
  • I grow up I am going to make great scientific discoveries and I am
  • going to begin now with this experiment.”
  • “Aye, aye, sir!” said Ben Weatherstaff promptly, though this was the
  • first time he had heard of great scientific discoveries.
  • It was the first time Mary had heard of them, either, but even at this
  • stage she had begun to realize that, queer as he was, Colin had read
  • about a great many singular things and was somehow a very convincing
  • sort of boy. When he held up his head and fixed his strange eyes on you
  • it seemed as if you believed him almost in spite of yourself though he
  • was only ten years old—going on eleven. At this moment he was
  • especially convincing because he suddenly felt the fascination of
  • actually making a sort of speech like a grown-up person.
  • “The great scientific discoveries I am going to make,” he went on,
  • “will be about Magic. Magic is a great thing and scarcely anyone knows
  • anything about it except a few people in old books—and Mary a little,
  • because she was born in India where there are fakirs. I believe Dickon
  • knows some Magic, but perhaps he doesn’t know he knows it. He charms
  • animals and people. I would never have let him come to see me if he had
  • not been an animal charmer—which is a boy charmer, too, because a boy
  • is an animal. I am sure there is Magic in everything, only we have not
  • sense enough to get hold of it and make it do things for us—like
  • electricity and horses and steam.”
  • This sounded so imposing that Ben Weatherstaff became quite excited and
  • really could not keep still.
  • “Aye, aye, sir,” he said and he began to stand up quite straight.
  • “When Mary found this garden it looked quite dead,” the orator
  • proceeded. “Then something began pushing things up out of the soil and
  • making things out of nothing. One day things weren’t there and another
  • they were. I had never watched things before and it made me feel very
  • curious. Scientific people are always curious and I am going to be
  • scientific. I keep saying to myself, ‘What is it? What is it?’ It’s
  • something. It can’t be nothing! I don’t know its name so I call it
  • Magic. I have never seen the sun rise but Mary and Dickon have and from
  • what they tell me I am sure that is Magic too. Something pushes it up
  • and draws it. Sometimes since I’ve been in the garden I’ve looked up
  • through the trees at the sky and I have had a strange feeling of being
  • happy as if something were pushing and drawing in my chest and making
  • me breathe fast. Magic is always pushing and drawing and making things
  • out of nothing. Everything is made out of Magic, leaves and trees,
  • flowers and birds, badgers and foxes and squirrels and people. So it
  • must be all around us. In this garden—in all the places. The Magic in
  • this garden has made me stand up and know I am going to live to be a
  • man. I am going to make the scientific experiment of trying to get some
  • and put it in myself and make it push and draw me and make me strong. I
  • don’t know how to do it but I think that if you keep thinking about it
  • and calling it perhaps it will come. Perhaps that is the first baby way
  • to get it. When I was going to try to stand that first time Mary kept
  • saying to herself as fast as she could, ‘You can do it! You can do it!’
  • and I did. I had to try myself at the same time, of course, but her
  • Magic helped me—and so did Dickon’s. Every morning and evening and as
  • often in the daytime as I can remember I am going to say, ‘Magic is in
  • me! Magic is making me well! I am going to be as strong as Dickon, as
  • strong as Dickon!’ And you must all do it, too. That is my experiment
  • Will you help, Ben Weatherstaff?”
  • “Aye, aye, sir!” said Ben Weatherstaff. “Aye, aye!”
  • “If you keep doing it every day as regularly as soldiers go through
  • drill we shall see what will happen and find out if the experiment
  • succeeds. You learn things by saying them over and over and thinking
  • about them until they stay in your mind forever and I think it will be
  • the same with Magic. If you keep calling it to come to you and help you
  • it will get to be part of you and it will stay and do things.”
  • “I once heard an officer in India tell my mother that there were fakirs
  • who said words over and over thousands of times,” said Mary.
  • “I’ve heard Jem Fettleworth’s wife say th’ same thing over thousands o’
  • times—callin’ Jem a drunken brute,” said Ben Weatherstaff dryly.
  • “Summat allus come o’ that, sure enough. He gave her a good hidin’ an’
  • went to th’ Blue Lion an’ got as drunk as a lord.”
  • Colin drew his brows together and thought a few minutes. Then he
  • cheered up.
  • “Well,” he said, “you see something did come of it. She used the wrong
  • Magic until she made him beat her. If she’d used the right Magic and
  • had said something nice perhaps he wouldn’t have got as drunk as a lord
  • and perhaps—perhaps he might have bought her a new bonnet.”
  • Ben Weatherstaff chuckled and there was shrewd admiration in his little
  • old eyes.
  • “Tha’rt a clever lad as well as a straight-legged one, Mester Colin,”
  • he said. “Next time I see Bess Fettleworth I’ll give her a bit of a
  • hint o’ what Magic will do for her. She’d be rare an’ pleased if th’
  • sinetifik ’speriment worked—an’ so ’ud Jem.”
  • Dickon had stood listening to the lecture, his round eyes shining with
  • curious delight. Nut and Shell were on his shoulders and he held a
  • long-eared white rabbit in his arm and stroked and stroked it softly
  • while it laid its ears along its back and enjoyed itself.
  • “Do you think the experiment will work?” Colin asked him, wondering
  • what he was thinking. He so often wondered what Dickon was thinking
  • when he saw him looking at him or at one of his “creatures” with his
  • happy wide smile.
  • He smiled now and his smile was wider than usual.
  • “Aye,” he answered, “that I do. It’ll work same as th’ seeds do when
  • th’ sun shines on ’em. It’ll work for sure. Shall us begin it now?”
  • Colin was delighted and so was Mary. Fired by recollections of fakirs
  • and devotees in illustrations Colin suggested that they should all sit
  • cross-legged under the tree which made a canopy.
  • “It will be like sitting in a sort of temple,” said Colin. “I’m rather
  • tired and I want to sit down.”
  • “Eh!” said Dickon, “tha’ mustn’t begin by sayin’ tha’rt tired. Tha’
  • might spoil th’ Magic.”
  • Colin turned and looked at him—into his innocent round eyes.
  • “That’s true,” he said slowly. “I must only think of the Magic.”
  • It all seemed most majestic and mysterious when they sat down in their
  • circle. Ben Weatherstaff felt as if he had somehow been led into
  • appearing at a prayer-meeting. Ordinarily he was very fixed in being
  • what he called “agen’ prayer-meetin’s” but this being the Rajah’s
  • affair he did not resent it and was indeed inclined to be gratified at
  • being called upon to assist. Mistress Mary felt solemnly enraptured.
  • Dickon held his rabbit in his arm, and perhaps he made some charmer’s
  • signal no one heard, for when he sat down, cross-legged like the rest,
  • the crow, the fox, the squirrels and the lamb slowly drew near and made
  • part of the circle, settling each into a place of rest as if of their
  • own desire.
  • “The ‘creatures’ have come,” said Colin gravely. “They want to help
  • us.”
  • Colin really looked quite beautiful, Mary thought. He held his head
  • high as if he felt like a sort of priest and his strange eyes had a
  • wonderful look in them. The light shone on him through the tree canopy.
  • “Now we will begin,” he said. “Shall we sway backward and forward,
  • Mary, as if we were dervishes?”
  • “I canna’ do no swayin’ back’ard and for’ard,” said Ben Weatherstaff.
  • “I’ve got th’ rheumatics.”
  • “The Magic will take them away,” said Colin in a High Priest tone, “but
  • we won’t sway until it has done it. We will only chant.”
  • “I canna’ do no chantin’” said Ben Weatherstaff a trifle testily. “They
  • turned me out o’ th’ church choir th’ only time I ever tried it.”
  • No one smiled. They were all too much in earnest. Colin’s face was not
  • even crossed by a shadow. He was thinking only of the Magic.
  • “Then I will chant,” he said. And he began, looking like a strange boy
  • spirit. “The sun is shining—the sun is shining. That is the Magic. The
  • flowers are growing—the roots are stirring. That is the Magic. Being
  • alive is the Magic—being strong is the Magic. The Magic is in me—the
  • Magic is in me. It is in me—it is in me. It’s in everyone of us. It’s
  • in Ben Weatherstaff’s back. Magic! Magic! Come and help!”
  • He said it a great many times—not a thousand times but quite a goodly
  • number. Mary listened entranced. She felt as if it were at once queer
  • and beautiful and she wanted him to go on and on. Ben Weatherstaff
  • began to feel soothed into a sort of dream which was quite agreeable.
  • The humming of the bees in the blossoms mingled with the chanting voice
  • and drowsily melted into a doze. Dickon sat cross-legged with his
  • rabbit asleep on his arm and a hand resting on the lamb’s back. Soot
  • had pushed away a squirrel and huddled close to him on his shoulder,
  • the gray film dropped over his eyes. At last Colin stopped.
  • “Now I am going to walk round the garden,” he announced.
  • Ben Weatherstaff’s head had just dropped forward and he lifted it with
  • a jerk.
  • “You have been asleep,” said Colin.
  • “Nowt o’ th’ sort,” mumbled Ben. “Th’ sermon was good enow—but I’m
  • bound to get out afore th’ collection.”
  • He was not quite awake yet.
  • “You’re not in church,” said Colin.
  • “Not me,” said Ben, straightening himself. “Who said I were? I heard
  • every bit of it. You said th’ Magic was in my back. Th’ doctor calls it
  • rheumatics.”
  • The Rajah waved his hand.
  • “That was the wrong Magic,” he said. “You will get better. You have my
  • permission to go to your work. But come back tomorrow.”
  • “I’d like to see thee walk round the garden,” grunted Ben.
  • It was not an unfriendly grunt, but it was a grunt. In fact, being a
  • stubborn old party and not having entire faith in Magic he had made up
  • his mind that if he were sent away he would climb his ladder and look
  • over the wall so that he might be ready to hobble back if there were
  • any stumbling.
  • The Rajah did not object to his staying and so the procession was
  • formed. It really did look like a procession. Colin was at its head
  • with Dickon on one side and Mary on the other. Ben Weatherstaff walked
  • behind, and the “creatures” trailed after them, the lamb and the fox
  • cub keeping close to Dickon, the white rabbit hopping along or stopping
  • to nibble and Soot following with the solemnity of a person who felt
  • himself in charge.
  • It was a procession which moved slowly but with dignity. Every few
  • yards it stopped to rest. Colin leaned on Dickon’s arm and privately
  • Ben Weatherstaff kept a sharp lookout, but now and then Colin took his
  • hand from its support and walked a few steps alone. His head was held
  • up all the time and he looked very grand.
  • “The Magic is in me!” he kept saying. “The Magic is making me strong! I
  • can feel it! I can feel it!”
  • It seemed very certain that something was upholding and uplifting him.
  • He sat on the seats in the alcoves, and once or twice he sat down on
  • the grass and several times he paused in the path and leaned on Dickon,
  • but he would not give up until he had gone all round the garden. When
  • he returned to the canopy tree his cheeks were flushed and he looked
  • triumphant.
  • “I did it! The Magic worked!” he cried. “That is my first scientific
  • discovery.”
  • “What will Dr. Craven say?” broke out Mary.
  • “He won’t say anything,” Colin answered, “because he will not be told.
  • This is to be the biggest secret of all. No one is to know anything
  • about it until I have grown so strong that I can walk and run like any
  • other boy. I shall come here every day in my chair and I shall be taken
  • back in it. I won’t have people whispering and asking questions and I
  • won’t let my father hear about it until the experiment has quite
  • succeeded. Then sometime when he comes back to Misselthwaite I shall
  • just walk into his study and say ‘Here I am; I am like any other boy. I
  • am quite well and I shall live to be a man. It has been done by a
  • scientific experiment.’”
  • “He will think he is in a dream,” cried Mary. “He won’t believe his
  • eyes.”
  • Colin flushed triumphantly. He had made himself believe that he was
  • going to get well, which was really more than half the battle, if he
  • had been aware of it. And the thought which stimulated him more than
  • any other was this imagining what his father would look like when he
  • saw that he had a son who was as straight and strong as other fathers’
  • sons. One of his darkest miseries in the unhealthy morbid past days had
  • been his hatred of being a sickly weak-backed boy whose father was
  • afraid to look at him.
  • “He’ll be obliged to believe them,” he said.
  • “One of the things I am going to do, after the Magic works and before I
  • begin to make scientific discoveries, is to be an athlete.”
  • “We shall have thee takin’ to boxin’ in a week or so,” said Ben
  • Weatherstaff. “Tha’lt end wi’ winnin’ th’ Belt an’ bein’ champion
  • prize-fighter of all England.”
  • Colin fixed his eyes on him sternly.
  • “Weatherstaff,” he said, “that is disrespectful. You must not take
  • liberties because you are in the secret. However much the Magic works I
  • shall not be a prize-fighter. I shall be a Scientific Discoverer.”
  • “Ax pardon—ax pardon, sir” answered Ben, touching his forehead in
  • salute. “I ought to have seed it wasn’t a jokin’ matter,” but his eyes
  • twinkled and secretly he was immensely pleased. He really did not mind
  • being snubbed since the snubbing meant that the lad was gaining
  • strength and spirit.
  • CHAPTER XXIV
  • “LET THEM LAUGH”
  • The secret garden was not the only one Dickon worked in. Round the
  • cottage on the moor there was a piece of ground enclosed by a low wall
  • of rough stones. Early in the morning and late in the fading twilight
  • and on all the days Colin and Mary did not see him, Dickon worked there
  • planting or tending potatoes and cabbages, turnips and carrots and
  • herbs for his mother. In the company of his “creatures” he did wonders
  • there and was never tired of doing them, it seemed. While he dug or
  • weeded he whistled or sang bits of Yorkshire moor songs or talked to
  • Soot or Captain or the brothers and sisters he had taught to help him.
  • “We’d never get on as comfortable as we do,” Mrs. Sowerby said, “if it
  • wasn’t for Dickon’s garden. Anything’ll grow for him. His ’taters and
  • cabbages is twice th’ size of anyone else’s an’ they’ve got a flavor
  • with ’em as nobody’s has.”
  • When she found a moment to spare she liked to go out and talk to him.
  • After supper there was still a long clear twilight to work in and that
  • was her quiet time. She could sit upon the low rough wall and look on
  • and hear stories of the day. She loved this time. There were not only
  • vegetables in this garden. Dickon had bought penny packages of flower
  • seeds now and then and sown bright sweet-scented things among
  • gooseberry bushes and even cabbages and he grew borders of mignonette
  • and pinks and pansies and things whose seeds he could save year after
  • year or whose roots would bloom each spring and spread in time into
  • fine clumps. The low wall was one of the prettiest things in Yorkshire
  • because he had tucked moorland foxglove and ferns and rock-cress and
  • hedgerow flowers into every crevice until only here and there glimpses
  • of the stones were to be seen.
  • “All a chap’s got to do to make ’em thrive, mother,” he would say, “is
  • to be friends with ’em for sure. They’re just like th’ ‘creatures.’ If
  • they’re thirsty give ’em drink and if they’re hungry give ’em a bit o’
  • food. They want to live same as we do. If they died I should feel as if
  • I’d been a bad lad and somehow treated them heartless.”
  • It was in these twilight hours that Mrs. Sowerby heard of all that
  • happened at Misselthwaite Manor. At first she was only told that
  • “Mester Colin” had taken a fancy to going out into the grounds with
  • Miss Mary and that it was doing him good. But it was not long before it
  • was agreed between the two children that Dickon’s mother might “come
  • into the secret.” Somehow it was not doubted that she was “safe for
  • sure.”
  • So one beautiful still evening Dickon told the whole story, with all
  • the thrilling details of the buried key and the robin and the gray haze
  • which had seemed like deadness and the secret Mistress Mary had planned
  • never to reveal. The coming of Dickon and how it had been told to him,
  • the doubt of Mester Colin and the final drama of his introduction to
  • the hidden domain, combined with the incident of Ben Weatherstaff’s
  • angry face peering over the wall and Mester Colin’s sudden indignant
  • strength, made Mrs. Sowerby’s nice-looking face quite change color
  • several times.
  • “My word!” she said. “It was a good thing that little lass came to th’
  • Manor. It’s been th’ makin’ o’ her an’ th’ savin, o’ him. Standin’ on
  • his feet! An’ us all thinkin’ he was a poor half-witted lad with not a
  • straight bone in him.”
  • She asked a great many questions and her blue eyes were full of deep
  • thinking.
  • “What do they make of it at th’ Manor—him being so well an’ cheerful
  • an’ never complainin’?” she inquired.
  • “They don’t know what to make of it,” answered Dickon. “Every day as
  • comes round his face looks different. It’s fillin’ out and doesn’t look
  • so sharp an’ th’ waxy color is goin’. But he has to do his bit o’
  • complainin’,” with a highly entertained grin.
  • “What for, i’ Mercy’s name?” asked Mrs. Sowerby.
  • Dickon chuckled.
  • “He does it to keep them from guessin’ what’s happened. If the doctor
  • knew he’d found out he could stand on his feet he’d likely write and
  • tell Mester Craven. Mester Colin’s savin’ th’ secret to tell himself.
  • He’s goin’ to practise his Magic on his legs every day till his father
  • comes back an’ then he’s goin’ to march into his room an’ show him he’s
  • as straight as other lads. But him an’ Miss Mary thinks it’s best plan
  • to do a bit o’ groanin’ an’ frettin’ now an’ then to throw folk off th’
  • scent.”
  • Mrs. Sowerby was laughing a low comfortable laugh long before he had
  • finished his last sentence.
  • “Eh!” she said, “that pair’s enjoyin’ theirselves I’ll warrant. They’ll
  • get a good bit o’ actin’ out of it an’ there’s nothin’ children likes
  • as much as play actin’. Let’s hear what they do, Dickon lad.”
  • Dickon stopped weeding and sat up on his heels to tell her. His eyes
  • were twinkling with fun.
  • “Mester Colin is carried down to his chair every time he goes out,” he
  • explained. “An’ he flies out at John, th’ footman, for not carryin’ him
  • careful enough. He makes himself as helpless lookin’ as he can an’
  • never lifts his head until we’re out o’ sight o’ th’ house. An’ he
  • grunts an’ frets a good bit when he’s bein’ settled into his chair. Him
  • an’ Miss Mary’s both got to enjoyin’ it an’ when he groans an’
  • complains she’ll say, ‘Poor Colin! Does it hurt you so much? Are you so
  • weak as that, poor Colin?’—but th’ trouble is that sometimes they can
  • scarce keep from burstin’ out laughin’. When we get safe into the
  • garden they laugh till they’ve no breath left to laugh with. An’ they
  • have to stuff their faces into Mester Colin’s cushions to keep the
  • gardeners from hearin’, if any of, ’em’s about.”
  • “Th’ more they laugh th’ better for ’em!” said Mrs. Sowerby, still
  • laughing herself. “Good healthy child laughin’s better than pills any
  • day o’ th’ year. That pair’ll plump up for sure.”
  • “They are plumpin’ up,” said Dickon. “They’re that hungry they don’t
  • know how to get enough to eat without makin’ talk. Mester Colin says if
  • he keeps sendin’ for more food they won’t believe he’s an invalid at
  • all. Miss Mary says she’ll let him eat her share, but he says that if
  • she goes hungry she’ll get thin an’ they mun both get fat at once.”
  • Mrs. Sowerby laughed so heartily at the revelation of this difficulty
  • that she quite rocked backward and forward in her blue cloak, and
  • Dickon laughed with her.
  • “I’ll tell thee what, lad,” Mrs. Sowerby said when she could speak.
  • “I’ve thought of a way to help ’em. When tha’ goes to ’em in th’
  • mornin’s tha’ shall take a pail o’ good new milk an’ I’ll bake ’em a
  • crusty cottage loaf or some buns wi’ currants in ’em, same as you
  • children like. Nothin’s so good as fresh milk an’ bread. Then they
  • could take off th’ edge o’ their hunger while they were in their garden
  • an’ th, fine food they get indoors ’ud polish off th’ corners.”
  • “Eh! mother!” said Dickon admiringly, “what a wonder tha’ art! Tha’
  • always sees a way out o’ things. They was quite in a pother yesterday.
  • They didn’t see how they was to manage without orderin’ up more
  • food—they felt that empty inside.”
  • “They’re two young ’uns growin’ fast, an’ health’s comin’ back to both
  • of ’em. Children like that feels like young wolves an’ food’s flesh an’
  • blood to ’em,” said Mrs. Sowerby. Then she smiled Dickon’s own curving
  • smile. “Eh! but they’re enjoyin’ theirselves for sure,” she said.
  • She was quite right, the comfortable wonderful mother creature—and she
  • had never been more so than when she said their “play actin’” would be
  • their joy. Colin and Mary found it one of their most thrilling sources
  • of entertainment. The idea of protecting themselves from suspicion had
  • been unconsciously suggested to them first by the puzzled nurse and
  • then by Dr. Craven himself.
  • “Your appetite. Is improving very much, Master Colin,” the nurse had
  • said one day. “You used to eat nothing, and so many things disagreed
  • with you.”
  • “Nothing disagrees with me now” replied Colin, and then seeing the
  • nurse looking at him curiously he suddenly remembered that perhaps he
  • ought not to appear too well just yet. “At least things don’t so often
  • disagree with me. It’s the fresh air.”
  • “Perhaps it is,” said the nurse, still looking at him with a mystified
  • expression. “But I must talk to Dr. Craven about it.”
  • “How she stared at you!” said Mary when she went away. “As if she
  • thought there must be something to find out.”
  • “I won’t have her finding out things,” said Colin. “No one must begin
  • to find out yet.”
  • When Dr. Craven came that morning he seemed puzzled, also. He asked a
  • number of questions, to Colin’s great annoyance.
  • “You stay out in the garden a great deal,” he suggested. “Where do you
  • go?”
  • Colin put on his favorite air of dignified indifference to opinion.
  • “I will not let anyone know where I go,” he answered. “I go to a place
  • I like. Everyone has orders to keep out of the way. I won’t be watched
  • and stared at. You know that!”
  • “You seem to be out all day but I do not think it has done you harm—I
  • do not think so. The nurse says that you eat much more than you have
  • ever done before.”
  • “Perhaps,” said Colin, prompted by a sudden inspiration, “perhaps it is
  • an unnatural appetite.”
  • “I do not think so, as your food seems to agree with you,” said Dr.
  • Craven. “You are gaining flesh rapidly and your color is better.”
  • “Perhaps—perhaps I am bloated and feverish,” said Colin, assuming a
  • discouraging air of gloom. “People who are not going to live are
  • often—different.”
  • Dr. Craven shook his head. He was holding Colin’s wrist and he pushed
  • up his sleeve and felt his arm.
  • “You are not feverish,” he said thoughtfully, “and such flesh as you
  • have gained is healthy. If you can keep this up, my boy, we need not
  • talk of dying. Your father will be happy to hear of this remarkable
  • improvement.”
  • “I won’t have him told!” Colin broke forth fiercely. “It will only
  • disappoint him if I get worse again—and I may get worse this very
  • night. I might have a raging fever. I feel as if I might be beginning
  • to have one now. I won’t have letters written to my father—I won’t—I
  • won’t! You are making me angry and you know that is bad for me. I feel
  • hot already. I hate being written about and being talked over as much
  • as I hate being stared at!”
  • “Hush-h! my boy,” Dr. Craven soothed him. “Nothing shall be written
  • without your permission. You are too sensitive about things. You must
  • not undo the good which has been done.”
  • He said no more about writing to Mr. Craven and when he saw the nurse
  • he privately warned her that such a possibility must not be mentioned
  • to the patient.
  • “The boy is extraordinarily better,” he said. “His advance seems almost
  • abnormal. But of course he is doing now of his own free will what we
  • could not make him do before. Still, he excites himself very easily and
  • nothing must be said to irritate him.”
  • Mary and Colin were much alarmed and talked together anxiously. From
  • this time dated their plan of “play actin’.”
  • “I may be obliged to have a tantrum,” said Colin regretfully. “I don’t
  • want to have one and I’m not miserable enough now to work myself into a
  • big one. Perhaps I couldn’t have one at all. That lump doesn’t come in
  • my throat now and I keep thinking of nice things instead of horrible
  • ones. But if they talk about writing to my father I shall have to do
  • something.”
  • He made up his mind to eat less, but unfortunately it was not possible
  • to carry out this brilliant idea when he wakened each morning with an
  • amazing appetite and the table near his sofa was set with a breakfast
  • of home-made bread and fresh butter, snow-white eggs, raspberry jam and
  • clotted cream. Mary always breakfasted with him and when they found
  • themselves at the table—particularly if there were delicate slices of
  • sizzling ham sending forth tempting odors from under a hot silver
  • cover—they would look into each other’s eyes in desperation.
  • “I think we shall have to eat it all this morning, Mary,” Colin always
  • ended by saying. “We can send away some of the lunch and a great deal
  • of the dinner.”
  • But they never found they could send away anything and the highly
  • polished condition of the empty plates returned to the pantry awakened
  • much comment.
  • “I do wish,” Colin would say also, “I do wish the slices of ham were
  • thicker, and one muffin each is not enough for anyone.”
  • “It’s enough for a person who is going to die,” answered Mary when
  • first she heard this, “but it’s not enough for a person who is going to
  • live. I sometimes feel as if I could eat three when those nice fresh
  • heather and gorse smells from the moor come pouring in at the open
  • window.”
  • The morning that Dickon—after they had been enjoying themselves in the
  • garden for about two hours—went behind a big rosebush and brought forth
  • two tin pails and revealed that one was full of rich new milk with
  • cream on the top of it, and that the other held cottage-made currant
  • buns folded in a clean blue and white napkin, buns so carefully tucked
  • in that they were still hot, there was a riot of surprised joyfulness.
  • What a wonderful thing for Mrs. Sowerby to think of! What a kind,
  • clever woman she must be! How good the buns were! And what delicious
  • fresh milk!
  • “Magic is in her just as it is in Dickon,” said Colin. “It makes her
  • think of ways to do things—nice things. She is a Magic person. Tell her
  • we are grateful, Dickon—extremely grateful.”
  • He was given to using rather grown-up phrases at times. He enjoyed
  • them. He liked this so much that he improved upon it.
  • “Tell her she has been most bounteous and our gratitude is extreme.”
  • And then forgetting his grandeur he fell to and stuffed himself with
  • buns and drank milk out of the pail in copious draughts in the manner
  • of any hungry little boy who had been taking unusual exercise and
  • breathing in moorland air and whose breakfast was more than two hours
  • behind him.
  • This was the beginning of many agreeable incidents of the same kind.
  • They actually awoke to the fact that as Mrs. Sowerby had fourteen
  • people to provide food for she might not have enough to satisfy two
  • extra appetites every day. So they asked her to let them send some of
  • their shillings to buy things.
  • Dickon made the stimulating discovery that in the wood in the park
  • outside the garden where Mary had first found him piping to the wild
  • creatures there was a deep little hollow where you could build a sort
  • of tiny oven with stones and roast potatoes and eggs in it. Roasted
  • eggs were a previously unknown luxury and very hot potatoes with salt
  • and fresh butter in them were fit for a woodland king—besides being
  • deliciously satisfying. You could buy both potatoes and eggs and eat as
  • many as you liked without feeling as if you were taking food out of the
  • mouths of fourteen people.
  • Every beautiful morning the Magic was worked by the mystic circle under
  • the plum-tree which provided a canopy of thickening green leaves after
  • its brief blossom-time was ended. After the ceremony Colin always took
  • his walking exercise and throughout the day he exercised his newly
  • found power at intervals. Each day he grew stronger and could walk more
  • steadily and cover more ground. And each day his belief in the Magic
  • grew stronger—as well it might. He tried one experiment after another
  • as he felt himself gaining strength and it was Dickon who showed him
  • the best things of all.
  • “Yesterday,” he said one morning after an absence, “I went to Thwaite
  • for mother an’ near th’ Blue Cow Inn I seed Bob Haworth. He’s the
  • strongest chap on th’ moor. He’s the champion wrestler an’ he can jump
  • higher than any other chap an’ throw th’ hammer farther. He’s gone all
  • th’ way to Scotland for th’ sports some years. He’s knowed me ever
  • since I was a little ’un an’ he’s a friendly sort an’ I axed him some
  • questions. Th’ gentry calls him a athlete and I thought o’ thee, Mester
  • Colin, and I says, ‘How did tha’ make tha’ muscles stick out that way,
  • Bob? Did tha’ do anythin’ extra to make thysel’ so strong?’ An’ he says
  • ‘Well, yes, lad, I did. A strong man in a show that came to Thwaite
  • once showed me how to exercise my arms an’ legs an’ every muscle in my
  • body. An’ I says, ‘Could a delicate chap make himself stronger with
  • ’em, Bob?’ an’ he laughed an’ says, ‘Art tha’ th’ delicate chap?’ an’ I
  • says, ‘No, but I knows a young gentleman that’s gettin’ well of a long
  • illness an’ I wish I knowed some o’ them tricks to tell him about.’ I
  • didn’t say no names an’ he didn’t ask none. He’s friendly same as I
  • said an’ he stood up an’ showed me good-natured like, an’ I imitated
  • what he did till I knowed it by heart.”
  • Colin had been listening excitedly.
  • “Can you show me?” he cried. “Will you?”
  • “Aye, to be sure,” Dickon answered, getting up. “But he says tha’ mun
  • do ’em gentle at first an’ be careful not to tire thysel’. Rest in
  • between times an’ take deep breaths an’ don’t overdo.”
  • “I’ll be careful,” said Colin. “Show me! Show me! Dickon, you are the
  • most Magic boy in the world!”
  • Dickon stood up on the grass and slowly went through a carefully
  • practical but simple series of muscle exercises. Colin watched them
  • with widening eyes. He could do a few while he was sitting down.
  • Presently he did a few gently while he stood upon his already steadied
  • feet. Mary began to do them also. Soot, who was watching the
  • performance, became much disturbed and left his branch and hopped about
  • restlessly because he could not do them too.
  • From that time the exercises were part of the day’s duties as much as
  • the Magic was. It became possible for both Colin and Mary to do more of
  • them each time they tried, and such appetites were the results that but
  • for the basket Dickon put down behind the bush each morning when he
  • arrived they would have been lost. But the little oven in the hollow
  • and Mrs. Sowerby’s bounties were so satisfying that Mrs. Medlock and
  • the nurse and Dr. Craven became mystified again. You can trifle with
  • your breakfast and seem to disdain your dinner if you are full to the
  • brim with roasted eggs and potatoes and richly frothed new milk and
  • oatcakes and buns and heather honey and clotted cream.
  • “They are eating next to nothing,” said the nurse. “They’ll die of
  • starvation if they can’t be persuaded to take some nourishment. And yet
  • see how they look.”
  • “Look!” exclaimed Mrs. Medlock indignantly. “Eh! I’m moithered to death
  • with them. They’re a pair of young Satans. Bursting their jackets one
  • day and the next turning up their noses at the best meals Cook can
  • tempt them with. Not a mouthful of that lovely young fowl and bread
  • sauce did they set a fork into yesterday—and the poor woman fair
  • _invented_ a pudding for them—and back it’s sent. She almost cried.
  • She’s afraid she’ll be blamed if they starve themselves into their
  • graves.”
  • Dr. Craven came and looked at Colin long and carefully, He wore an
  • extremely worried expression when the nurse talked with him and showed
  • him the almost untouched tray of breakfast she had saved for him to
  • look at—but it was even more worried when he sat down by Colin’s sofa
  • and examined him. He had been called to London on business and had not
  • seen the boy for nearly two weeks. When young things begin to gain
  • health they gain it rapidly. The waxen tinge had left, Colins skin and
  • a warm rose showed through it; his beautiful eyes were clear and the
  • hollows under them and in his cheeks and temples had filled out. His
  • once dark, heavy locks had begun to look as if they sprang healthily
  • from his forehead and were soft and warm with life. His lips were
  • fuller and of a normal color. In fact as an imitation of a boy who was
  • a confirmed invalid he was a disgraceful sight. Dr. Craven held his
  • chin in his hand and thought him over.
  • “I am sorry to hear that you do not eat anything,” he said. “That will
  • not do. You will lose all you have gained—and you have gained
  • amazingly. You ate so well a short time ago.”
  • “I told you it was an unnatural appetite,” answered Colin.
  • Mary was sitting on her stool nearby and she suddenly made a very queer
  • sound which she tried so violently to repress that she ended by almost
  • choking.
  • “What is the matter?” said Dr. Craven, turning to look at her.
  • Mary became quite severe in her manner.
  • “It was something between a sneeze and a cough,” she replied with
  • reproachful dignity, “and it got into my throat.”
  • “But,” she said afterward to Colin, “I couldn’t stop myself. It just
  • burst out because all at once I couldn’t help remembering that last big
  • potato you ate and the way your mouth stretched when you bit through
  • that thick lovely crust with jam and clotted cream on it.”
  • “Is there any way in which those children can get food secretly?” Dr.
  • Craven inquired of Mrs. Medlock.
  • “There’s no way unless they dig it out of the earth or pick it off the
  • trees,” Mrs. Medlock answered. “They stay out in the grounds all day
  • and see no one but each other. And if they want anything different to
  • eat from what’s sent up to them they need only ask for it.”
  • “Well,” said Dr. Craven, “so long as going without food agrees with
  • them we need not disturb ourselves. The boy is a new creature.”
  • “So is the girl,” said Mrs. Medlock. “She’s begun to be downright
  • pretty since she’s filled out and lost her ugly little sour look. Her
  • hair’s grown thick and healthy looking and she’s got a bright color.
  • The glummest, ill-natured little thing she used to be and now her and
  • Master Colin laugh together like a pair of crazy young ones. Perhaps
  • they’re growing fat on that.”
  • “Perhaps they are,” said Dr. Craven. “Let them laugh.”
  • CHAPTER XXV
  • THE CURTAIN
  • And the secret garden bloomed and bloomed and every morning revealed
  • new miracles. In the robin’s nest there were Eggs and the robin’s mate
  • sat upon them keeping them warm with her feathery little breast and
  • careful wings. At first she was very nervous and the robin himself was
  • indignantly watchful. Even Dickon did not go near the close-grown
  • corner in those days, but waited until by the quiet working of some
  • mysterious spell he seemed to have conveyed to the soul of the little
  • pair that in the garden there was nothing which was not quite like
  • themselves—nothing which did not understand the wonderfulness of what
  • was happening to them—the immense, tender, terrible, heart-breaking
  • beauty and solemnity of Eggs. If there had been one person in that
  • garden who had not known through all his or her innermost being that if
  • an Egg were taken away or hurt the whole world would whirl round and
  • crash through space and come to an end—if there had been even one who
  • did not feel it and act accordingly there could have been no happiness
  • even in that golden springtime air. But they all knew it and felt it
  • and the robin and his mate knew they knew it.
  • At first the robin watched Mary and Colin with sharp anxiety. For some
  • mysterious reason he knew he need not watch Dickon. The first moment he
  • set his dew-bright black eye on Dickon he knew he was not a stranger
  • but a sort of robin without beak or feathers. He could speak robin
  • (which is a quite distinct language not to be mistaken for any other).
  • To speak robin to a robin is like speaking French to a Frenchman.
  • Dickon always spoke it to the robin himself, so the queer gibberish he
  • used when he spoke to humans did not matter in the least. The robin
  • thought he spoke this gibberish to them because they were not
  • intelligent enough to understand feathered speech. His movements also
  • were robin. They never startled one by being sudden enough to seem
  • dangerous or threatening. Any robin could understand Dickon, so his
  • presence was not even disturbing.
  • But at the outset it seemed necessary to be on guard against the other
  • two. In the first place the boy creature did not come into the garden
  • on his legs. He was pushed in on a thing with wheels and the skins of
  • wild animals were thrown over him. That in itself was doubtful. Then
  • when he began to stand up and move about he did it in a queer
  • unaccustomed way and the others seemed to have to help him. The robin
  • used to secrete himself in a bush and watch this anxiously, his head
  • tilted first on one side and then on the other. He thought that the
  • slow movements might mean that he was preparing to pounce, as cats do.
  • When cats are preparing to pounce they creep over the ground very
  • slowly. The robin talked this over with his mate a great deal for a few
  • days but after that he decided not to speak of the subject because her
  • terror was so great that he was afraid it might be injurious to the
  • Eggs.
  • When the boy began to walk by himself and even to move more quickly it
  • was an immense relief. But for a long time—or it seemed a long time to
  • the robin—he was a source of some anxiety. He did not act as the other
  • humans did. He seemed very fond of walking but he had a way of sitting
  • or lying down for a while and then getting up in a disconcerting manner
  • to begin again.
  • One day the robin remembered that when he himself had been made to
  • learn to fly by his parents he had done much the same sort of thing. He
  • had taken short flights of a few yards and then had been obliged to
  • rest. So it occurred to him that this boy was learning to fly—or rather
  • to walk. He mentioned this to his mate and when he told her that the
  • Eggs would probably conduct themselves in the same way after they were
  • fledged she was quite comforted and even became eagerly interested and
  • derived great pleasure from watching the boy over the edge of her
  • nest—though she always thought that the Eggs would be much cleverer and
  • learn more quickly. But then she said indulgently that humans were
  • always more clumsy and slow than Eggs and most of them never seemed
  • really to learn to fly at all. You never met them in the air or on
  • tree-tops.
  • After a while the boy began to move about as the others did, but all
  • three of the children at times did unusual things. They would stand
  • under the trees and move their arms and legs and heads about in a way
  • which was neither walking nor running nor sitting down. They went
  • through these movements at intervals every day and the robin was never
  • able to explain to his mate what they were doing or tying to do. He
  • could only say that he was sure that the Eggs would never flap about in
  • such a manner; but as the boy who could speak robin so fluently was
  • doing the thing with them, birds could be quite sure that the actions
  • were not of a dangerous nature. Of course neither the robin nor his
  • mate had ever heard of the champion wrestler, Bob Haworth, and his
  • exercises for making the muscles stand out like lumps. Robins are not
  • like human beings; their muscles are always exercised from the first
  • and so they develop themselves in a natural manner. If you have to fly
  • about to find every meal you eat, your muscles do not become atrophied
  • (atrophied means wasted away through want of use).
  • When the boy was walking and running about and digging and weeding like
  • the others, the nest in the corner was brooded over by a great peace
  • and content. Fears for the Eggs became things of the past. Knowing that
  • your Eggs were as safe as if they were locked in a bank vault and the
  • fact that you could watch so many curious things going on made setting
  • a most entertaining occupation. On wet days the Eggs’ mother sometimes
  • felt even a little dull because the children did not come into the
  • garden.
  • But even on wet days it could not be said that Mary and Colin were
  • dull. One morning when the rain streamed down unceasingly and Colin was
  • beginning to feel a little restive, as he was obliged to remain on his
  • sofa because it was not safe to get up and walk about, Mary had an
  • inspiration.
  • “Now that I am a real boy,” Colin had said, “my legs and arms and all
  • my body are so full of Magic that I can’t keep them still. They want to
  • be doing things all the time. Do you know that when I waken in the
  • morning, Mary, when it’s quite early and the birds are just shouting
  • outside and everything seems just shouting for joy—even the trees and
  • things we can’t really hear—I feel as if I must jump out of bed and
  • shout myself. If I did it, just think what would happen!”
  • Mary giggled inordinately.
  • “The nurse would come running and Mrs. Medlock would come running and
  • they would be sure you had gone crazy and they’d send for the doctor,”
  • she said.
  • Colin giggled himself. He could see how they would all look—how
  • horrified by his outbreak and how amazed to see him standing upright.
  • “I wish my father would come home,” he said. “I want to tell him
  • myself. I’m always thinking about it—but we couldn’t go on like this
  • much longer. I can’t stand lying still and pretending, and besides I
  • look too different. I wish it wasn’t raining today.”
  • It was then Mistress Mary had her inspiration.
  • “Colin,” she began mysteriously, “do you know how many rooms there are
  • in this house?”
  • “About a thousand, I suppose,” he answered.
  • “There’s about a hundred no one ever goes into,” said Mary. “And one
  • rainy day I went and looked into ever so many of them. No one ever
  • knew, though Mrs. Medlock nearly found me out. I lost my way when I was
  • coming back and I stopped at the end of your corridor. That was the
  • second time I heard you crying.”
  • Colin started up on his sofa.
  • “A hundred rooms no one goes into,” he said. “It sounds almost like a
  • secret garden. Suppose we go and look at them. Wheel me in my chair and
  • nobody would know we went.”
  • “That’s what I was thinking,” said Mary. “No one would dare to follow
  • us. There are galleries where you could run. We could do our exercises.
  • There is a little Indian room where there is a cabinet full of ivory
  • elephants. There are all sorts of rooms.”
  • “Ring the bell,” said Colin.
  • When the nurse came in he gave his orders.
  • “I want my chair,” he said. “Miss Mary and I are going to look at the
  • part of the house which is not used. John can push me as far as the
  • picture-gallery because there are some stairs. Then he must go away and
  • leave us alone until I send for him again.”
  • Rainy days lost their terrors that morning. When the footman had
  • wheeled the chair into the picture-gallery and left the two together in
  • obedience to orders, Colin and Mary looked at each other delighted. As
  • soon as Mary had made sure that John was really on his way back to his
  • own quarters below stairs, Colin got out of his chair.
  • “I am going to run from one end of the gallery to the other,” he said,
  • “and then I am going to jump and then we will do Bob Haworth’s
  • exercises.”
  • And they did all these things and many others. They looked at the
  • portraits and found the plain little girl dressed in green brocade and
  • holding the parrot on her finger.
  • “All these,” said Colin, “must be my relations. They lived a long time
  • ago. That parrot one, I believe, is one of my great, great, great,
  • great aunts. She looks rather like you, Mary—not as you look now but as
  • you looked when you came here. Now you are a great deal fatter and
  • better looking.”
  • “So are you,” said Mary, and they both laughed.
  • They went to the Indian room and amused themselves with the ivory
  • elephants. They found the rose-colored brocade boudoir and the hole in
  • the cushion the mouse had left, but the mice had grown up and run away
  • and the hole was empty. They saw more rooms and made more discoveries
  • than Mary had made on her first pilgrimage. They found new corridors
  • and corners and flights of steps and new old pictures they liked and
  • weird old things they did not know the use of. It was a curiously
  • entertaining morning and the feeling of wandering about in the same
  • house with other people but at the same time feeling as if one were
  • miles away from them was a fascinating thing.
  • “I’m glad we came,” Colin said. “I never knew I lived in such a big
  • queer old place. I like it. We will ramble about every rainy day. We
  • shall always be finding new queer corners and things.”
  • That morning they had found among other things such good appetites that
  • when they returned to Colin’s room it was not possible to send the
  • luncheon away untouched.
  • When the nurse carried the tray downstairs she slapped it down on the
  • kitchen dresser so that Mrs. Loomis, the cook, could see the highly
  • polished dishes and plates.
  • “Look at that!” she said. “This is a house of mystery, and those two
  • children are the greatest mysteries in it.”
  • “If they keep that up every day,” said the strong young footman John,
  • “there’d be small wonder that he weighs twice as much today as he did a
  • month ago. I should have to give up my place in time, for fear of doing
  • my muscles an injury.”
  • That afternoon Mary noticed that something new had happened in Colin’s
  • room. She had noticed it the day before but had said nothing because
  • she thought the change might have been made by chance. She said nothing
  • today but she sat and looked fixedly at the picture over the mantel.
  • She could look at it because the curtain had been drawn aside. That was
  • the change she noticed.
  • “I know what you want me to tell you,” said Colin, after she had stared
  • a few minutes. “I always know when you want me to tell you something.
  • You are wondering why the curtain is drawn back. I am going to keep it
  • like that.”
  • “Why?” asked Mary.
  • “Because it doesn’t make me angry any more to see her laughing. I
  • wakened when it was bright moonlight two nights ago and felt as if the
  • Magic was filling the room and making everything so splendid that I
  • couldn’t lie still. I got up and looked out of the window. The room was
  • quite light and there was a patch of moonlight on the curtain and
  • somehow that made me go and pull the cord. She looked right down at me
  • as if she were laughing because she was glad I was standing there. It
  • made me like to look at her. I want to see her laughing like that all
  • the time. I think she must have been a sort of Magic person perhaps.”
  • “You are so like her now,” said Mary, “that sometimes I think perhaps
  • you are her ghost made into a boy.”
  • That idea seemed to impress Colin. He thought it over and then answered
  • her slowly.
  • “If I were her ghost—my father would be fond of me,” he said.
  • “Do you want him to be fond of you?” inquired Mary.
  • “I used to hate it because he was not fond of me. If he grew fond of me
  • I think I should tell him about the Magic. It might make him more
  • cheerful.”
  • CHAPTER XXVI
  • “IT’S MOTHER!”
  • Their belief in the Magic was an abiding thing. After the morning’s
  • incantations Colin sometimes gave them Magic lectures.
  • “I like to do it,” he explained, “because when I grow up and make great
  • scientific discoveries I shall be obliged to lecture about them and so
  • this is practise. I can only give short lectures now because I am very
  • young, and besides Ben Weatherstaff would feel as if he were in church
  • and he would go to sleep.”
  • “Th’ best thing about lecturin’,” said Ben, “is that a chap can get up
  • an’ say aught he pleases an’ no other chap can answer him back. I
  • wouldn’t be agen’ lecturin’ a bit mysel’ sometimes.”
  • But when Colin held forth under his tree old Ben fixed devouring eyes
  • on him and kept them there. He looked him over with critical affection.
  • It was not so much the lecture which interested him as the legs which
  • looked straighter and stronger each day, the boyish head which held
  • itself up so well, the once sharp chin and hollow cheeks which had
  • filled and rounded out and the eyes which had begun to hold the light
  • he remembered in another pair. Sometimes when Colin felt Ben’s earnest
  • gaze meant that he was much impressed he wondered what he was
  • reflecting on and once when he had seemed quite entranced he questioned
  • him.
  • “What are you thinking about, Ben Weatherstaff?” he asked.
  • “I was thinkin’” answered Ben, “as I’d warrant tha’s gone up three or
  • four pound this week. I was lookin’ at tha’ calves an’ tha’ shoulders.
  • I’d like to get thee on a pair o’ scales.”
  • “It’s the Magic and—and Mrs. Sowerby’s buns and milk and things,” said
  • Colin. “You see the scientific experiment has succeeded.”
  • That morning Dickon was too late to hear the lecture. When he came he
  • was ruddy with running and his funny face looked more twinkling than
  • usual. As they had a good deal of weeding to do after the rains they
  • fell to work. They always had plenty to do after a warm deep sinking
  • rain. The moisture which was good for the flowers was also good for the
  • weeds which thrust up tiny blades of grass and points of leaves which
  • must be pulled up before their roots took too firm hold. Colin was as
  • good at weeding as anyone in these days and he could lecture while he
  • was doing it.
  • “The Magic works best when you work, yourself,” he said this morning.
  • “You can feel it in your bones and muscles. I am going to read books
  • about bones and muscles, but I am going to write a book about Magic. I
  • am making it up now. I keep finding out things.”
  • It was not very long after he had said this that he laid down his
  • trowel and stood up on his feet. He had been silent for several minutes
  • and they had seen that he was thinking out lectures, as he often did.
  • When he dropped his trowel and stood upright it seemed to Mary and
  • Dickon as if a sudden strong thought had made him do it. He stretched
  • himself out to his tallest height and he threw out his arms exultantly.
  • Color glowed in his face and his strange eyes widened with joyfulness.
  • All at once he had realized something to the full.
  • “Mary! Dickon!” he cried. “Just look at me!”
  • They stopped their weeding and looked at him.
  • “Do you remember that first morning you brought me in here?” he
  • demanded.
  • Dickon was looking at him very hard. Being an animal charmer he could
  • see more things than most people could and many of them were things he
  • never talked about. He saw some of them now in this boy.
  • “Aye, that we do,” he answered.
  • Mary looked hard too, but she said nothing.
  • “Just this minute,” said Colin, “all at once I remembered it
  • myself—when I looked at my hand digging with the trowel—and I had to
  • stand up on my feet to see if it was real. And it is real! I’m
  • _well_—I’m _well!_”
  • “Aye, that th’ art!” said Dickon.
  • “I’m well! I’m well!” said Colin again, and his face went quite red all
  • over.
  • He had known it before in a way, he had hoped it and felt it and
  • thought about it, but just at that minute something had rushed all
  • through him—a sort of rapturous belief and realization and it had been
  • so strong that he could not help calling out.
  • “I shall live forever and ever and ever!” he cried grandly. “I shall
  • find out thousands and thousands of things. I shall find out about
  • people and creatures and everything that grows—like Dickon—and I shall
  • never stop making Magic. I’m well! I’m well! I feel—I feel as if I want
  • to shout out something—something thankful, joyful!”
  • Ben Weatherstaff, who had been working near a rose-bush, glanced round
  • at him.
  • “Tha’ might sing th’ Doxology,” he suggested in his dryest grunt. He
  • had no opinion of the Doxology and he did not make the suggestion with
  • any particular reverence.
  • But Colin was of an exploring mind and he knew nothing about the
  • Doxology.
  • “What is that?” he inquired.
  • “Dickon can sing it for thee, I’ll warrant,” replied Ben Weatherstaff.
  • Dickon answered with his all-perceiving animal charmer’s smile.
  • “They sing it i’ church,” he said. “Mother says she believes th’
  • skylarks sings it when they gets up i’ th’ mornin’.”
  • “If she says that, it must be a nice song,” Colin answered. “I’ve never
  • been in a church myself. I was always too ill. Sing it, Dickon. I want
  • to hear it.”
  • Dickon was quite simple and unaffected about it. He understood what
  • Colin felt better than Colin did himself. He understood by a sort of
  • instinct so natural that he did not know it was understanding. He
  • pulled off his cap and looked round still smiling.
  • “Tha’ must take off tha’ cap,” he said to Colin, “an’ so mun tha’,
  • Ben—an’ tha’ mun stand up, tha’ knows.”
  • Colin took off his cap and the sun shone on and warmed his thick hair
  • as he watched Dickon intently. Ben Weatherstaff scrambled up from his
  • knees and bared his head too with a sort of puzzled half-resentful look
  • on his old face as if he didn’t know exactly why he was doing this
  • remarkable thing.
  • Dickon stood out among the trees and rose-bushes and began to sing in
  • quite a simple matter-of-fact way and in a nice strong boy voice:
  • “Praise God from whom all blessings flow,
  • Praise Him all creatures here below,
  • Praise Him above ye Heavenly Host,
  • Praise Father, Son, and Holy Ghost.
  • Amen.”
  • When he had finished, Ben Weatherstaff was standing quite still with
  • his jaws set obstinately but with a disturbed look in his eyes fixed on
  • Colin. Colin’s face was thoughtful and appreciative.
  • “It is a very nice song,” he said. “I like it. Perhaps it means just
  • what I mean when I want to shout out that I am thankful to the Magic.”
  • He stopped and thought in a puzzled way. “Perhaps they are both the
  • same thing. How can we know the exact names of everything? Sing it
  • again, Dickon. Let us try, Mary. I want to sing it, too. It’s my song.
  • How does it begin? ‘Praise God from whom all blessings flow’?”
  • And they sang it again, and Mary and Colin lifted their voices as
  • musically as they could and Dickon’s swelled quite loud and
  • beautiful—and at the second line Ben Weatherstaff raspingly cleared his
  • throat and at the third line he joined in with such vigor that it
  • seemed almost savage and when the “Amen” came to an end Mary observed
  • that the very same thing had happened to him which had happened when he
  • found out that Colin was not a cripple—his chin was twitching and he
  • was staring and winking and his leathery old cheeks were wet.
  • “I never seed no sense in th’ Doxology afore,” he said hoarsely, “but I
  • may change my mind i’ time. I should say tha’d gone up five pound this
  • week Mester Colin—five on ’em!”
  • Colin was looking across the garden at something attracting his
  • attention and his expression had become a startled one.
  • “Who is coming in here?” he said quickly. “Who is it?”
  • The door in the ivied wall had been pushed gently open and a woman had
  • entered. She had come in with the last line of their song and she had
  • stood still listening and looking at them. With the ivy behind her, the
  • sunlight drifting through the trees and dappling her long blue cloak,
  • and her nice fresh face smiling across the greenery she was rather like
  • a softly colored illustration in one of Colin’s books. She had
  • wonderful affectionate eyes which seemed to take everything in—all of
  • them, even Ben Weatherstaff and the “creatures” and every flower that
  • was in bloom. Unexpectedly as she had appeared, not one of them felt
  • that she was an intruder at all. Dickon’s eyes lighted like lamps.
  • “It’s mother—that’s who it is!” he cried and went across the grass at a
  • run.
  • Colin began to move toward her, too, and Mary went with him. They both
  • felt their pulses beat faster.
  • “It’s mother!” Dickon said again when they met halfway. “I knowed tha’
  • wanted to see her an’ I told her where th’ door was hid.”
  • Colin held out his hand with a sort of flushed royal shyness but his
  • eyes quite devoured her face.
  • “Even when I was ill I wanted to see you,” he said, “you and Dickon and
  • the secret garden. I’d never wanted to see anyone or anything before.”
  • The sight of his uplifted face brought about a sudden change in her
  • own. She flushed and the corners of her mouth shook and a mist seemed
  • to sweep over her eyes.
  • “Eh! dear lad!” she broke out tremulously. “Eh! dear lad!” as if she
  • had not known she were going to say it. She did not say, “Mester
  • Colin,” but just “dear lad” quite suddenly. She might have said it to
  • Dickon in the same way if she had seen something in his face which
  • touched her. Colin liked it.
  • “Are you surprised because I am so well?” he asked.
  • She put her hand on his shoulder and smiled the mist out of her eyes.
  • “Aye, that I am!” she said; “but tha’rt so like thy mother tha’ made my
  • heart jump.”
  • “Do you think,” said Colin a little awkwardly, “that will make my
  • father like me?”
  • “Aye, for sure, dear lad,” she answered and she gave his shoulder a
  • soft quick pat. “He mun come home—he mun come home.”
  • “Susan Sowerby,” said Ben Weatherstaff, getting close to her. “Look at
  • th’ lad’s legs, wilt tha’? They was like drumsticks i’ stockin’ two
  • month’ ago—an’ I heard folk tell as they was bandy an’ knock-kneed both
  • at th’ same time. Look at ’em now!”
  • Susan Sowerby laughed a comfortable laugh.
  • “They’re goin’ to be fine strong lad’s legs in a bit,” she said. “Let
  • him go on playin’ an’ workin’ in the garden an’ eatin’ hearty an’
  • drinkin’ plenty o’ good sweet milk an’ there’ll not be a finer pair i’
  • Yorkshire, thank God for it.”
  • She put both hands on Mistress Mary’s shoulders and looked her little
  • face over in a motherly fashion.
  • “An’ thee, too!” she said. “Tha’rt grown near as hearty as our
  • ’Lisabeth Ellen. I’ll warrant tha’rt like thy mother too. Our Martha
  • told me as Mrs. Medlock heard she was a pretty woman. Tha’lt be like a
  • blush rose when tha’ grows up, my little lass, bless thee.”
  • She did not mention that when Martha came home on her “day out” and
  • described the plain sallow child she had said that she had no
  • confidence whatever in what Mrs. Medlock had heard. “It doesn’t stand
  • to reason that a pretty woman could be th’ mother o’ such a fou’ little
  • lass,” she had added obstinately.
  • Mary had not had time to pay much attention to her changing face. She
  • had only known that she looked “different” and seemed to have a great
  • deal more hair and that it was growing very fast. But remembering her
  • pleasure in looking at the Mem Sahib in the past she was glad to hear
  • that she might some day look like her.
  • Susan Sowerby went round their garden with them and was told the whole
  • story of it and shown every bush and tree which had come alive. Colin
  • walked on one side of her and Mary on the other. Each of them kept
  • looking up at her comfortable rosy face, secretly curious about the
  • delightful feeling she gave them—a sort of warm, supported feeling. It
  • seemed as if she understood them as Dickon understood his “creatures.”
  • She stooped over the flowers and talked about them as if they were
  • children. Soot followed her and once or twice cawed at her and flew
  • upon her shoulder as if it were Dickon’s. When they told her about the
  • robin and the first flight of the young ones she laughed a motherly
  • little mellow laugh in her throat.
  • “I suppose learnin’ ’em to fly is like learnin’ children to walk, but
  • I’m feared I should be all in a worrit if mine had wings instead o’
  • legs,” she said.
  • It was because she seemed such a wonderful woman in her nice moorland
  • cottage way that at last she was told about the Magic.
  • “Do you believe in Magic?” asked Colin after he had explained about
  • Indian fakirs. “I do hope you do.”
  • “That I do, lad,” she answered. “I never knowed it by that name but
  • what does th’ name matter? I warrant they call it a different name i’
  • France an’ a different one i’ Germany. Th’ same thing as set th’ seeds
  • swellin’ an’ th’ sun shinin’ made thee a well lad an’ it’s th’ Good
  • Thing. It isn’t like us poor fools as think it matters if us is called
  • out of our names. Th’ Big Good Thing doesn’t stop to worrit, bless
  • thee. It goes on makin’ worlds by th’ million—worlds like us. Never
  • thee stop believin’ in th’ Big Good Thing an’ knowin’ th’ world’s full
  • of it—an’ call it what tha’ likes. Tha’ wert singin’ to it when I come
  • into th’ garden.”
  • “I felt so joyful,” said Colin, opening his beautiful strange eyes at
  • her. “Suddenly I felt how different I was—how strong my arms and legs
  • were, you know—and how I could dig and stand—and I jumped up and wanted
  • to shout out something to anything that would listen.”
  • “Th’ Magic listened when tha’ sung th’ Doxology. It would ha’ listened
  • to anything tha’d sung. It was th’ joy that mattered. Eh! lad,
  • lad—what’s names to th’ Joy Maker,” and she gave his shoulders a quick
  • soft pat again.
  • She had packed a basket which held a regular feast this morning, and
  • when the hungry hour came and Dickon brought it out from its hiding
  • place, she sat down with them under their tree and watched them devour
  • their food, laughing and quite gloating over their appetites. She was
  • full of fun and made them laugh at all sorts of odd things. She told
  • them stories in broad Yorkshire and taught them new words. She laughed
  • as if she could not help it when they told her of the increasing
  • difficulty there was in pretending that Colin was still a fretful
  • invalid.
  • “You see we can’t help laughing nearly all the time when we are
  • together,” explained Colin. “And it doesn’t sound ill at all. We try to
  • choke it back but it will burst out and that sounds worse than ever.”
  • “There’s one thing that comes into my mind so often,” said Mary, “and I
  • can scarcely ever hold in when I think of it suddenly. I keep thinking
  • suppose Colin’s face should get to look like a full moon. It isn’t like
  • one yet but he gets a tiny bit fatter every day—and suppose some
  • morning it should look like one—what should we do!”
  • “Bless us all, I can see tha’ has a good bit o’ play actin’ to do,”
  • said Susan Sowerby. “But tha’ won’t have to keep it up much longer.
  • Mester Craven’ll come home.”
  • “Do you think he will?” asked Colin. “Why?”
  • Susan Sowerby chuckled softly.
  • “I suppose it ’ud nigh break thy heart if he found out before tha’ told
  • him in tha’ own way,” she said. “Tha’s laid awake nights plannin’ it.”
  • “I couldn’t bear anyone else to tell him,” said Colin. “I think about
  • different ways every day, I think now I just want to run into his
  • room.”
  • “That’d be a fine start for him,” said Susan Sowerby. “I’d like to see
  • his face, lad. I would that! He mun come back—that he mun.”
  • One of the things they talked of was the visit they were to make to her
  • cottage. They planned it all. They were to drive over the moor and
  • lunch out of doors among the heather. They would see all the twelve
  • children and Dickon’s garden and would not come back until they were
  • tired.
  • Susan Sowerby got up at last to return to the house and Mrs. Medlock.
  • It was time for Colin to be wheeled back also. But before he got into
  • his chair he stood quite close to Susan and fixed his eyes on her with
  • a kind of bewildered adoration and he suddenly caught hold of the fold
  • of her blue cloak and held it fast.
  • “You are just what I—what I wanted,” he said. “I wish you were my
  • mother—as well as Dickon’s!”
  • All at once Susan Sowerby bent down and drew him with her warm arms
  • close against the bosom under the blue cloak—as if he had been Dickon’s
  • brother. The quick mist swept over her eyes.
  • “Eh! dear lad!” she said. “Thy own mother’s in this ’ere very garden, I
  • do believe. She couldna’ keep out of it. Thy father mun come back to
  • thee—he mun!”
  • CHAPTER XXVII
  • IN THE GARDEN
  • In each century since the beginning of the world wonderful things have
  • been discovered. In the last century more amazing things were found out
  • than in any century before. In this new century hundreds of things
  • still more astounding will be brought to light. At first people refuse
  • to believe that a strange new thing can be done, then they begin to
  • hope it can be done, then they see it can be done—then it is done and
  • all the world wonders why it was not done centuries ago. One of the new
  • things people began to find out in the last century was that
  • thoughts—just mere thoughts—are as powerful as electric batteries—as
  • good for one as sunlight is, or as bad for one as poison. To let a sad
  • thought or a bad one get into your mind is as dangerous as letting a
  • scarlet fever germ get into your body. If you let it stay there after
  • it has got in you may never get over it as long as you live.
  • So long as Mistress Mary’s mind was full of disagreeable thoughts about
  • her dislikes and sour opinions of people and her determination not to
  • be pleased by or interested in anything, she was a yellow-faced,
  • sickly, bored and wretched child. Circumstances, however, were very
  • kind to her, though she was not at all aware of it. They began to push
  • her about for her own good. When her mind gradually filled itself with
  • robins, and moorland cottages crowded with children, with queer crabbed
  • old gardeners and common little Yorkshire housemaids, with springtime
  • and with secret gardens coming alive day by day, and also with a moor
  • boy and his “creatures,” there was no room left for the disagreeable
  • thoughts which affected her liver and her digestion and made her yellow
  • and tired.
  • So long as Colin shut himself up in his room and thought only of his
  • fears and weakness and his detestation of people who looked at him and
  • reflected hourly on humps and early death, he was a hysterical
  • half-crazy little hypochondriac who knew nothing of the sunshine and
  • the spring and also did not know that he could get well and could stand
  • upon his feet if he tried to do it. When new beautiful thoughts began
  • to push out the old hideous ones, life began to come back to him, his
  • blood ran healthily through his veins and strength poured into him like
  • a flood. His scientific experiment was quite practical and simple and
  • there was nothing weird about it at all. Much more surprising things
  • can happen to anyone who, when a disagreeable or discouraged thought
  • comes into his mind, just has the sense to remember in time and push it
  • out by putting in an agreeable determinedly courageous one. Two things
  • cannot be in one place.
  • “Where you tend a rose, my lad,
  • A thistle cannot grow.”
  • While the secret garden was coming alive and two children were coming
  • alive with it, there was a man wandering about certain far-away
  • beautiful places in the Norwegian fiords and the valleys and mountains
  • of Switzerland and he was a man who for ten years had kept his mind
  • filled with dark and heart-broken thinking. He had not been courageous;
  • he had never tried to put any other thoughts in the place of the dark
  • ones. He had wandered by blue lakes and thought them; he had lain on
  • mountain-sides with sheets of deep blue gentians blooming all about him
  • and flower breaths filling all the air and he had thought them. A
  • terrible sorrow had fallen upon him when he had been happy and he had
  • let his soul fill itself with blackness and had refused obstinately to
  • allow any rift of light to pierce through. He had forgotten and
  • deserted his home and his duties. When he traveled about, darkness so
  • brooded over him that the sight of him was a wrong done to other people
  • because it was as if he poisoned the air about him with gloom. Most
  • strangers thought he must be either half mad or a man with some hidden
  • crime on his soul. He, was a tall man with a drawn face and crooked
  • shoulders and the name he always entered on hotel registers was,
  • “Archibald Craven, Misselthwaite Manor, Yorkshire, England.”
  • He had traveled far and wide since the day he saw Mistress Mary in his
  • study and told her she might have her “bit of earth.” He had been in
  • the most beautiful places in Europe, though he had remained nowhere
  • more than a few days. He had chosen the quietest and remotest spots. He
  • had been on the tops of mountains whose heads were in the clouds and
  • had looked down on other mountains when the sun rose and touched them
  • with such light as made it seem as if the world were just being born.
  • But the light had never seemed to touch himself until one day when he
  • realized that for the first time in ten years a strange thing had
  • happened. He was in a wonderful valley in the Austrian Tyrol and he had
  • been walking alone through such beauty as might have lifted, any man’s
  • soul out of shadow. He had walked a long way and it had not lifted his.
  • But at last he had felt tired and had thrown himself down to rest on a
  • carpet of moss by a stream. It was a clear little stream which ran
  • quite merrily along on its narrow way through the luscious damp
  • greenness. Sometimes it made a sound rather like very low laughter as
  • it bubbled over and round stones. He saw birds come and dip their heads
  • to drink in it and then flick their wings and fly away. It seemed like
  • a thing alive and yet its tiny voice made the stillness seem deeper.
  • The valley was very, very still.
  • As he sat gazing into the clear running of the water, Archibald Craven
  • gradually felt his mind and body both grow quiet, as quiet as the
  • valley itself. He wondered if he were going to sleep, but he was not.
  • He sat and gazed at the sunlit water and his eyes began to see things
  • growing at its edge. There was one lovely mass of blue forget-me-nots
  • growing so close to the stream that its leaves were wet and at these he
  • found himself looking as he remembered he had looked at such things
  • years ago. He was actually thinking tenderly how lovely it was and what
  • wonders of blue its hundreds of little blossoms were. He did not know
  • that just that simple thought was slowly filling his mind—filling and
  • filling it until other things were softly pushed aside. It was as if a
  • sweet clear spring had begun to rise in a stagnant pool and had risen
  • and risen until at last it swept the dark water away. But of course he
  • did not think of this himself. He only knew that the valley seemed to
  • grow quieter and quieter as he sat and stared at the bright delicate
  • blueness. He did not know how long he sat there or what was happening
  • to him, but at last he moved as if he were awakening and he got up
  • slowly and stood on the moss carpet, drawing a long, deep, soft breath
  • and wondering at himself. Something seemed to have been unbound and
  • released in him, very quietly.
  • “What is it?” he said, almost in a whisper, and he passed his hand over
  • his forehead. “I almost feel as if—I were alive!”
  • I do not know enough about the wonderfulness of undiscovered things to
  • be able to explain how this had happened to him. Neither does anyone
  • else yet. He did not understand at all himself—but he remembered this
  • strange hour months afterward when he was at Misselthwaite again and he
  • found out quite by accident that on this very day Colin had cried out
  • as he went into the secret garden:
  • “I am going to live forever and ever and ever!”
  • The singular calmness remained with him the rest of the evening and he
  • slept a new reposeful sleep; but it was not with him very long. He did
  • not know that it could be kept. By the next night he had opened the
  • doors wide to his dark thoughts and they had come trooping and rushing
  • back. He left the valley and went on his wandering way again. But,
  • strange as it seemed to him, there were minutes—sometimes
  • half-hours—when, without his knowing why, the black burden seemed to
  • lift itself again and he knew he was a living man and not a dead one.
  • Slowly—slowly—for no reason that he knew of—he was “coming alive” with
  • the garden.
  • As the golden summer changed into the deep golden autumn he went to the
  • Lake of Como. There he found the loveliness of a dream. He spent his
  • days upon the crystal blueness of the lake or he walked back into the
  • soft thick verdure of the hills and tramped until he was tired so that
  • he might sleep. But by this time he had begun to sleep better, he knew,
  • and his dreams had ceased to be a terror to him.
  • “Perhaps,” he thought, “my body is growing stronger.”
  • It was growing stronger but—because of the rare peaceful hours when his
  • thoughts were changed—his soul was slowly growing stronger, too. He
  • began to think of Misselthwaite and wonder if he should not go home.
  • Now and then he wondered vaguely about his boy and asked himself what
  • he should feel when he went and stood by the carved four-posted bed
  • again and looked down at the sharply chiseled ivory-white face while it
  • slept and, the black lashes rimmed so startlingly the close-shut eyes.
  • He shrank from it.
  • One marvel of a day he had walked so far that when he returned the moon
  • was high and full and all the world was purple shadow and silver. The
  • stillness of lake and shore and wood was so wonderful that he did not
  • go into the villa he lived in. He walked down to a little bowered
  • terrace at the water’s edge and sat upon a seat and breathed in all the
  • heavenly scents of the night. He felt the strange calmness stealing
  • over him and it grew deeper and deeper until he fell asleep.
  • He did not know when he fell asleep and when he began to dream; his
  • dream was so real that he did not feel as if he were dreaming. He
  • remembered afterward how intensely wide awake and alert he had thought
  • he was. He thought that as he sat and breathed in the scent of the late
  • roses and listened to the lapping of the water at his feet he heard a
  • voice calling. It was sweet and clear and happy and far away. It seemed
  • very far, but he heard it as distinctly as if it had been at his very
  • side.
  • “Archie! Archie! Archie!” it said, and then again, sweeter and clearer
  • than before, “Archie! Archie!”
  • He thought he sprang to his feet not even startled. It was such a real
  • voice and it seemed so natural that he should hear it.
  • “Lilias! Lilias!” he answered. “Lilias! where are you?”
  • “In the garden,” it came back like a sound from a golden flute. “In the
  • garden!”
  • And then the dream ended. But he did not awaken. He slept soundly and
  • sweetly all through the lovely night. When he did awake at last it was
  • brilliant morning and a servant was standing staring at him. He was an
  • Italian servant and was accustomed, as all the servants of the villa
  • were, to accepting without question any strange thing his foreign
  • master might do. No one ever knew when he would go out or come in or
  • where he would choose to sleep or if he would roam about the garden or
  • lie in the boat on the lake all night. The man held a salver with some
  • letters on it and he waited quietly until Mr. Craven took them. When he
  • had gone away Mr. Craven sat a few moments holding them in his hand and
  • looking at the lake. His strange calm was still upon him and something
  • more—a lightness as if the cruel thing which had been done had not
  • happened as he thought—as if something had changed. He was remembering
  • the dream—the real—real dream.
  • “In the garden!” he said, wondering at himself. “In the garden! But the
  • door is locked and the key is buried deep.”
  • When he glanced at the letters a few minutes later he saw that the one
  • lying at the top of the rest was an English letter and came from
  • Yorkshire. It was directed in a plain woman’s hand but it was not a
  • hand he knew. He opened it, scarcely thinking of the writer, but the
  • first words attracted his attention at once.
  • “_Dear Sir:_
  • I am Susan Sowerby that made bold to speak to you once on the moor. It
  • was about Miss Mary I spoke. I will make bold to speak again. Please,
  • sir, I would come home if I was you. I think you would be glad to come
  • and—if you will excuse me, sir—I think your lady would ask you to come
  • if she was here.
  • Your obedient servant,
  • Susan Sowerby.”
  • Mr. Craven read the letter twice before he put it back in its envelope.
  • He kept thinking about the dream.
  • “I will go back to Misselthwaite,” he said. “Yes, I’ll go at once.”
  • And he went through the garden to the villa and ordered Pitcher to
  • prepare for his return to England.
  • In a few days he was in Yorkshire again, and on his long railroad
  • journey he found himself thinking of his boy as he had never thought in
  • all the ten years past. During those years he had only wished to forget
  • him. Now, though he did not intend to think about him, memories of him
  • constantly drifted into his mind. He remembered the black days when he
  • had raved like a madman because the child was alive and the mother was
  • dead. He had refused to see it, and when he had gone to look at it at
  • last it had been, such a weak wretched thing that everyone had been
  • sure it would die in a few days. But to the surprise of those who took
  • care of it the days passed and it lived and then everyone believed it
  • would be a deformed and crippled creature.
  • He had not meant to be a bad father, but he had not felt like a father
  • at all. He had supplied doctors and nurses and luxuries, but he had
  • shrunk from the mere thought of the boy and had buried himself in his
  • own misery. The first time after a year’s absence he returned to
  • Misselthwaite and the small miserable looking thing languidly and
  • indifferently lifted to his face the great gray eyes with black lashes
  • round them, so like and yet so horribly unlike the happy eyes he had
  • adored, he could not bear the sight of them and turned away pale as
  • death. After that he scarcely ever saw him except when he was asleep,
  • and all he knew of him was that he was a confirmed invalid, with a
  • vicious, hysterical, half-insane temper. He could only be kept from
  • furies dangerous to himself by being given his own way in every detail.
  • All this was not an uplifting thing to recall, but as the train whirled
  • him through mountain passes and golden plains the man who was “coming
  • alive” began to think in a new way and he thought long and steadily and
  • deeply.
  • “Perhaps I have been all wrong for ten years,” he said to himself. “Ten
  • years is a long time. It may be too late to do anything—quite too late.
  • What have I been thinking of!”
  • Of course this was the wrong Magic—to begin by saying “too late.” Even
  • Colin could have told him that. But he knew nothing of Magic—either
  • black or white. This he had yet to learn. He wondered if Susan Sowerby
  • had taken courage and written to him only because the motherly creature
  • had realized that the boy was much worse—was fatally ill. If he had not
  • been under the spell of the curious calmness which had taken possession
  • of him he would have been more wretched than ever. But the calm had
  • brought a sort of courage and hope with it. Instead of giving way to
  • thoughts of the worst he actually found he was trying to believe in
  • better things.
  • “Could it be possible that she sees that I may be able to do him good
  • and control him?” he thought. “I will go and see her on my way to
  • Misselthwaite.”
  • But when on his way across the moor he stopped the carriage at the
  • cottage, seven or eight children who were playing about gathered in a
  • group and bobbing seven or eight friendly and polite curtsies told him
  • that their mother had gone to the other side of the moor early in the
  • morning to help a woman who had a new baby. “Our Dickon,” they
  • volunteered, was over at the Manor working in one of the gardens where
  • he went several days each week.
  • Mr. Craven looked over the collection of sturdy little bodies and round
  • red-cheeked faces, each one grinning in its own particular way, and he
  • awoke to the fact that they were a healthy likable lot. He smiled at
  • their friendly grins and took a golden sovereign from his pocket and
  • gave it to “our ’Lizabeth Ellen” who was the oldest.
  • “If you divide that into eight parts there will be half a crown for
  • each of, you,” he said.
  • Then amid grins and chuckles and bobbing of curtsies he drove away,
  • leaving ecstasy and nudging elbows and little jumps of joy behind.
  • The drive across the wonderfulness of the moor was a soothing thing.
  • Why did it seem to give him a sense of homecoming which he had been
  • sure he could never feel again—that sense of the beauty of land and sky
  • and purple bloom of distance and a warming of the heart at drawing,
  • nearer to the great old house which had held those of his blood for six
  • hundred years? How he had driven away from it the last time, shuddering
  • to think of its closed rooms and the boy lying in the four-posted bed
  • with the brocaded hangings. Was it possible that perhaps he might find
  • him changed a little for the better and that he might overcome his
  • shrinking from him? How real that dream had been—how wonderful and
  • clear the voice which called back to him, “In the garden—In the
  • garden!”
  • “I will try to find the key,” he said. “I will try to open the door. I
  • must—though I don’t know why.”
  • When he arrived at the Manor the servants who received him with the
  • usual ceremony noticed that he looked better and that he did not go to
  • the remote rooms where he usually lived attended by Pitcher. He went
  • into the library and sent for Mrs. Medlock. She came to him somewhat
  • excited and curious and flustered.
  • “How is Master Colin, Medlock?” he inquired.
  • “Well, sir,” Mrs. Medlock answered, “he’s—he’s different, in a manner
  • of speaking.”
  • “Worse?” he suggested.
  • Mrs. Medlock really was flushed.
  • “Well, you see, sir,” she tried to explain, “neither Dr. Craven, nor
  • the nurse, nor me can exactly make him out.”
  • “Why is that?”
  • “To tell the truth, sir, Master Colin might be better and he might be
  • changing for the worse. His appetite, sir, is past understanding—and
  • his ways—”
  • “Has he become more—more peculiar?” her master, asked, knitting his
  • brows anxiously.
  • “That’s it, sir. He’s growing very peculiar—when you compare him with
  • what he used to be. He used to eat nothing and then suddenly he began
  • to eat something enormous—and then he stopped again all at once and the
  • meals were sent back just as they used to be. You never knew, sir,
  • perhaps, that out of doors he never would let himself be taken. The
  • things we’ve gone through to get him to go out in his chair would leave
  • a body trembling like a leaf. He’d throw himself into such a state that
  • Dr. Craven said he couldn’t be responsible for forcing him. Well, sir,
  • just without warning—not long after one of his worst tantrums he
  • suddenly insisted on being taken out every day by Miss Mary and Susan
  • Sowerby’s boy Dickon that could push his chair. He took a fancy to both
  • Miss Mary and Dickon, and Dickon brought his tame animals, and, if
  • you’ll credit it, sir, out of doors he will stay from morning until
  • night.”
  • “How does he look?” was the next question.
  • “If he took his food natural, sir, you’d think he was putting on
  • flesh—but we’re afraid it may be a sort of bloat. He laughs sometimes
  • in a queer way when he’s alone with Miss Mary. He never used to laugh
  • at all. Dr. Craven is coming to see you at once, if you’ll allow him.
  • He never was as puzzled in his life.”
  • “Where is Master Colin now?” Mr. Craven asked.
  • “In the garden, sir. He’s always in the garden—though not a human
  • creature is allowed to go near for fear they’ll look at him.”
  • Mr. Craven scarcely heard her last words.
  • “In the garden,” he said, and after he had sent Mrs. Medlock away he
  • stood and repeated it again and again. “In the garden!”
  • He had to make an effort to bring himself back to the place he was
  • standing in and when he felt he was on earth again he turned and went
  • out of the room. He took his way, as Mary had done, through the door in
  • the shrubbery and among the laurels and the fountain beds. The fountain
  • was playing now and was encircled by beds of brilliant autumn flowers.
  • He crossed the lawn and turned into the Long Walk by the ivied walls.
  • He did not walk quickly, but slowly, and his eyes were on the path. He
  • felt as if he were being drawn back to the place he had so long
  • forsaken, and he did not know why. As he drew near to it his step
  • became still more slow. He knew where the door was even though the ivy
  • hung thick over it—but he did not know exactly where it lay—that buried
  • key.
  • So he stopped and stood still, looking about him, and almost the moment
  • after he had paused he started and listened—asking himself if he were
  • walking in a dream.
  • The ivy hung thick over the door, the key was buried under the shrubs,
  • no human being had passed that portal for ten lonely years—and yet
  • inside the garden there were sounds. They were the sounds of running
  • scuffling feet seeming to chase round and round under the trees, they
  • were strange sounds of lowered suppressed voices—exclamations and
  • smothered joyous cries. It seemed actually like the laughter of young
  • things, the uncontrollable laughter of children who were trying not to
  • be heard but who in a moment or so—as their excitement mounted—would
  • burst forth. What in heaven’s name was he dreaming of—what in heaven’s
  • name did he hear? Was he losing his reason and thinking he heard things
  • which were not for human ears? Was it that the far clear voice had
  • meant?
  • And then the moment came, the uncontrollable moment when the sounds
  • forgot to hush themselves. The feet ran faster and faster—they were
  • nearing the garden door—there was quick strong young breathing and a
  • wild outbreak of laughing shouts which could not be contained—and the
  • door in the wall was flung wide open, the sheet of ivy swinging back,
  • and a boy burst through it at full speed and, without seeing the
  • outsider, dashed almost into his arms.
  • Mr. Craven had extended them just in time to save him from falling as a
  • result of his unseeing dash against him, and when he held him away to
  • look at him in amazement at his being there he truly gasped for breath.
  • He was a tall boy and a handsome one. He was glowing with life and his
  • running had sent splendid color leaping to his face. He threw the thick
  • hair back from his forehead and lifted a pair of strange gray eyes—eyes
  • full of boyish laughter and rimmed with black lashes like a fringe. It
  • was the eyes which made Mr. Craven gasp for breath.
  • “Who—What? Who!” he stammered.
  • This was not what Colin had expected—this was not what he had planned.
  • He had never thought of such a meeting. And yet to come dashing
  • out—winning a race—perhaps it was even better. He drew himself up to
  • his very tallest. Mary, who had been running with him and had dashed
  • through the door too, believed that he managed to make himself look
  • taller than he had ever looked before—inches taller.
  • “Father,” he said, “I’m Colin. You can’t believe it. I scarcely can
  • myself. I’m Colin.”
  • Like Mrs. Medlock, he did not understand what his father meant when he
  • said hurriedly:
  • “In the garden! In the garden!”
  • “Yes,” hurried on Colin. “It was the garden that did it—and Mary and
  • Dickon and the creatures—and the Magic. No one knows. We kept it to
  • tell you when you came. I’m well, I can beat Mary in a race. I’m going
  • to be an athlete.”
  • He said it all so like a healthy boy—his face flushed, his words
  • tumbling over each other in his eagerness—that Mr. Craven’s soul shook
  • with unbelieving joy.
  • Colin put out his hand and laid it on his father’s arm.
  • “Aren’t you glad, Father?” he ended. “Aren’t you glad? I’m going to
  • live forever and ever and ever!”
  • Mr. Craven put his hands on both the boy’s shoulders and held him
  • still. He knew he dared not even try to speak for a moment.
  • “Take me into the garden, my boy,” he said at last. “And tell me all
  • about it.”
  • And so they led him in.
  • The place was a wilderness of autumn gold and purple and violet blue
  • and flaming scarlet and on every side were sheaves of late lilies
  • standing together—lilies which were white or white and ruby. He
  • remembered well when the first of them had been planted that just at
  • this season of the year their late glories should reveal themselves.
  • Late roses climbed and hung and clustered and the sunshine deepening
  • the hue of the yellowing trees made one feel that one, stood in an
  • embowered temple of gold. The newcomer stood silent just as the
  • children had done when they came into its grayness. He looked round and
  • round.
  • “I thought it would be dead,” he said.
  • “Mary thought so at first,” said Colin. “But it came alive.”
  • Then they sat down under their tree—all but Colin, who wanted to stand
  • while he told the story.
  • It was the strangest thing he had ever heard, Archibald Craven thought,
  • as it was poured forth in headlong boy fashion. Mystery and Magic and
  • wild creatures, the weird midnight meeting—the coming of the spring—the
  • passion of insulted pride which had dragged the young Rajah to his feet
  • to defy old Ben Weatherstaff to his face. The odd companionship, the
  • play acting, the great secret so carefully kept. The listener laughed
  • until tears came into his eyes and sometimes tears came into his eyes
  • when he was not laughing. The Athlete, the Lecturer, the Scientific
  • Discoverer was a laughable, lovable, healthy young human thing.
  • “Now,” he said at the end of the story, “it need not be a secret any
  • more. I dare say it will frighten them nearly into fits when they see
  • me—but I am never going to get into the chair again. I shall walk back
  • with you, Father—to the house.”
  • Ben Weatherstaff’s duties rarely took him away from the gardens, but on
  • this occasion he made an excuse to carry some vegetables to the kitchen
  • and being invited into the servants’ hall by Mrs. Medlock to drink a
  • glass of beer he was on the spot—as he had hoped to be—when the most
  • dramatic event Misselthwaite Manor had seen during the present
  • generation actually took place.
  • One of the windows looking upon the courtyard gave also a glimpse of
  • the lawn. Mrs. Medlock, knowing Ben had come from the gardens, hoped
  • that he might have caught sight of his master and even by chance of his
  • meeting with Master Colin.
  • “Did you see either of them, Weatherstaff?” she asked.
  • Ben took his beer-mug from his mouth and wiped his lips with the back
  • of his hand.
  • “Aye, that I did,” he answered with a shrewdly significant air.
  • “Both of them?” suggested Mrs. Medlock.
  • “Both of ’em,” returned Ben Weatherstaff. “Thank ye kindly, ma’am, I
  • could sup up another mug of it.”
  • “Together?” said Mrs. Medlock, hastily overfilling his beer-mug in her
  • excitement.
  • “Together, ma’am,” and Ben gulped down half of his new mug at one gulp.
  • “Where was Master Colin? How did he look? What did they say to each
  • other?”
  • “I didna’ hear that,” said Ben, “along o’ only bein’ on th’ stepladder
  • lookin over th’ wall. But I’ll tell thee this. There’s been things
  • goin’ on outside as you house people knows nowt about. An’ what tha’ll
  • find out tha’ll find out soon.”
  • And it was not two minutes before he swallowed the last of his beer and
  • waved his mug solemnly toward the window which took in through the
  • shrubbery a piece of the lawn.
  • “Look there,” he said, “if tha’s curious. Look what’s comin’ across th’
  • grass.”
  • When Mrs. Medlock looked she threw up her hands and gave a little
  • shriek and every man and woman servant within hearing bolted across the
  • servants’ hall and stood looking through the window with their eyes
  • almost starting out of their heads.
  • Across the lawn came the Master of Misselthwaite and he looked as many
  • of them had never seen him. And by his side with his head up in the air
  • and his eyes full of laughter walked as strongly and steadily as any
  • boy in Yorkshire—Master Colin!
  • THE END
  • End of The Project Gutenberg Etext of The Secret Garden by Frances Hodgson Burnett
  • *** END OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK THE SECRET GARDEN ***
  • ***** This file should be named 113-0.txt or 113-0.zip ***** This and all
  • associated files of various formats will be found in:
  • http://www.gutenberg.org/1/1/113/
  • Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions will
  • be renamed.
  • Creating the works from print editions not protected by U.S. copyright
  • law means that no one owns a United States copyright in these works,
  • so the Foundation (and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United
  • States without permission and without paying copyright
  • royalties. Special rules, set forth in the General Terms of Use part
  • of this license, apply to copying and distributing Project
  • Gutenberg-tm electronic works to protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm
  • concept and trademark. Project Gutenberg is a registered trademark,
  • and may not be used if you charge for the eBooks, unless you receive
  • specific permission. If you do not charge anything for copies of this
  • eBook, complying with the rules is very easy. You may use this eBook
  • for nearly any purpose such as creation of derivative works, reports,
  • performances and research. They may be modified and printed and given
  • away--you may do practically ANYTHING in the United States with eBooks
  • not protected by U.S. copyright law. Redistribution is subject to the
  • trademark license, especially commercial redistribution.
  • START: FULL LICENSE
  • THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE
  • PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK
  • To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free
  • distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work
  • (or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project
  • Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full
  • Project Gutenberg-tm License available with this file or online at
  • www.gutenberg.org/license.
  • Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project
  • Gutenberg-tm electronic works
  • 1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm
  • electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
  • and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property
  • (trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all
  • the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or
  • destroy all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your
  • possession. If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a
  • Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound
  • by the terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the
  • person or entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph
  • 1.E.8.
  • 1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be
  • used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who
  • agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few
  • things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
  • even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See
  • paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project
  • Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this
  • agreement and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm
  • electronic works. See paragraph 1.E below.
  • 1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the
  • Foundation" or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection
  • of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual
  • works in the collection are in the public domain in the United
  • States. If an individual work is unprotected by copyright law in the
  • United States and you are located in the United States, we do not
  • claim a right to prevent you from copying, distributing, performing,
  • displaying or creating derivative works based on the work as long as
  • all references to Project Gutenberg are removed. Of course, we hope
  • that you will support the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting
  • free access to electronic works by freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm
  • works in compliance with the terms of this agreement for keeping the
  • Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with the work. You can easily
  • comply with the terms of this agreement by keeping this work in the
  • same format with its attached full Project Gutenberg-tm License when
  • you share it without charge with others.
  • 1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
  • what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are
  • in a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States,
  • check the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this
  • agreement before downloading, copying, displaying, performing,
  • distributing or creating derivative works based on this work or any
  • other Project Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no
  • representations concerning the copyright status of any work in any
  • country outside the United States.
  • 1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:
  • 1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other
  • immediate access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear
  • prominently whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work
  • on which the phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the
  • phrase "Project Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed,
  • performed, viewed, copied or distributed:
  • This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere in the United States and
  • most other parts of the world at no cost and with almost no
  • restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or re-use it
  • under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included with this
  • eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org. If you are not located in the
  • United States, you'll have to check the laws of the country where you
  • are located before using this ebook.
  • 1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is
  • derived from texts not protected by U.S. copyright law (does not
  • contain a notice indicating that it is posted with permission of the
  • copyright holder), the work can be copied and distributed to anyone in
  • the United States without paying any fees or charges. If you are
  • redistributing or providing access to a work with the phrase "Project
  • Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the work, you must comply
  • either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 or
  • obtain permission for the use of the work and the Project Gutenberg-tm
  • trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
  • 1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted
  • with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution
  • must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any
  • additional terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms
  • will be linked to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works
  • posted with the permission of the copyright holder found at the
  • beginning of this work.
  • 1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm
  • License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this
  • work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm.
  • 1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
  • electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
  • prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with
  • active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project
  • Gutenberg-tm License.
  • 1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
  • compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including
  • any word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access
  • to or distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format
  • other than "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official
  • version posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site
  • (www.gutenberg.org), you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense
  • to the user, provide a copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means
  • of obtaining a copy upon request, of the work in its original "Plain
  • Vanilla ASCII" or other form. Any alternate format must include the
  • full Project Gutenberg-tm License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1.
  • 1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying,
  • performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works
  • unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
  • 1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing
  • access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
  • provided that
  • * You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
  • the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method
  • you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is owed
  • to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he has
  • agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the Project
  • Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments must be paid
  • within 60 days following each date on which you prepare (or are
  • legally required to prepare) your periodic tax returns. Royalty
  • payments should be clearly marked as such and sent to the Project
  • Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the address specified in
  • Section 4, "Information about donations to the Project Gutenberg
  • Literary Archive Foundation."
  • * You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
  • you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he
  • does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm
  • License. You must require such a user to return or destroy all
  • copies of the works possessed in a physical medium and discontinue
  • all use of and all access to other copies of Project Gutenberg-tm
  • works.
  • * You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of
  • any money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the
  • electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days of
  • receipt of the work.
  • * You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
  • distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works.
  • 1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project
  • Gutenberg-tm electronic work or group of works on different terms than
  • are set forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing
  • from both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and The
  • Project Gutenberg Trademark LLC, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm
  • trademark. Contact the Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below.
  • 1.F.
  • 1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable
  • effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread
  • works not protected by U.S. copyright law in creating the Project
  • Gutenberg-tm collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm
  • electronic works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may
  • contain "Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate
  • or corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other
  • intellectual property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or
  • other medium, a computer virus, or computer codes that damage or
  • cannot be read by your equipment.
  • 1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right
  • of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project
  • Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project
  • Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project
  • Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all
  • liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal
  • fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
  • LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
  • PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH 1.F.3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE
  • TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE
  • LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR
  • INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
  • DAMAGE.
  • 1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a
  • defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can
  • receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a
  • written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you
  • received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium
  • with your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you
  • with the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in
  • lieu of a refund. If you received the work electronically, the person
  • or entity providing it to you may choose to give you a second
  • opportunity to receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If
  • the second copy is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing
  • without further opportunities to fix the problem.
  • 1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth
  • in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS', WITH NO
  • OTHER WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT
  • LIMITED TO WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.
  • 1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied
  • warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of
  • damages. If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement
  • violates the law of the state applicable to this agreement, the
  • agreement shall be interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or
  • limitation permitted by the applicable state law. The invalidity or
  • unenforceability of any provision of this agreement shall not void the
  • remaining provisions.
  • 1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
  • trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
  • providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in
  • accordance with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the
  • production, promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm
  • electronic works, harmless from all liability, costs and expenses,
  • including legal fees, that arise directly or indirectly from any of
  • the following which you do or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this
  • or any Project Gutenberg-tm work, (b) alteration, modification, or
  • additions or deletions to any Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any
  • Defect you cause.
  • Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm
  • Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of
  • electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of
  • computers including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It
  • exists because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations
  • from people in all walks of life.
  • Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
  • assistance they need are critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's
  • goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will
  • remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project
  • Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure
  • and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future
  • generations. To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary
  • Archive Foundation and how your efforts and donations can help, see
  • Sections 3 and 4 and the Foundation information page at
  • www.gutenberg.org
  • Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation
  • The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit
  • 501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the
  • state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal
  • Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification
  • number is 64-6221541. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg Literary
  • Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent permitted by
  • U.S. federal laws and your state's laws.
  • The Foundation's principal office is in Fairbanks, Alaska, with the
  • mailing address: PO Box 750175, Fairbanks, AK 99775, but its
  • volunteers and employees are scattered throughout numerous
  • locations. Its business office is located at 809 North 1500 West, Salt
  • Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887. Email contact links and up to
  • date contact information can be found at the Foundation's web site and
  • official page at www.gutenberg.org/contact
  • For additional contact information:
  • Dr. Gregory B. Newby
  • Chief Executive and Director
  • gbnewby@pglaf.org
  • Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg
  • Literary Archive Foundation
  • Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide
  • spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of
  • increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be
  • freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest
  • array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations
  • ($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt
  • status with the IRS.
  • The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
  • charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
  • States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
  • considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
  • with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations
  • where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To SEND
  • DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any particular
  • state visit www.gutenberg.org/donate
  • While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
  • have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
  • against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
  • approach us with offers to donate.
  • International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
  • any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
  • outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.
  • Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation
  • methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other
  • ways including checks, online payments and credit card donations. To
  • donate, please visit: www.gutenberg.org/donate
  • Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works.
  • Professor Michael S. Hart was the originator of the Project
  • Gutenberg-tm concept of a library of electronic works that could be
  • freely shared with anyone. For forty years, he produced and
  • distributed Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of
  • volunteer support.
  • Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed
  • editions, all of which are confirmed as not protected by copyright in
  • the U.S. unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not
  • necessarily keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper
  • edition.
  • Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search
  • facility: www.gutenberg.org
  • This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm,
  • including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary
  • Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to
  • subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.